3 @setfilename coreutils.info
4 @settitle @sc{gnu} Coreutils
9 @include constants.texi
11 @c Define new indices.
15 @c Put everything in one index (arbitrarily chosen to be the concept index).
25 * Coreutils: (coreutils). Core GNU (file, text, shell) utilities.
26 * Common options: (coreutils)Common options. Common options.
27 * File permissions: (coreutils)File permissions. Access modes.
28 * Date input formats: (coreutils)Date input formats.
31 @c FIXME: the following need documentation
32 @c * [: (coreutils)[ invocation. File/string tests.
33 @c * pinky: (coreutils)pinky invocation. FIXME.
34 @c * uptime: (coreutils)uptime invocation. FIXME.
36 @dircategory Individual utilities
38 * base64: (coreutils)base64 invocation. Base64 encode/decode data.
39 * basename: (coreutils)basename invocation. Strip directory and suffix.
40 * cat: (coreutils)cat invocation. Concatenate and write files.
41 * chgrp: (coreutils)chgrp invocation. Change file groups.
42 * chmod: (coreutils)chmod invocation. Change file permissions.
43 * chown: (coreutils)chown invocation. Change file owners/groups.
44 * chroot: (coreutils)chroot invocation. Specify the root directory.
45 * cksum: (coreutils)cksum invocation. Print POSIX CRC checksum.
46 * comm: (coreutils)comm invocation. Compare sorted files by line.
47 * cp: (coreutils)cp invocation. Copy files.
48 * csplit: (coreutils)csplit invocation. Split by context.
49 * cut: (coreutils)cut invocation. Print selected parts of lines.
50 * date: (coreutils)date invocation. Print/set system date and time.
51 * dd: (coreutils)dd invocation. Copy and convert a file.
52 * df: (coreutils)df invocation. Report file system disk usage.
53 * dir: (coreutils)dir invocation. List directories briefly.
54 * dircolors: (coreutils)dircolors invocation. Color setup for ls.
55 * dirname: (coreutils)dirname invocation. Strip non-directory suffix.
56 * du: (coreutils)du invocation. Report on disk usage.
57 * echo: (coreutils)echo invocation. Print a line of text.
58 * env: (coreutils)env invocation. Modify the environment.
59 * expand: (coreutils)expand invocation. Convert tabs to spaces.
60 * expr: (coreutils)expr invocation. Evaluate expressions.
61 * factor: (coreutils)factor invocation. Print prime factors
62 * false: (coreutils)false invocation. Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
63 * fmt: (coreutils)fmt invocation. Reformat paragraph text.
64 * fold: (coreutils)fold invocation. Wrap long input lines.
65 * groups: (coreutils)groups invocation. Print group names a user is in.
66 * head: (coreutils)head invocation. Output the first part of files.
67 * hostid: (coreutils)hostid invocation. Print numeric host identifier.
68 * hostname: (coreutils)hostname invocation. Print or set system name.
69 * id: (coreutils)id invocation. Print user identity.
70 * install: (coreutils)install invocation. Copy and change attributes.
71 * join: (coreutils)join invocation. Join lines on a common field.
72 * kill: (coreutils)kill invocation. Send a signal to processes.
73 * link: (coreutils)link invocation. Make hard links between files.
74 * ln: (coreutils)ln invocation. Make links between files.
75 * logname: (coreutils)logname invocation. Print current login name.
76 * ls: (coreutils)ls invocation. List directory contents.
77 * md5sum: (coreutils)md5sum invocation. Print or check MD5 digests.
78 * mkdir: (coreutils)mkdir invocation. Create directories.
79 * mkfifo: (coreutils)mkfifo invocation. Create FIFOs (named pipes).
80 * mknod: (coreutils)mknod invocation. Create special files.
81 * mv: (coreutils)mv invocation. Rename files.
82 * nice: (coreutils)nice invocation. Modify niceness.
83 * nl: (coreutils)nl invocation. Number lines and write files.
84 * nohup: (coreutils)nohup invocation. Immunize to hangups.
85 * od: (coreutils)od invocation. Dump files in octal, etc.
86 * paste: (coreutils)paste invocation. Merge lines of files.
87 * pathchk: (coreutils)pathchk invocation. Check file name portability.
88 * pr: (coreutils)pr invocation. Paginate or columnate files.
89 * printenv: (coreutils)printenv invocation. Print environment variables.
90 * printf: (coreutils)printf invocation. Format and print data.
91 * ptx: (coreutils)ptx invocation. Produce permuted indexes.
92 * pwd: (coreutils)pwd invocation. Print working directory.
93 * readlink: (coreutils)readlink invocation. Print referent of a symlink.
94 * rm: (coreutils)rm invocation. Remove files.
95 * rmdir: (coreutils)rmdir invocation. Remove empty directories.
96 * seq: (coreutils)seq invocation. Print numeric sequences
97 * sha1sum: (coreutils)sha1sum invocation. Print or check SHA-1 digests.
98 * sha2: (coreutils)sha2 utilities. Print or check SHA-2 digests.
99 * shred: (coreutils)shred invocation. Remove files more securely.
100 * shuf: (coreutils)shuf invocation. Shuffling text files.
101 * sleep: (coreutils)sleep invocation. Delay for a specified time.
102 * sort: (coreutils)sort invocation. Sort text files.
103 * split: (coreutils)split invocation. Split into fixed-size pieces.
104 * stat: (coreutils)stat invocation. Report file(system) status.
105 * stty: (coreutils)stty invocation. Print/change terminal settings.
106 * su: (coreutils)su invocation. Modify user and group ID.
107 * sum: (coreutils)sum invocation. Print traditional checksum.
108 * sync: (coreutils)sync invocation. Synchronize memory and disk.
109 * tac: (coreutils)tac invocation. Reverse files.
110 * tail: (coreutils)tail invocation. Output the last part of files.
111 * tee: (coreutils)tee invocation. Redirect to multiple files.
112 * test: (coreutils)test invocation. File/string tests.
113 * touch: (coreutils)touch invocation. Change file timestamps.
114 * tr: (coreutils)tr invocation. Translate characters.
115 * true: (coreutils)true invocation. Do nothing, successfully.
116 * tsort: (coreutils)tsort invocation. Topological sort.
117 * tty: (coreutils)tty invocation. Print terminal name.
118 * uname: (coreutils)uname invocation. Print system information.
119 * unexpand: (coreutils)unexpand invocation. Convert spaces to tabs.
120 * uniq: (coreutils)uniq invocation. Uniquify files.
121 * unlink: (coreutils)unlink invocation. Removal via unlink(2).
122 * users: (coreutils)users invocation. Print current user names.
123 * vdir: (coreutils)vdir invocation. List directories verbosely.
124 * wc: (coreutils)wc invocation. Line, word, and byte counts.
125 * who: (coreutils)who invocation. Print who is logged in.
126 * whoami: (coreutils)whoami invocation. Print effective user ID.
127 * yes: (coreutils)yes invocation. Print a string indefinitely.
131 This manual documents version @value{VERSION} of the @sc{gnu} core
132 utilities, including the standard programs for text and file manipulation.
134 Copyright @copyright{} 1994-1996, 2000-2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
137 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
138 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
139 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
140 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
141 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
142 Free Documentation License''.
147 @title @sc{gnu} @code{Coreutils}
148 @subtitle Core GNU utilities
149 @subtitle for version @value{VERSION}, @value{UPDATED}
150 @author David MacKenzie et al.
153 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
165 @cindex core utilities
166 @cindex text utilities
167 @cindex shell utilities
168 @cindex file utilities
171 * Introduction:: Caveats, overview, and authors.
172 * Common options:: Common options.
173 * Output of entire files:: cat tac nl od
174 * Formatting file contents:: fmt pr fold
175 * Output of parts of files:: head tail split csplit
176 * Summarizing files:: wc sum cksum md5sum sha1sum sha2
177 * Operating on sorted files:: sort shuf uniq comm ptx tsort
178 * Operating on fields within a line:: cut paste join
179 * Operating on characters:: tr expand unexpand
180 * Directory listing:: ls dir vdir dircolors
181 * Basic operations:: cp dd install mv rm shred
182 * Special file types:: ln mkdir rmdir mkfifo mknod
183 * Changing file attributes:: chgrp chmod chown touch
184 * Disk usage:: df du stat sync
185 * Printing text:: echo printf yes
186 * Conditions:: false true test expr
188 * File name manipulation:: dirname basename pathchk
189 * Working context:: pwd stty printenv tty
190 * User information:: id logname whoami groups users who
191 * System context:: date uname hostname hostid
192 * Modified command invocation:: chroot env nice nohup su
193 * Process control:: kill
195 * Numeric operations:: factor seq
196 * File permissions:: Access modes.
197 * Date input formats:: Specifying date strings.
198 * Opening the software toolbox:: The software tools philosophy.
199 * Copying This Manual:: License for copying this manual.
200 * Index:: General index.
203 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
207 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
208 * Backup options:: Backup options
209 * Block size:: Block size
210 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
211 * Random sources:: Sources of random data
212 * Target directory:: Target directory
213 * Trailing slashes:: Trailing slashes
214 * Traversing symlinks:: Traversing symlinks to directories
215 * Treating / specially:: Treating / specially
216 * Standards conformance:: Standards conformance
218 Output of entire files
220 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
221 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
222 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
223 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
224 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
226 Formatting file contents
228 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
229 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
230 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
232 Output of parts of files
234 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
235 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
236 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
237 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
241 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
242 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
243 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
244 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
245 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
246 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
248 Operating on sorted files
250 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
251 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
252 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
253 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
254 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
255 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
257 @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
259 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
260 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
261 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
262 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
263 * Compatibility in ptx:: The @acronym{GNU} extensions to @command{ptx}
265 Operating on fields within a line
267 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
268 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
269 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
271 Operating on characters
273 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
274 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
275 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
277 @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
279 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
280 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
281 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
285 * ls invocation:: List directory contents
286 * dir invocation:: Briefly list directory contents
287 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely list directory contents
288 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for @command{ls}
290 @command{ls}: List directory contents
292 * Which files are listed:: Which files are listed
293 * What information is listed:: What information is listed
294 * Sorting the output:: Sorting the output
295 * More details about version sort:: More details about version sort
296 * General output formatting:: General output formatting
297 * Formatting the file names:: Formatting the file names
301 * cp invocation:: Copy files and directories
302 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file
303 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes
304 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files
305 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories
306 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely
310 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
311 * ln invocation:: Make links between files
312 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories
313 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
314 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files
315 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link
316 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories
317 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via unlink syscall
319 Changing file attributes
321 * chown invocation:: Change file owner and group
322 * chgrp invocation:: Change group ownership
323 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions
324 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps
328 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage
329 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage
330 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status
331 * sync invocation:: Synchronize data on disk with memory
335 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text
336 * printf invocation:: Format and print data
337 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted
341 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
342 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully
343 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values
344 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions
346 @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
348 * File type tests:: File type tests
349 * Access permission tests:: Access permission tests
350 * File characteristic tests:: File characteristic tests
351 * String tests:: String tests
352 * Numeric tests:: Numeric tests
354 @command{expr}: Evaluate expression
356 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
357 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
358 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
359 * Examples of expr:: Examples of using @command{expr}
363 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files
365 File name manipulation
367 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
368 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
369 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability
373 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory
374 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics
375 * printenv invocation:: Print all or some environment variables
376 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input
378 @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
380 * Control:: Control settings
381 * Input:: Input settings
382 * Output:: Output settings
383 * Local:: Local settings
384 * Combination:: Combination settings
385 * Characters:: Special characters
386 * Special:: Special settings
390 * id invocation:: Print user identity
391 * logname invocation:: Print current login name
392 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID
393 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in
394 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in
395 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in
399 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time
400 * uname invocation:: Print system information
401 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name
402 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
404 @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
406 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
407 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
408 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
409 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
410 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
411 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
412 * Examples of date:: Examples.
414 Modified command invocation
416 * chroot invocation:: Run a command with a different root directory
417 * env invocation:: Run a command in a modified environment
418 * nice invocation:: Run a command with modified niceness
419 * nohup invocation:: Run a command immune to hangups
420 * su invocation:: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
424 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
428 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time
432 * factor invocation:: Print prime factors
433 * seq invocation:: Print numeric sequences
437 * Mode Structure:: Structure of file mode bits.
438 * Symbolic Modes:: Mnemonic representation of file mode bits.
439 * Numeric Modes:: File mode bits as octal numbers.
440 * Directory Setuid and Setgid:: Set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
444 * General date syntax:: Common rules.
445 * Calendar date items:: 19 Dec 1994.
446 * Time of day items:: 9:20pm.
447 * Time zone items:: @sc{est}, @sc{pdt}, @sc{gmt}.
448 * Day of week items:: Monday and others.
449 * Relative items in date strings:: next tuesday, 2 years ago.
450 * Pure numbers in date strings:: 19931219, 1440.
451 * Seconds since the Epoch:: @@1078100502.
452 * Specifying time zone rules:: TZ="America/New_York", TZ="UTC0".
453 * Authors of get_date:: Bellovin, Eggert, Salz, Berets, et al.
455 Opening the software toolbox
457 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
458 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
459 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
460 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
461 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
462 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
463 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
467 * GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual.
474 @chapter Introduction
476 This manual is a work in progress: many sections make no attempt to explain
477 basic concepts in a way suitable for novices. Thus, if you are interested,
478 please get involved in improving this manual. The entire @sc{gnu} community
481 @cindex @acronym{POSIX}
482 The @sc{gnu} utilities documented here are mostly compatible with the
483 @acronym{POSIX} standard.
484 @cindex bugs, reporting
485 Please report bugs to @email{bug-coreutils@@gnu.org}. Remember
486 to include the version number, machine architecture, input files, and
487 any other information needed to reproduce the bug: your input, what you
488 expected, what you got, and why it is wrong. Diffs are welcome, but
489 please include a description of the problem as well, since this is
490 sometimes difficult to infer. @xref{Bugs, , , gcc, Using and Porting GNU CC}.
496 @cindex MacKenzie, D.
499 This manual was originally derived from the Unix man pages in the
500 distributions, which were written by David MacKenzie and updated by Jim
501 Meyering. What you are reading now is the authoritative documentation
502 for these utilities; the man pages are no longer being maintained. The
503 original @command{fmt} man page was written by Ross Paterson. Fran@,{c}ois
504 Pinard did the initial conversion to Texinfo format. Karl Berry did the
505 indexing, some reorganization, and editing of the results. Brian
506 Youmans of the Free Software Foundation office staff combined the
507 manuals for textutils, fileutils, and sh-utils to produce the present
508 omnibus manual. Richard Stallman contributed his usual invaluable
509 insights to the overall process.
512 @chapter Common options
516 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
519 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
520 @cindex backups, making
521 @xref{Backup options}.
522 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
525 @macro optBackupSuffix
526 @item -S @var{suffix}
527 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
530 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}.
531 @xref{Backup options}.
534 @macro optTargetDirectory
535 @item -t @var{directory}
536 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
538 @opindex --target-directory
539 @cindex target directory
540 @cindex destination directory
541 Specify the destination @var{directory}.
542 @xref{Target directory}.
545 @macro optNoTargetDirectory
547 @itemx --no-target-directory
549 @opindex --no-target-directory
550 @cindex target directory
551 @cindex destination directory
552 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
553 symbolic link to a directory. @xref{Target directory}.
560 Append an SI-style abbreviation to each size, such as @samp{M} for
561 megabytes. Powers of 1000 are used, not 1024; @samp{M} stands for
562 1,000,000 bytes. This option is equivalent to
563 @option{--block-size=si}. Use the @option{-h} or
564 @option{--human-readable} option if
565 you prefer powers of 1024.
568 @macro optHumanReadable
570 @itemx --human-readable
572 @opindex --human-readable
573 @cindex human-readable output
574 Append a size letter to each size, such as @samp{M} for mebibytes.
575 Powers of 1024 are used, not 1000; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
576 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=human-readable}.
577 Use the @option{--si} option if you prefer powers of 1000.
580 @macro optStripTrailingSlashes
581 @itemx @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}}
582 @opindex --strip-trailing-slashes
583 @cindex stripping trailing slashes
584 Remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument.
585 @xref{Trailing slashes}.
588 @cindex common options
590 Certain options are available in all of these programs. Rather than
591 writing identical descriptions for each of the programs, they are
592 described here. (In fact, every @sc{gnu} program accepts (or should accept)
595 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
596 Normally options and operands can appear in any order, and programs act
597 as if all the options appear before any operands. For example,
598 @samp{sort -r passwd -t :} acts like @samp{sort -r -t : passwd}, since
599 @samp{:} is an option-argument of @option{-t}. However, if the
600 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, options must appear
601 before operands, unless otherwise specified for a particular command.
603 A few programs can usefully have trailing operands with leading
604 @samp{-}. With such a program, options must precede operands even if
605 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is not set, and this fact is noted in the
606 program description. For example, the @command{env} command's options
607 must appear before its operands, since in some cases the operands
608 specify a command that itself contains options.
610 Some of these programs recognize the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
611 options only when one of them is the sole command line argument.
618 Print a usage message listing all available options, then exit successfully.
622 @cindex version number, finding
623 Print the version number, then exit successfully.
627 @cindex option delimiter
628 Delimit the option list. Later arguments, if any, are treated as
629 operands even if they begin with @samp{-}. For example, @samp{sort --
630 -r} reads from the file named @file{-r}.
634 @cindex standard input
635 @cindex standard output
636 A single @samp{-} operand is not really an option, though it looks like one. It
637 stands for standard input, or for standard output if that is clear from
638 the context. For example, @samp{sort -} reads from standard input,
639 and is equivalent to plain @samp{sort}, and @samp{tee -} writes an
640 extra copy of its input to standard output. Unless otherwise
641 specified, @samp{-} can appear as any operand that requires a file
645 * Exit status:: Indicating program success or failure.
646 * Backup options:: -b -S, in some programs.
647 * Block size:: BLOCK_SIZE and --block-size, in some programs.
648 * Disambiguating names and IDs:: chgrp and chown owner and group syntax
649 * Random sources:: --random-source, in some programs.
650 * Target directory:: Specifying a target directory, in some programs.
651 * Trailing slashes:: --strip-trailing-slashes, in some programs.
652 * Traversing symlinks:: -H, -L, or -P, in some programs.
653 * Treating / specially:: --preserve-root and --no-preserve-root.
654 * Special built-in utilities:: @command{break}, @command{:}, @command{eval}, @dots{}
655 * Standards conformance:: Conformance to the @acronym{POSIX} standard.
663 An exit status of zero indicates success,
664 and a nonzero value indicates failure.
667 Nearly every command invocation yields an integral @dfn{exit status}
668 that can be used to change how other commands work.
669 For the vast majority of commands, an exit status of zero indicates
670 success. Failure is indicated by a nonzero value---typically
671 @samp{1}, though it may differ on unusual platforms as @acronym{POSIX}
672 requires only that it be nonzero.
674 However, some of the programs documented here do produce
675 other exit status values and a few associate different
676 meanings with the values @samp{0} and @samp{1}.
677 Here are some of the exceptions:
678 @command{chroot}, @command{env}, @command{expr},
679 @command{nice}, @command{nohup}, @command{printenv},
680 @command{sort}, @command{su}, @command{test}, @command{tty}.
684 @section Backup options
686 @cindex backup options
688 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp}, @command{install},
689 @command{ln}, and @command{mv}) optionally make backups of files
690 before writing new versions.
691 These options control the details of these backups. The options are also
692 briefly mentioned in the descriptions of the particular programs.
697 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
700 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
701 @cindex backups, making
702 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
703 Without this option, the original versions are destroyed.
704 Use @var{method} to determine the type of backups to make.
705 When this option is used but @var{method} is not specified,
706 then the value of the @env{VERSION_CONTROL}
707 environment variable is used. And if @env{VERSION_CONTROL} is not set,
708 the default backup type is @samp{existing}.
710 Note that the short form of this option, @option{-b} does not accept any
711 argument. Using @option{-b} is equivalent to using @option{--backup=existing}.
713 @vindex version-control @r{Emacs variable}
714 This option corresponds to the Emacs variable @samp{version-control};
715 the values for @var{method} are the same as those used in Emacs.
716 This option also accepts more descriptive names.
717 The valid @var{method}s are (unique abbreviations are accepted):
722 @opindex none @r{backup method}
727 @opindex numbered @r{backup method}
728 Always make numbered backups.
732 @opindex existing @r{backup method}
733 Make numbered backups of files that already have them, simple backups
738 @opindex simple @r{backup method}
739 Always make simple backups. Please note @samp{never} is not to be
740 confused with @samp{none}.
744 @item -S @var{suffix}
745 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
748 @cindex backup suffix
749 @vindex SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX
750 Append @var{suffix} to each backup file made with @option{-b}. If this
751 option is not specified, the value of the @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX}
752 environment variable is used. And if @env{SIMPLE_BACKUP_SUFFIX} is not
753 set, the default is @samp{~}, just as in Emacs.
762 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{df}, @command{du}, and
763 @command{ls}) display sizes in ``blocks''. You can adjust the block size
764 and method of display to make sizes easier to read. The block size
765 used for display is independent of any file system block size.
766 Fractional block counts are rounded up to the nearest integer.
768 @opindex --block-size=@var{size}
771 @vindex DF_BLOCK_SIZE
772 @vindex DU_BLOCK_SIZE
773 @vindex LS_BLOCK_SIZE
774 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT@r{, and block size}
776 The default block size is chosen by examining the following environment
777 variables in turn; the first one that is set determines the block size.
782 This specifies the default block size for the @command{df} command.
783 Similarly, @env{DU_BLOCK_SIZE} specifies the default for @command{du} and
784 @env{LS_BLOCK_SIZE} for @command{ls}.
787 This specifies the default block size for all three commands, if the
788 above command-specific environment variables are not set.
791 This specifies the default block size for all values that are normally
792 printed as blocks, if neither @env{BLOCK_SIZE} nor the above
793 command-specific environment variables are set. Unlike the other
794 environment variables, @env{BLOCKSIZE} does not affect values that are
795 normally printed as byte counts, e.g., the file sizes contained in
798 @item POSIXLY_CORRECT
799 If neither @env{@var{command}_BLOCK_SIZE}, nor @env{BLOCK_SIZE}, nor
800 @env{BLOCKSIZE} is set, but this variable is set, the block size
805 If none of the above environment variables are set, the block size
806 currently defaults to 1024 bytes in most contexts, but this number may
807 change in the future. For @command{ls} file sizes, the block size
810 @cindex human-readable output
813 A block size specification can be a positive integer specifying the number
814 of bytes per block, or it can be @code{human-readable} or @code{si} to
815 select a human-readable format. Integers may be followed by suffixes
816 that are upward compatible with the
817 @uref{http://www.bipm.fr/enus/3_SI/si-prefixes.html, SI prefixes}
818 for decimal multiples and with the
819 @uref{http://physics.nist.gov/cuu/Units/binary.html, IEC 60027-2
820 prefixes for binary multiples}.
822 With human-readable formats, output sizes are followed by a size letter
823 such as @samp{M} for megabytes. @code{BLOCK_SIZE=human-readable} uses
824 powers of 1024; @samp{M} stands for 1,048,576 bytes.
825 @code{BLOCK_SIZE=si} is similar, but uses powers of 1000 and appends
826 @samp{B}; @samp{MB} stands for 1,000,000 bytes.
829 A block size specification preceded by @samp{'} causes output sizes to
830 be displayed with thousands separators. The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale
831 specifies the thousands separator and grouping. For example, in an
832 American English locale, @samp{--block-size="'1kB"} would cause a size
833 of 1234000 bytes to be displayed as @samp{1,234}. In the default C
834 locale, there is no thousands separator so a leading @samp{'} has no
837 An integer block size can be followed by a suffix to specify a
838 multiple of that size. A bare size letter,
839 or one followed by @samp{iB}, specifies
840 a multiple using powers of 1024. A size letter followed by @samp{B}
841 specifies powers of 1000 instead. For example, @samp{1M} and
842 @samp{1MiB} are equivalent to @samp{1048576}, whereas @samp{1MB} is
843 equivalent to @samp{1000000}.
845 A plain suffix without a preceding integer acts as if @samp{1} were
846 prepended, except that it causes a size indication to be appended to
847 the output. For example, @samp{--block-size="kB"} displays 3000 as
850 The following suffixes are defined. Large sizes like @code{1Y}
851 may be rejected by your computer due to limitations of its arithmetic.
855 @cindex kilobyte, definition of
856 kilobyte: @math{10^3 = 1000}.
860 @cindex kibibyte, definition of
861 kibibyte: @math{2^10 = 1024}. @samp{K} is special: the SI prefix is
862 @samp{k} and the IEC 60027-2 prefix is @samp{Ki}, but tradition and
863 @acronym{POSIX} use @samp{k} to mean @samp{KiB}.
865 @cindex megabyte, definition of
866 megabyte: @math{10^6 = 1,000,000}.
869 @cindex mebibyte, definition of
870 mebibyte: @math{2^20 = 1,048,576}.
872 @cindex gigabyte, definition of
873 gigabyte: @math{10^9 = 1,000,000,000}.
876 @cindex gibibyte, definition of
877 gibibyte: @math{2^30 = 1,073,741,824}.
879 @cindex terabyte, definition of
880 terabyte: @math{10^12 = 1,000,000,000,000}.
883 @cindex tebibyte, definition of
884 tebibyte: @math{2^40 = 1,099,511,627,776}.
886 @cindex petabyte, definition of
887 petabyte: @math{10^15 = 1,000,000,000,000,000}.
890 @cindex pebibyte, definition of
891 pebibyte: @math{2^50 = 1,125,899,906,842,624}.
893 @cindex exabyte, definition of
894 exabyte: @math{10^18 = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
897 @cindex exbibyte, definition of
898 exbibyte: @math{2^60 = 1,152,921,504,606,846,976}.
900 @cindex zettabyte, definition of
901 zettabyte: @math{10^21 = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}
904 @math{2^70 = 1,180,591,620,717,411,303,424}.
905 (@samp{Zi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
907 @cindex yottabyte, definition of
908 yottabyte: @math{10^24 = 1,000,000,000,000,000,000,000,000}.
911 @math{2^80 = 1,208,925,819,614,629,174,706,176}.
912 (@samp{Yi} is a @acronym{GNU} extension to IEC 60027-2.)
917 @opindex --block-size
918 @opindex --human-readable
921 Block size defaults can be overridden by an explicit
922 @option{--block-size=@var{size}} option. The @option{-k}
923 option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}, which
924 is the default unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is
925 set. The @option{-h} or @option{--human-readable} option is equivalent to
926 @option{--block-size=human-readable}. The @option{--si} option is
927 equivalent to @option{--block-size=si}.
929 @node Disambiguating names and IDs
930 @section chown and chgrp: Disambiguating user names and IDs
931 @cindex user names, disambiguating
932 @cindex user IDs, disambiguating
933 @cindex group names, disambiguating
934 @cindex group IDs, disambiguating
935 @cindex disambiguating group names and IDs
937 Since the @var{owner} and @var{group} arguments to @command{chown} and
938 @command{chgrp} may be specified as names or numeric IDs, there is an
940 What if a user or group @emph{name} is a string of digits?
941 @footnote{Using a number as a user name is common in some environments.}
942 Should the command interpret it as a user name or as an ID?
943 @acronym{POSIX} requires that @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
944 first attempt to resolve the specified string as a name, and
945 only once that fails, then try to interpret it as an ID.
946 This is troublesome when you want to specify a numeric ID, say 42,
947 and it must work even in a pathological situation where
948 @samp{42} is a user name that maps to some other user ID, say 1000.
949 Simply invoking @code{chown 42 F}, will set @file{F}s owner ID to
950 1000---not what you intended.
952 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp} provide a way to work around this,
953 that at the same time may result in a significant performance improvement
954 by eliminating a database look-up.
955 Simply precede each numeric user ID and/or group ID with a @samp{+},
956 in order to force its interpretation as an integer:
960 chgrp +$numeric_group_id another-file
964 GNU @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
965 skip the name look-up process for each @samp{+}-prefixed string,
966 because a string containing @samp{+} is never a valid user or group name.
967 This syntax is accepted on most common Unix systems, but not on Solaris 10.
970 @section Sources of random data
972 @cindex random sources
974 The @command{shuf}, @command{shred}, and @command{sort} commands
975 sometimes need random data to do their work. For example, @samp{sort
976 -R} must choose a hash function at random, and it needs random data to
979 Normally these commands use the device file @file{/dev/urandom} as the
980 source of random data. Typically, this device gathers environmental
981 noise from device drivers and other sources into an entropy pool, and
982 uses the pool to generate random bits. If the pool is short of data,
983 the device reuses the internal pool to produce more bits, using a
984 cryptographically secure pseudorandom number generator.
986 @file{/dev/urandom} suffices for most practical uses, but applications
987 requiring high-value or long-term protection of private data may
988 require an alternate data source like @file{/dev/random} or
989 @file{/dev/arandom}. The set of available sources depends on your
992 To use such a source, specify the @option{--random-source=@var{file}}
993 option, e.g., @samp{shuf --random-source=/dev/random}. The contents
994 of @var{file} should be as random as possible. An error is reported
995 if @var{file} does not contain enough bytes to randomize the input
998 To reproduce the results of an earlier invocation of a command, you
999 can save some random data into a file and then use that file as the
1000 random source in earlier and later invocations of the command.
1002 Some old-fashioned or stripped-down operating systems lack support for
1003 @command{/dev/urandom}. On these systems commands like @command{shuf}
1004 by default fall back on an internal pseudorandom generator initialized
1005 by a small amount of entropy.
1007 @node Target directory
1008 @section Target directory
1010 @cindex target directory
1012 The @command{cp}, @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv}
1013 commands normally treat the last operand specially when it is a
1014 directory or a symbolic link to a directory. For example, @samp{cp
1015 source dest} is equivalent to @samp{cp source dest/source} if
1016 @file{dest} is a directory. Sometimes this behavior is not exactly
1017 what is wanted, so these commands support the following options to
1018 allow more fine-grained control:
1023 @itemx --no-target-directory
1024 @opindex --no-target-directory
1025 @cindex target directory
1026 @cindex destination directory
1027 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a directory or a
1028 symbolic link to a directory. This can help avoid race conditions in
1029 programs that operate in a shared area. For example, when the command
1030 @samp{mv /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no guarantee that
1031 @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}: it could have been
1032 renamed to @file{/tmp/dest/source} instead, if some other process
1033 created @file{/tmp/dest} as a directory. However, if @file{mv
1034 -T /tmp/source /tmp/dest} succeeds, there is no
1035 question that @file{/tmp/source} was renamed to @file{/tmp/dest}.
1037 In the opposite situation, where you want the last operand to be
1038 treated as a directory and want a diagnostic otherwise, you can use
1039 the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option.
1041 @item -t @var{directory}
1042 @itemx @w{@kbd{--target-directory}=@var{directory}}
1043 @opindex --target-directory
1044 @cindex target directory
1045 @cindex destination directory
1046 Use @var{directory} as the directory component of each destination
1049 The interface for most programs is that after processing options and a
1050 finite (possibly zero) number of fixed-position arguments, the remaining
1051 argument list is either expected to be empty, or is a list of items
1052 (usually files) that will all be handled identically. The @command{xargs}
1053 program is designed to work well with this convention.
1055 The commands in the @command{mv}-family are unusual in that they take
1056 a variable number of arguments with a special case at the @emph{end}
1057 (namely, the target directory). This makes it nontrivial to perform some
1058 operations, e.g., ``move all files from here to ../d/'', because
1059 @code{mv * ../d/} might exhaust the argument space, and @code{ls | xargs ...}
1060 doesn't have a clean way to specify an extra final argument for each
1061 invocation of the subject command. (It can be done by going through a
1062 shell command, but that requires more human labor and brain power than
1065 The @w{@kbd{--target-directory}} (@option{-t}) option allows the @command{cp},
1066 @command{install}, @command{ln}, and @command{mv} programs to be used
1067 conveniently with @command{xargs}. For example, you can move the files
1068 from the current directory to a sibling directory, @code{d} like this:
1071 ls | xargs mv -t ../d --
1074 However, this doesn't move files whose names begin with @samp{.}.
1075 If you use the @sc{gnu} @command{find} program, you can move those
1076 files too, with this command:
1079 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 \
1083 But both of the above approaches fail if there are no files in the
1084 current directory, or if any file has a name containing a blank or
1085 some other special characters.
1086 The following example removes those limitations and requires both
1087 @sc{gnu} @command{find} and @sc{gnu} @command{xargs}:
1090 find . -mindepth 1 -maxdepth 1 -print0 \
1091 | xargs --null --no-run-if-empty \
1098 The @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) and
1099 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T})
1100 options cannot be combined.
1102 @node Trailing slashes
1103 @section Trailing slashes
1105 @cindex trailing slashes
1107 Some @sc{gnu} programs (at least @command{cp} and @command{mv}) allow you to
1108 remove any trailing slashes from each @var{source} argument before
1109 operating on it. The @w{@kbd{--strip-trailing-slashes}} option enables
1112 This is useful when a @var{source} argument may have a trailing slash and
1113 @c FIXME: mv's behavior in this case is system-dependent
1114 specify a symbolic link to a directory. This scenario is in fact rather
1115 common because some shells can automatically append a trailing slash when
1116 performing file name completion on such symbolic links. Without this
1117 option, @command{mv}, for example, (via the system's rename function) must
1118 interpret a trailing slash as a request to dereference the symbolic link
1119 and so must rename the indirectly referenced @emph{directory} and not
1120 the symbolic link. Although it may seem surprising that such behavior
1121 be the default, it is required by @acronym{POSIX} and is consistent with
1122 other parts of that standard.
1124 @node Traversing symlinks
1125 @section Traversing symlinks
1127 @cindex symbolic link to directory, controlling traversal of
1129 The following options modify how @command{chown} and @command{chgrp}
1130 @c FIXME: note that `du' has these options, too, but they have slightly
1131 @c different meaning.
1132 traverse a hierarchy when the @option{--recursive} (@option{-R})
1133 option is also specified.
1134 If more than one of the following options is specified, only the final
1136 These options specify whether processing a symbolic link to a directory
1137 entails operating on just the symbolic link or on all files in the
1138 hierarchy rooted at that directory.
1140 These options are independent of @option{--dereference} and
1141 @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-h}), which control whether to modify
1142 a symlink or its referent.
1149 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is specified on the command line
1150 If @option{--recursive} (@option{-R}) is specified and
1151 a command line argument is a symbolic link to a directory, traverse it.
1158 @cindex symbolic link to directory, traverse each that is encountered
1159 In a recursive traversal, traverse every symbolic link to a directory
1160 that is encountered.
1167 @cindex symbolic link to directory, never traverse
1168 Do not traverse any symbolic links.
1169 This is the default if none of @option{-H}, @option{-L},
1170 or @option{-P} is specified.
1177 @node Treating / specially
1178 @section Treating / specially
1180 Certain commands can operate destructively on entire hierarchies.
1181 For example, if a user with appropriate privileges mistakenly runs
1182 @samp{rm -rf / tmp/junk}, that may remove
1183 all files on the entire system. Since there are so few
1184 legitimate uses for such a command,
1185 @sc{gnu} @command{rm} normally declines to operate on any directory
1186 that resolves to @file{/}. If you really want to try to remove all
1187 the files on your system, you can use the @option{--no-preserve-root}
1188 option, but the default behavior, specified by the
1189 @option{--preserve-option}, is safer for most purposes.
1191 The commands @command{chgrp}, @command{chmod} and @command{chown}
1192 can also operate destructively on entire hierarchies, so they too
1193 support these options. Although, unlike @command{rm}, they don't
1194 actually unlink files, these commands are arguably more dangerous
1195 when operating recursively on @file{/}, since they often work much
1196 more quickly, and hence damage more files before an alert user can
1197 interrupt them. Tradition and @acronym{POSIX} require these commands
1198 to operate recursively on @file{/}, so they default to
1199 @option{--no-preserve-root}, but using the @option{--preserve-root}
1200 option makes them safer for most purposes. For convenience you can
1201 specify @option{--preserve-root} in an alias or in a shell function.
1203 Note that the @option{--preserve-root} option also ensures
1204 that @command{chgrp} and @command{chown} do not modify @file{/}
1205 even when dereferencing a symlink pointing to @file{/}.
1207 @node Special built-in utilities
1208 @section Special built-in utilities
1210 Some programs like @command{nice} can invoke other programs; for
1211 example, the command @samp{nice cat file} invokes the program
1212 @command{cat} by executing the command @samp{cat file}. However,
1213 @dfn{special built-in utilities} like @command{exit} cannot be invoked
1214 this way. For example, the command @samp{nice exit} does not have a
1215 well-defined behavior: it may generate an error message instead of
1218 Here is a list of the special built-in utilities that are standardized
1219 by @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2004.
1222 @t{.@: : break continue eval exec exit export readonly
1223 return set shift times trap unset}
1226 For example, because @samp{.}, @samp{:}, and @samp{exec} are special,
1227 the commands @samp{nice . foo.sh}, @samp{nice :}, and @samp{nice exec
1228 pwd} do not work as you might expect.
1230 Many shells extend this list. For example, Bash has several extra
1231 special built-in utilities like @command{history}, and
1232 @command{suspend}, and with Bash the command @samp{nice suspend}
1233 generates an error message instead of suspending.
1235 @node Standards conformance
1236 @section Standards conformance
1238 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
1239 In a few cases, the @sc{gnu} utilities' default behavior is
1240 incompatible with the @acronym{POSIX} standard. To suppress these
1241 incompatibilities, define the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment
1242 variable. Unless you are checking for @acronym{POSIX} conformance, you
1243 probably do not need to define @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}.
1245 Newer versions of @acronym{POSIX} are occasionally incompatible with older
1246 versions. For example, older versions of @acronym{POSIX} required the
1247 command @samp{sort +1} to sort based on the second and succeeding
1248 fields in each input line, but starting with @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001
1249 the same command is required to sort the file named @file{+1}, and you
1250 must instead use the command @samp{sort -k 2} to get the field-based
1253 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
1254 The @sc{gnu} utilities normally conform to the version of @acronym{POSIX}
1255 that is standard for your system. To cause them to conform to a
1256 different version of @acronym{POSIX}, define the @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}
1257 environment variable to a value of the form @var{yyyymm} specifying
1258 the year and month the standard was adopted. Two values are currently
1259 supported for @env{_POSIX2_VERSION}: @samp{199209} stands for
1260 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.2-1992, and @samp{200112} stands for @acronym{POSIX}
1261 1003.1-2001. For example, if you have a newer system but are running software
1262 that assumes an older version of @acronym{POSIX} and uses @samp{sort +1}
1263 or @samp{tail +10}, you can work around any compatibility problems by setting
1264 @samp{_POSIX2_VERSION=199209} in your environment.
1266 @node Output of entire files
1267 @chapter Output of entire files
1269 @cindex output of entire files
1270 @cindex entire files, output of
1272 These commands read and write entire files, possibly transforming them
1276 * cat invocation:: Concatenate and write files.
1277 * tac invocation:: Concatenate and write files in reverse.
1278 * nl invocation:: Number lines and write files.
1279 * od invocation:: Write files in octal or other formats.
1280 * base64 invocation:: Transform data into printable data.
1283 @node cat invocation
1284 @section @command{cat}: Concatenate and write files
1287 @cindex concatenate and write files
1288 @cindex copying files
1290 @command{cat} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1291 standard input if none are given, to standard output. Synopsis:
1294 cat [@var{option}] [@var{file}]@dots{}
1297 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1305 Equivalent to @option{-vET}.
1308 @itemx --number-nonblank
1310 @opindex --number-nonblank
1311 Number all nonempty output lines, starting with 1.
1315 Equivalent to @option{-vE}.
1320 @opindex --show-ends
1321 Display a @samp{$} after the end of each line.
1327 Number all output lines, starting with 1.
1330 @itemx --squeeze-blank
1332 @opindex --squeeze-blank
1333 @cindex squeezing empty lines
1334 Suppress repeated adjacent empty lines; output just one empty line
1339 Equivalent to @option{-vT}.
1344 @opindex --show-tabs
1345 Display TAB characters as @samp{^I}.
1349 Ignored; for @acronym{POSIX} compatibility.
1352 @itemx --show-nonprinting
1354 @opindex --show-nonprinting
1355 Display control characters except for LFD and TAB using
1356 @samp{^} notation and precede characters that have the high bit set with
1361 On systems like MS-DOS that distinguish between text and binary files,
1362 @command{cat} normally reads and writes in binary mode. However,
1363 @command{cat} reads in text mode if one of the options
1364 @option{-bensAE} is used or if @command{cat} is reading from standard
1365 input and standard input is a terminal. Similarly, @command{cat}
1366 writes in text mode if one of the options @option{-bensAE} is used or
1367 if standard output is a terminal.
1374 # Output f's contents, then standard input, then g's contents.
1377 # Copy standard input to standard output.
1382 @node tac invocation
1383 @section @command{tac}: Concatenate and write files in reverse
1386 @cindex reversing files
1388 @command{tac} copies each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1389 standard input if none are given, to standard output, reversing the
1390 records (lines by default) in each separately. Synopsis:
1393 tac [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1396 @dfn{Records} are separated by instances of a string (newline by
1397 default). By default, this separator string is attached to the end of
1398 the record that it follows in the file.
1400 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1408 The separator is attached to the beginning of the record that it
1409 precedes in the file.
1415 Treat the separator string as a regular expression. Users of @command{tac}
1416 on MS-DOS/MS-Windows should note that, since @command{tac} reads files in
1417 binary mode, each line of a text file might end with a CR/LF pair
1418 instead of the Unix-style LF.
1420 @item -s @var{separator}
1421 @itemx --separator=@var{separator}
1423 @opindex --separator
1424 Use @var{separator} as the record separator, instead of newline.
1432 @section @command{nl}: Number lines and write files
1435 @cindex numbering lines
1436 @cindex line numbering
1438 @command{nl} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
1439 standard input if none are given, to standard output, with line numbers
1440 added to some or all of the lines. Synopsis:
1443 nl [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1446 @cindex logical pages, numbering on
1447 @command{nl} decomposes its input into (logical) pages; by default, the
1448 line number is reset to 1 at the top of each logical page. @command{nl}
1449 treats all of the input files as a single document; it does not reset
1450 line numbers or logical pages between files.
1452 @cindex headers, numbering
1453 @cindex body, numbering
1454 @cindex footers, numbering
1455 A logical page consists of three sections: header, body, and footer.
1456 Any of the sections can be empty. Each can be numbered in a different
1457 style from the others.
1459 The beginnings of the sections of logical pages are indicated in the
1460 input file by a line containing exactly one of these delimiter strings:
1471 The two characters from which these strings are made can be changed from
1472 @samp{\} and @samp{:} via options (see below), but the pattern and
1473 length of each string cannot be changed.
1475 A section delimiter is replaced by an empty line on output. Any text
1476 that comes before the first section delimiter string in the input file
1477 is considered to be part of a body section, so @command{nl} treats a
1478 file that contains no section delimiters as a single body section.
1480 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1484 @item -b @var{style}
1485 @itemx --body-numbering=@var{style}
1487 @opindex --body-numbering
1488 Select the numbering style for lines in the body section of each
1489 logical page. When a line is not numbered, the current line number
1490 is not incremented, but the line number separator character is still
1491 prepended to the line. The styles are:
1497 number only nonempty lines (default for body),
1499 do not number lines (default for header and footer),
1501 number only lines that contain a match for the basic regular
1502 expression @var{bre}.
1503 @xref{Regular Expressions, , Regular Expressions, grep, The GNU Grep Manual}.
1507 @itemx --section-delimiter=@var{cd}
1509 @opindex --section-delimiter
1510 @cindex section delimiters of pages
1511 Set the section delimiter characters to @var{cd}; default is
1512 @samp{\:}. If only @var{c} is given, the second remains @samp{:}.
1513 (Remember to protect @samp{\} or other metacharacters from shell
1514 expansion with quotes or extra backslashes.)
1516 @item -f @var{style}
1517 @itemx --footer-numbering=@var{style}
1519 @opindex --footer-numbering
1520 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1522 @item -h @var{style}
1523 @itemx --header-numbering=@var{style}
1525 @opindex --header-numbering
1526 Analogous to @option{--body-numbering}.
1528 @item -i @var{number}
1529 @itemx --page-increment=@var{number}
1531 @opindex --page-increment
1532 Increment line numbers by @var{number} (default 1).
1534 @item -l @var{number}
1535 @itemx --join-blank-lines=@var{number}
1537 @opindex --join-blank-lines
1538 @cindex empty lines, numbering
1539 @cindex blank lines, numbering
1540 Consider @var{number} (default 1) consecutive empty lines to be one
1541 logical line for numbering, and only number the last one. Where fewer
1542 than @var{number} consecutive empty lines occur, do not number them.
1543 An empty line is one that contains no characters, not even spaces
1546 @item -n @var{format}
1547 @itemx --number-format=@var{format}
1549 @opindex --number-format
1550 Select the line numbering format (default is @code{rn}):
1554 @opindex ln @r{format for @command{nl}}
1555 left justified, no leading zeros;
1557 @opindex rn @r{format for @command{nl}}
1558 right justified, no leading zeros;
1560 @opindex rz @r{format for @command{nl}}
1561 right justified, leading zeros.
1565 @itemx --no-renumber
1567 @opindex --no-renumber
1568 Do not reset the line number at the start of a logical page.
1570 @item -s @var{string}
1571 @itemx --number-separator=@var{string}
1573 @opindex --number-separator
1574 Separate the line number from the text line in the output with
1575 @var{string} (default is the TAB character).
1577 @item -v @var{number}
1578 @itemx --starting-line-number=@var{number}
1580 @opindex --starting-line-number
1581 Set the initial line number on each logical page to @var{number} (default 1).
1583 @item -w @var{number}
1584 @itemx --number-width=@var{number}
1586 @opindex --number-width
1587 Use @var{number} characters for line numbers (default 6).
1595 @section @command{od}: Write files in octal or other formats
1598 @cindex octal dump of files
1599 @cindex hex dump of files
1600 @cindex ASCII dump of files
1601 @cindex file contents, dumping unambiguously
1603 @command{od} writes an unambiguous representation of each @var{file}
1604 (@samp{-} means standard input), or standard input if none are given.
1608 od [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1609 od [-abcdfilosx]@dots{} [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b]]
1610 od [@var{option}]@dots{} --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1613 Each line of output consists of the offset in the input, followed by
1614 groups of data from the file. By default, @command{od} prints the offset in
1615 octal, and each group of file data is a C @code{short int}'s worth of input
1616 printed as a single octal number.
1618 If @var{offset} is given, it specifies how many input bytes to skip
1619 before formatting and writing. By default, it is interpreted as an
1620 octal number, but the optional trailing decimal point causes it to be
1621 interpreted as decimal. If no decimal is specified and the offset
1622 begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} it is interpreted as a hexadecimal
1623 number. If there is a trailing @samp{b}, the number of bytes skipped
1624 will be @var{offset} multiplied by 512.
1626 If a command is of both the first and second forms, the second form is
1627 assumed if the last operand begins with @samp{+} or (if there are two
1628 operands) a digit. For example, in @samp{od foo 10} and @samp{od +10}
1629 the @samp{10} is an offset, whereas in @samp{od 10} the @samp{10} is a
1632 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1636 @item -A @var{radix}
1637 @itemx --address-radix=@var{radix}
1639 @opindex --address-radix
1640 @cindex radix for file offsets
1641 @cindex file offset radix
1642 Select the base in which file offsets are printed. @var{radix} can
1643 be one of the following:
1653 none (do not print offsets).
1656 The default is octal.
1658 @item -j @var{bytes}
1659 @itemx --skip-bytes=@var{bytes}
1661 @opindex --skip-bytes
1662 Skip @var{bytes} input bytes before formatting and writing. If
1663 @var{bytes} begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}, it is interpreted in
1664 hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0}, in octal; otherwise,
1665 in decimal. Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
1666 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
1667 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
1668 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{GB} by 1024*1024*1024,
1669 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
1671 @item -N @var{bytes}
1672 @itemx --read-bytes=@var{bytes}
1674 @opindex --read-bytes
1675 Output at most @var{bytes} bytes of the input. Prefixes and suffixes on
1676 @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the @option{-j} option.
1678 @item -S @var{bytes}
1679 @itemx --strings[=@var{bytes}]
1682 @cindex string constants, outputting
1683 Instead of the normal output, output only @dfn{string constants}: at
1684 least @var{bytes} consecutive @acronym{ASCII} graphic characters,
1685 followed by a null (zero) byte.
1686 Prefixes and suffixes on @code{bytes} are interpreted as for the
1689 If @var{n} is omitted with @option{--strings}, the default is 3.
1692 @itemx --format=@var{type}
1695 Select the format in which to output the file data. @var{type} is a
1696 string of one or more of the below type indicator characters. If you
1697 include more than one type indicator character in a single @var{type}
1698 string, or use this option more than once, @command{od} writes one copy
1699 of each output line using each of the data types that you specified,
1700 in the order that you specified.
1702 Adding a trailing ``z'' to any type specification appends a display
1703 of the @acronym{ASCII} character representation of the printable characters
1704 to the output line generated by the type specification.
1708 named character, ignoring high-order bit
1710 @acronym{ASCII} character or backslash escape,
1723 The type @code{a} outputs things like @samp{sp} for space, @samp{nl} for
1724 newline, and @samp{nul} for a null (zero) byte. Only the least significant
1725 seven bits of each byte is used; the high-order bit is ignored.
1726 Type @code{c} outputs
1727 @samp{ }, @samp{\n}, and @code{\0}, respectively.
1730 Except for types @samp{a} and @samp{c}, you can specify the number
1731 of bytes to use in interpreting each number in the given data type
1732 by following the type indicator character with a decimal integer.
1733 Alternately, you can specify the size of one of the C compiler's
1734 built-in data types by following the type indicator character with
1735 one of the following characters. For integers (@samp{d}, @samp{o},
1736 @samp{u}, @samp{x}):
1749 For floating point (@code{f}):
1761 @itemx --output-duplicates
1763 @opindex --output-duplicates
1764 Output consecutive lines that are identical. By default, when two or
1765 more consecutive output lines would be identical, @command{od} outputs only
1766 the first line, and puts just an asterisk on the following line to
1767 indicate the elision.
1770 @itemx --width[=@var{n}]
1773 Dump @code{n} input bytes per output line. This must be a multiple of
1774 the least common multiple of the sizes associated with the specified
1777 If this option is not given at all, the default is 16. If @var{n} is
1778 omitted, the default is 32.
1782 The next several options are shorthands for format specifications.
1783 @sc{gnu} @command{od} accepts any combination of shorthands and format
1784 specification options. These options accumulate.
1790 Output as named characters. Equivalent to @samp{-t a}.
1794 Output as octal bytes. Equivalent to @samp{-t o1}.
1798 Output as @acronym{ASCII} characters or backslash escapes. Equivalent to
1803 Output as unsigned decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t u2}.
1807 Output as floats. Equivalent to @samp{-t fF}.
1811 Output as decimal ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dI}.
1815 Output as decimal long ints. Equivalent to @samp{-t dL}.
1819 Output as octal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t o2}.
1823 Output as decimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @option{-t d2}.
1827 Output as hexadecimal two-byte units. Equivalent to @samp{-t x2}.
1830 @opindex --traditional
1831 Recognize the non-option label argument that traditional @command{od}
1832 accepted. The following syntax:
1835 od --traditional [@var{file}] [[+]@var{offset}[.][b] [[+]@var{label}[.][b]]]
1839 can be used to specify at most one file and optional arguments
1840 specifying an offset and a pseudo-start address, @var{label}.
1841 The @var{label} argument is interpreted
1842 just like @var{offset}, but it specifies an initial pseudo-address. The
1843 pseudo-addresses are displayed in parentheses following any normal
1850 @node base64 invocation
1851 @section @command{base64}: Transform data into printable data.
1854 @cindex base64 encoding
1856 @command{base64} transforms data read from a file, or standard input,
1857 into (or from) base64 encoded form. The base64 encoded form uses
1858 printable @acronym{ASCII} characters to represent binary data, see
1859 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3548.txt, RFC 3548}.
1863 base64 [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1864 base64 --decode [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
1867 The base64 encoding expands data to roughly 133% of the original.
1869 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1874 @itemx --wrap=@var{COLS}
1878 @cindex column to wrap data after
1879 During encoding, wrap lines after @var{COLS} characters. This must be
1882 The default is to wrap after 76 characters. Use the value 0 to
1883 disable line wrapping altogether.
1889 @cindex Decode base64 data
1890 @cindex Base64 decoding
1891 Change the mode of operation, from the default of encoding data, to
1892 decoding data. Input is expected to be base64 encoded data, and the
1893 output will be the original data.
1896 @itemx --ignore-garbage
1898 @opindex --ignore-garbage
1899 @cindex Ignore garbage in base64 stream
1900 When decoding, newlines are always accepted.
1901 During decoding, ignore unrecognized bytes,
1902 to permit distorted data to be decoded.
1909 @node Formatting file contents
1910 @chapter Formatting file contents
1912 @cindex formatting file contents
1914 These commands reformat the contents of files.
1917 * fmt invocation:: Reformat paragraph text.
1918 * pr invocation:: Paginate or columnate files for printing.
1919 * fold invocation:: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width.
1923 @node fmt invocation
1924 @section @command{fmt}: Reformat paragraph text
1927 @cindex reformatting paragraph text
1928 @cindex paragraphs, reformatting
1929 @cindex text, reformatting
1931 @command{fmt} fills and joins lines to produce output lines of (at most)
1932 a given number of characters (75 by default). Synopsis:
1935 fmt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
1938 @command{fmt} reads from the specified @var{file} arguments (or standard
1939 input if none are given), and writes to standard output.
1941 By default, blank lines, spaces between words, and indentation are
1942 preserved in the output; successive input lines with different
1943 indentation are not joined; tabs are expanded on input and introduced on
1946 @cindex line-breaking
1947 @cindex sentences and line-breaking
1948 @cindex Knuth, Donald E.
1949 @cindex Plass, Michael F.
1950 @command{fmt} prefers breaking lines at the end of a sentence, and tries to
1951 avoid line breaks after the first word of a sentence or before the last
1952 word of a sentence. A @dfn{sentence break} is defined as either the end
1953 of a paragraph or a word ending in any of @samp{.?!}, followed by two
1954 spaces or end of line, ignoring any intervening parentheses or quotes.
1955 Like @TeX{}, @command{fmt} reads entire ``paragraphs'' before choosing line
1956 breaks; the algorithm is a variant of that given by Donald E. Knuth
1957 and Michael F. Plass in ``Breaking Paragraphs Into Lines'',
1958 @cite{Software---Practice & Experience} @b{11}, 11 (November 1981),
1961 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
1966 @itemx --crown-margin
1968 @opindex --crown-margin
1969 @cindex crown margin
1970 @dfn{Crown margin} mode: preserve the indentation of the first two
1971 lines within a paragraph, and align the left margin of each subsequent
1972 line with that of the second line.
1975 @itemx --tagged-paragraph
1977 @opindex --tagged-paragraph
1978 @cindex tagged paragraphs
1979 @dfn{Tagged paragraph} mode: like crown margin mode, except that if
1980 indentation of the first line of a paragraph is the same as the
1981 indentation of the second, the first line is treated as a one-line
1987 @opindex --split-only
1988 Split lines only. Do not join short lines to form longer ones. This
1989 prevents sample lines of code, and other such ``formatted'' text from
1990 being unduly combined.
1993 @itemx --uniform-spacing
1995 @opindex --uniform-spacing
1996 Uniform spacing. Reduce spacing between words to one space, and spacing
1997 between sentences to two spaces.
2000 @itemx -w @var{width}
2001 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2002 @opindex -@var{width}
2005 Fill output lines up to @var{width} characters (default 75). @command{fmt}
2006 initially tries to make lines about 7% shorter than this, to give it
2007 room to balance line lengths.
2009 @item -p @var{prefix}
2010 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2011 Only lines beginning with @var{prefix} (possibly preceded by whitespace)
2012 are subject to formatting. The prefix and any preceding whitespace are
2013 stripped for the formatting and then re-attached to each formatted output
2014 line. One use is to format certain kinds of program comments, while
2015 leaving the code unchanged.
2023 @section @command{pr}: Paginate or columnate files for printing
2026 @cindex printing, preparing files for
2027 @cindex multicolumn output, generating
2028 @cindex merging files in parallel
2030 @command{pr} writes each @var{file} (@samp{-} means standard input), or
2031 standard input if none are given, to standard output, paginating and
2032 optionally outputting in multicolumn format; optionally merges all
2033 @var{file}s, printing all in parallel, one per column. Synopsis:
2036 pr [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2040 By default, a 5-line header is printed at each page: two blank lines;
2041 a line with the date, the file name, and the page count; and two more
2042 blank lines. A footer of five blank lines is also printed.
2043 With the @option{-F}
2044 option, a 3-line header is printed: the leading two blank lines are
2045 omitted; no footer is used. The default @var{page_length} in both cases is 66
2046 lines. The default number of text lines changes from 56 (without @option{-F})
2047 to 63 (with @option{-F}). The text line of the header takes the form
2048 @samp{@var{date} @var{string} @var{page}}, with spaces inserted around
2049 @var{string} so that the line takes up the full @var{page_width}. Here,
2050 @var{date} is the date (see the @option{-D} or @option{--date-format}
2051 option for details), @var{string} is the centered header string, and
2052 @var{page} identifies the page number. The @env{LC_MESSAGES} locale
2053 category affects the spelling of @var{page}; in the default C locale, it
2054 is @samp{Page @var{number}} where @var{number} is the decimal page
2057 Form feeds in the input cause page breaks in the output. Multiple form
2058 feeds produce empty pages.
2060 Columns are of equal width, separated by an optional string (default
2061 is @samp{space}). For multicolumn output, lines will always be truncated to
2062 @var{page_width} (default 72), unless you use the @option{-J} option.
2064 column output no line truncation occurs by default. Use @option{-W} option to
2065 truncate lines in that case.
2067 The following changes were made in version 1.22i and apply to later
2068 versions of @command{pr}:
2069 @c FIXME: this whole section here sounds very awkward to me. I
2070 @c made a few small changes, but really it all needs to be redone. - Brian
2071 @c OK, I fixed another sentence or two, but some of it I just don't understand.
2076 Some small @var{letter options} (@option{-s}, @option{-w}) have been
2077 redefined for better @acronym{POSIX} compliance. The output of some further
2078 cases has been adapted to other Unix systems. These changes are not
2079 compatible with earlier versions of the program.
2082 Some @var{new capital letter} options (@option{-J}, @option{-S}, @option{-W})
2083 have been introduced to turn off unexpected interferences of small letter
2084 options. The @option{-N} option and the second argument @var{last_page}
2085 of @samp{+FIRST_PAGE} offer more flexibility. The detailed handling of
2086 form feeds set in the input files requires the @option{-T} option.
2089 Capital letter options override small letter ones.
2092 Some of the option-arguments (compare @option{-s}, @option{-e},
2093 @option{-i}, @option{-n}) cannot be specified as separate arguments from the
2094 preceding option letter (already stated in the @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2097 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2101 @item +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2102 @itemx --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2103 @c The two following @opindex lines evoke warnings because they contain `:'
2104 @c The `info' spec does not permit that. If we use those lines, we end
2105 @c up with truncated index entries that don't work.
2106 @c @opindex +@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2107 @c @opindex --pages=@var{first_page}[:@var{last_page}]
2108 @opindex +@var{page_range}
2109 @opindex --pages=@var{page_range}
2110 Begin printing with page @var{first_page} and stop with @var{last_page}.
2111 Missing @samp{:@var{last_page}} implies end of file. While estimating
2112 the number of skipped pages each form feed in the input file results
2113 in a new page. Page counting with and without @samp{+@var{first_page}}
2114 is identical. By default, counting starts with the first page of input
2115 file (not first page printed). Line numbering may be altered by @option{-N}
2119 @itemx --columns=@var{column}
2120 @opindex -@var{column}
2122 @cindex down columns
2123 With each single @var{file}, produce @var{column} columns of output
2124 (default is 1) and print columns down, unless @option{-a} is used. The
2125 column width is automatically decreased as @var{column} increases; unless
2126 you use the @option{-W/-w} option to increase @var{page_width} as well.
2127 This option might well cause some lines to be truncated. The number of
2128 lines in the columns on each page are balanced. The options @option{-e}
2129 and @option{-i} are on for multiple text-column output. Together with
2130 @option{-J} option column alignment and line truncation is turned off.
2131 Lines of full length are joined in a free field format and @option{-S}
2132 option may set field separators. @option{-@var{column}} may not be used
2133 with @option{-m} option.
2139 @cindex across columns
2140 With each single @var{file}, print columns across rather than down. The
2141 @option{-@var{column}} option must be given with @var{column} greater than one.
2142 If a line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated.
2145 @itemx --show-control-chars
2147 @opindex --show-control-chars
2148 Print control characters using hat notation (e.g., @samp{^G}); print
2149 other nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation. By default,
2150 nonprinting characters are not changed.
2153 @itemx --double-space
2155 @opindex --double-space
2156 @cindex double spacing
2157 Double space the output.
2159 @item -D @var{format}
2160 @itemx --date-format=@var{format}
2161 @cindex time formats
2162 @cindex formatting times
2163 Format header dates using @var{format}, using the same conventions as
2164 for the command @samp{date +@var{format}}; @xref{date invocation}.
2165 Except for directives, which start with
2166 @samp{%}, characters in @var{format} are printed unchanged. You can use
2167 this option to specify an arbitrary string in place of the header date,
2168 e.g., @option{--date-format="Monday morning"}.
2170 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2173 format defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M} (for example, @samp{2001-12-04
2174 23:59}); but if the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set
2175 and the @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the @acronym{POSIX}
2176 locale, the default is @samp{%b %e %H:%M %Y} (for example,
2177 @samp{Dec@ @ 4 23:59 2001}.
2180 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
2181 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
2182 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
2183 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
2185 @item -e[@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2186 @itemx --expand-tabs[=@var{in-tabchar}[@var{in-tabwidth}]]
2188 @opindex --expand-tabs
2190 Expand @var{tab}s to spaces on input. Optional argument @var{in-tabchar} is
2191 the input tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2192 argument @var{in-tabwidth} is the input tab character's width (default
2200 @opindex --form-feed
2201 Use a form feed instead of newlines to separate output pages. The default
2202 page length of 66 lines is not altered. But the number of lines of text
2203 per page changes from default 56 to 63 lines.
2205 @item -h @var{HEADER}
2206 @itemx --header=@var{HEADER}
2209 Replace the file name in the header with the centered string @var{header}.
2210 When using the shell, @var{header} should be quoted and should be
2211 separated from @option{-h} by a space.
2213 @item -i[@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2214 @itemx --output-tabs[=@var{out-tabchar}[@var{out-tabwidth}]]
2216 @opindex --output-tabs
2218 Replace spaces with @var{tab}s on output. Optional argument @var{out-tabchar}
2219 is the output tab character (default is the TAB character). Second optional
2220 argument @var{out-tabwidth} is the output tab character's width (default
2226 @opindex --join-lines
2227 Merge lines of full length. Used together with the column options
2228 @option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}. Turns off
2229 @option{-W/-w} line truncation;
2230 no column alignment used; may be used with
2231 @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]}. @option{-J} has been introduced
2232 (together with @option{-W} and @option{--sep-string})
2233 to disentangle the old (@acronym{POSIX}-compliant) options @option{-w} and
2234 @option{-s} along with the three column options.
2237 @item -l @var{page_length}
2238 @itemx --length=@var{page_length}
2241 Set the page length to @var{page_length} (default 66) lines, including
2242 the lines of the header [and the footer]. If @var{page_length} is less
2243 than or equal to 10 (or <= 3 with @option{-F}), the header and footer are
2244 omitted, and all form feeds set in input files are eliminated, as if
2245 the @option{-T} option had been given.
2251 Merge and print all @var{file}s in parallel, one in each column. If a
2252 line is too long to fit in a column, it is truncated, unless the @option{-J}
2253 option is used. @option{--sep-string[=@var{string}]} may be used.
2255 some @var{file}s (form feeds set) produce empty columns, still marked
2256 by @var{string}. The result is a continuous line numbering and column
2257 marking throughout the whole merged file. Completely empty merged pages
2258 show no separators or line numbers. The default header becomes
2259 @samp{@var{date} @var{page}} with spaces inserted in the middle; this
2260 may be used with the @option{-h} or @option{--header} option to fill up
2261 the middle blank part.
2263 @item -n[@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2264 @itemx --number-lines[=@var{number-separator}[@var{digits}]]
2266 @opindex --number-lines
2267 Provide @var{digits} digit line numbering (default for @var{digits} is
2268 5). With multicolumn output the number occupies the first @var{digits}
2269 column positions of each text column or only each line of @option{-m}
2270 output. With single column output the number precedes each line just as
2271 @option{-m} does. Default counting of the line numbers starts with the
2272 first line of the input file (not the first line printed, compare the
2273 @option{--page} option and @option{-N} option).
2274 Optional argument @var{number-separator} is the character appended to
2275 the line number to separate it from the text followed. The default
2276 separator is the TAB character. In a strict sense a TAB is always
2277 printed with single column output only. The @var{TAB}-width varies
2278 with the @var{TAB}-position, e.g., with the left @var{margin} specified
2279 by @option{-o} option. With multicolumn output priority is given to
2280 @samp{equal width of output columns} (a @acronym{POSIX} specification).
2281 The @var{TAB}-width is fixed to the value of the first column and does
2282 not change with different values of left @var{margin}. That means a
2283 fixed number of spaces is always printed in the place of the
2284 @var{number-separator tab}. The tabification depends upon the output
2287 @item -N @var{line_number}
2288 @itemx --first-line-number=@var{line_number}
2290 @opindex --first-line-number
2291 Start line counting with the number @var{line_number} at first line of
2292 first page printed (in most cases not the first line of the input file).
2294 @item -o @var{margin}
2295 @itemx --indent=@var{margin}
2298 @cindex indenting lines
2300 Indent each line with a margin @var{margin} spaces wide (default is zero).
2301 The total page width is the size of the margin plus the @var{page_width}
2302 set with the @option{-W/-w} option. A limited overflow may occur with
2303 numbered single column output (compare @option{-n} option).
2306 @itemx --no-file-warnings
2308 @opindex --no-file-warnings
2309 Do not print a warning message when an argument @var{file} cannot be
2310 opened. (The exit status will still be nonzero, however.)
2312 @item -s[@var{char}]
2313 @itemx --separator[=@var{char}]
2315 @opindex --separator
2316 Separate columns by a single character @var{char}. The default for
2317 @var{char} is the TAB character without @option{-w} and @samp{no
2318 character} with @option{-w}. Without @option{-s} the default separator
2319 @samp{space} is set. @option{-s[char]} turns off line truncation of all
2320 three column options (@option{-COLUMN}|@option{-a -COLUMN}|@option{-m}) unless
2321 @option{-w} is set. This is a @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2324 @item -S@var{string}
2325 @itemx --sep-string[=@var{string}]
2327 @opindex --sep-string
2328 Use @var{string} to separate output columns. The @option{-S} option doesn't
2329 affect the @option{-W/-w} option, unlike the @option{-s} option which does. It
2330 does not affect line truncation or column alignment.
2331 Without @option{-S}, and with @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses the default output
2333 Without @option{-S} or @option{-J}, @command{pr} uses a @samp{space}
2334 (same as @option{-S"@w{ }"}). @option{--sep-string} with no
2335 @samp{=@var{string}} is equivalent to @option{--sep-string=""}.
2338 @itemx --omit-header
2340 @opindex --omit-header
2341 Do not print the usual header [and footer] on each page, and do not fill
2342 out the bottom of pages (with blank lines or a form feed). No page
2343 structure is produced, but form feeds set in the input files are retained.
2344 The predefined pagination is not changed. @option{-t} or @option{-T} may be
2345 useful together with other options; e.g.: @option{-t -e4}, expand TAB characters
2346 in the input file to 4 spaces but don't make any other changes. Use of
2347 @option{-t} overrides @option{-h}.
2350 @itemx --omit-pagination
2352 @opindex --omit-pagination
2353 Do not print header [and footer]. In addition eliminate all form feeds
2354 set in the input files.
2357 @itemx --show-nonprinting
2359 @opindex --show-nonprinting
2360 Print nonprinting characters in octal backslash notation.
2362 @item -w @var{page_width}
2363 @itemx --width=@var{page_width}
2366 Set page width to @var{page_width} characters for multiple text-column
2367 output only (default for @var{page_width} is 72). @option{-s[CHAR]} turns
2368 off the default page width and any line truncation and column alignment.
2369 Lines of full length are merged, regardless of the column options
2370 set. No @var{page_width} setting is possible with single column output.
2371 A @acronym{POSIX}-compliant formulation.
2373 @item -W @var{page_width}
2374 @itemx --page_width=@var{page_width}
2376 @opindex --page_width
2377 Set the page width to @var{page_width} characters. That's valid with and
2378 without a column option. Text lines are truncated, unless @option{-J}
2379 is used. Together with one of the three column options
2380 (@option{-@var{column}}, @option{-a -@var{column}} or @option{-m}) column
2381 alignment is always used. The separator options @option{-S} or @option{-s}
2382 don't affect the @option{-W} option. Default is 72 characters. Without
2383 @option{-W @var{page_width}} and without any of the column options NO line
2384 truncation is used (defined to keep downward compatibility and to meet
2385 most frequent tasks). That's equivalent to @option{-W 72 -J}. The header
2386 line is never truncated.
2393 @node fold invocation
2394 @section @command{fold}: Wrap input lines to fit in specified width
2397 @cindex wrapping long input lines
2398 @cindex folding long input lines
2400 @command{fold} writes each @var{file} (@option{-} means standard input), or
2401 standard input if none are given, to standard output, breaking long
2405 fold [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2408 By default, @command{fold} breaks lines wider than 80 columns. The output
2409 is split into as many lines as necessary.
2411 @cindex screen columns
2412 @command{fold} counts screen columns by default; thus, a tab may count more
2413 than one column, backspace decreases the column count, and carriage
2414 return sets the column to zero.
2416 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2424 Count bytes rather than columns, so that tabs, backspaces, and carriage
2425 returns are each counted as taking up one column, just like other
2432 Break at word boundaries: the line is broken after the last blank before
2433 the maximum line length. If the line contains no such blanks, the line
2434 is broken at the maximum line length as usual.
2436 @item -w @var{width}
2437 @itemx --width=@var{width}
2440 Use a maximum line length of @var{width} columns instead of 80.
2442 For compatibility @command{fold} supports an obsolete option syntax
2443 @option{-@var{width}}. New scripts should use @option{-w @var{width}}
2451 @node Output of parts of files
2452 @chapter Output of parts of files
2454 @cindex output of parts of files
2455 @cindex parts of files, output of
2457 These commands output pieces of the input.
2460 * head invocation:: Output the first part of files.
2461 * tail invocation:: Output the last part of files.
2462 * split invocation:: Split a file into fixed-size pieces.
2463 * csplit invocation:: Split a file into context-determined pieces.
2466 @node head invocation
2467 @section @command{head}: Output the first part of files
2470 @cindex initial part of files, outputting
2471 @cindex first part of files, outputting
2473 @command{head} prints the first part (10 lines by default) of each
2474 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2475 when given a @var{file} of @option{-}. Synopsis:
2478 head [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2481 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{head} prints a
2482 one-line header consisting of:
2485 ==> @var{file name} <==
2489 before the output for each @var{file}.
2491 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2496 @itemx --bytes=@var{n}
2499 Print the first @var{n} bytes, instead of initial lines.
2500 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2501 print all but the last @var{n} bytes of each file.
2502 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{n} by 512,
2503 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2504 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2505 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{GB} by 1024*1024*1024,
2506 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2509 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2512 Output the first @var{n} lines.
2513 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{-},
2514 print all but the last @var{n} lines of each file.
2515 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2523 Never print file name headers.
2529 Always print file name headers.
2533 For compatibility @command{head} also supports an obsolete option syntax
2534 @option{-@var{count}@var{options}}, which is recognized only if it is
2535 specified first. @var{count} is a decimal number optionally followed
2536 by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{k}, @samp{m}) as in @option{-c}, or
2537 @samp{l} to mean count by lines, or other option letters (@samp{cqv}).
2538 Scripts intended for standard hosts should use @option{-c @var{count}}
2539 or @option{-n @var{count}} instead. If your script must also run on
2540 hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, it is usually simpler to
2541 avoid @command{head}, e.g., by using @samp{sed 5q} instead of
2547 @node tail invocation
2548 @section @command{tail}: Output the last part of files
2551 @cindex last part of files, outputting
2553 @command{tail} prints the last part (10 lines by default) of each
2554 @var{file}; it reads from standard input if no files are given or
2555 when given a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
2558 tail [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
2561 If more than one @var{file} is specified, @command{tail} prints a
2562 one-line header consisting of:
2565 ==> @var{file name} <==
2569 before the output for each @var{file}.
2571 @cindex BSD @command{tail}
2572 @sc{gnu} @command{tail} can output any amount of data (some other versions of
2573 @command{tail} cannot). It also has no @option{-r} option (print in
2574 reverse), since reversing a file is really a different job from printing
2575 the end of a file; BSD @command{tail} (which is the one with @option{-r}) can
2576 only reverse files that are at most as large as its buffer, which is
2577 typically 32 KiB@. A more reliable and versatile way to reverse files is
2578 the @sc{gnu} @command{tac} command.
2580 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2584 @item -c @var{bytes}
2585 @itemx --bytes=@var{bytes}
2588 Output the last @var{bytes} bytes, instead of final lines.
2589 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2590 @var{n}th byte from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2591 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
2592 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2593 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2594 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{GB} by 1024*1024*1024,
2595 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2598 @itemx --follow[=@var{how}]
2601 @cindex growing files
2602 @vindex name @r{follow option}
2603 @vindex descriptor @r{follow option}
2604 Loop forever trying to read more characters at the end of the file,
2605 presumably because the file is growing.
2606 If more than one file is given, @command{tail} prints a header whenever it
2607 gets output from a different file, to indicate which file that output is
2610 There are two ways to specify how you'd like to track files with this option,
2611 but that difference is noticeable only when a followed file is removed or
2613 If you'd like to continue to track the end of a growing file even after
2614 it has been unlinked, use @option{--follow=descriptor}. This is the default
2615 behavior, but it is not useful if you're tracking a log file that may be
2616 rotated (removed or renamed, then reopened). In that case, use
2617 @option{--follow=name} to track the named file by reopening it periodically
2618 to see if it has been removed and recreated by some other program.
2620 No matter which method you use, if the tracked file is determined to have
2621 shrunk, @command{tail} prints a message saying the file has been truncated
2622 and resumes tracking the end of the file from the newly-determined endpoint.
2624 When a file is removed, @command{tail}'s behavior depends on whether it is
2625 following the name or the descriptor. When following by name, tail can
2626 detect that a file has been removed and gives a message to that effect,
2627 and if @option{--retry} has been specified it will continue checking
2628 periodically to see if the file reappears.
2629 When following a descriptor, tail does not detect that the file has
2630 been unlinked or renamed and issues no message; even though the file
2631 may no longer be accessible via its original name, it may still be
2634 The option values @samp{descriptor} and @samp{name} may be specified only
2635 with the long form of the option, not with @option{-f}.
2637 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
2638 If @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, the @option{-f} option is ignored if
2639 no @var{file} operand is specified and standard input is a FIFO or a pipe.
2643 This option is the same as @option{--follow=name --retry}. That is, tail
2644 will attempt to reopen a file when it is removed. Should this fail, tail
2645 will keep trying until it becomes accessible again.
2649 This option is useful mainly when following by name (i.e., with
2650 @option{--follow=name}).
2651 Without this option, when tail encounters a file that doesn't
2652 exist or is otherwise inaccessible, it reports that fact and
2653 never checks it again.
2655 @itemx --sleep-interval=@var{number}
2656 @opindex --sleep-interval
2657 Change the number of seconds to wait between iterations (the default is 1.0).
2658 During one iteration, every specified file is checked to see if it has
2660 Historical implementations of @command{tail} have required that
2661 @var{number} be an integer. However, GNU @command{tail} accepts
2662 an arbitrary floating point number (using a period before any
2665 @itemx --pid=@var{pid}
2667 When following by name or by descriptor, you may specify the process ID,
2668 @var{pid}, of the sole writer of all @var{file} arguments. Then, shortly
2669 after that process terminates, tail will also terminate. This will
2670 work properly only if the writer and the tailing process are running on
2671 the same machine. For example, to save the output of a build in a file
2672 and to watch the file grow, if you invoke @command{make} and @command{tail}
2673 like this then the tail process will stop when your build completes.
2674 Without this option, you would have had to kill the @code{tail -f}
2678 $ make >& makerr & tail --pid=$! -f makerr
2681 If you specify a @var{pid} that is not in use or that does not correspond
2682 to the process that is writing to the tailed files, then @command{tail}
2683 may terminate long before any @var{file}s stop growing or it may not
2684 terminate until long after the real writer has terminated.
2685 Note that @option{--pid} cannot be supported on some systems; @command{tail}
2686 will print a warning if this is the case.
2688 @itemx --max-unchanged-stats=@var{n}
2689 @opindex --max-unchanged-stats
2690 When tailing a file by name, if there have been @var{n} (default
2691 n=@value{DEFAULT_MAX_N_UNCHANGED_STATS_BETWEEN_OPENS}) consecutive
2692 iterations for which the file has not changed, then
2693 @code{open}/@code{fstat} the file to determine if that file name is
2694 still associated with the same device/inode-number pair as before.
2695 When following a log file that is rotated, this is approximately the
2696 number of seconds between when tail prints the last pre-rotation lines
2697 and when it prints the lines that have accumulated in the new log file.
2698 This option is meaningful only when following by name.
2701 @itemx --lines=@var{n}
2704 Output the last @var{n} lines.
2705 However, if @var{n} starts with a @samp{+}, start printing with the
2706 @var{n}th line from the start of each file, instead of from the end.
2707 Size multiplier suffixes are the same as with the @option{-c} option.
2715 Never print file name headers.
2721 Always print file name headers.
2725 For compatibility @command{tail} also supports an obsolete usage
2726 @samp{tail -[@var{count}][bcl][f] [@var{file}]}, which is recognized
2727 only if it does not conflict with the usage described
2728 above. This obsolete form uses exactly one option and at most one
2729 file. In the option, @var{count} is an optional decimal number optionally
2730 followed by a size letter (@samp{b}, @samp{c}, @samp{l}) to mean count
2731 by 512-byte blocks, bytes, or lines, optionally followed by @samp{f}
2732 which has the same meaning as @option{-f}.
2734 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
2735 On older systems, the leading @samp{-} can be replaced by @samp{+} in
2736 the obsolete option syntax with the same meaning as in counts, and
2737 obsolete usage overrides normal usage when the two conflict.
2738 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
2739 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
2742 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
2743 syntax and should use @option{-c @var{count}[b]}, @option{-n
2744 @var{count}}, and/or @option{-f} instead. If your script must also
2745 run on hosts that support only the obsolete syntax, you can often
2746 rewrite it to avoid problematic usages, e.g., by using @samp{sed -n
2747 '$p'} rather than @samp{tail -1}. If that's not possible, the script
2748 can use a test like @samp{if tail -c +1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1;
2749 then @dots{}} to decide which syntax to use.
2751 Even if your script assumes the standard behavior, you should still
2752 beware usages whose behaviors differ depending on the @acronym{POSIX}
2753 version. For example, avoid @samp{tail - main.c}, since it might be
2754 interpreted as either @samp{tail main.c} or as @samp{tail -- -
2755 main.c}; avoid @samp{tail -c 4}, since it might mean either @samp{tail
2756 -c4} or @samp{tail -c 10 4}; and avoid @samp{tail +4}, since it might
2757 mean either @samp{tail ./+4} or @samp{tail -n +4}.
2762 @node split invocation
2763 @section @command{split}: Split a file into fixed-size pieces
2766 @cindex splitting a file into pieces
2767 @cindex pieces, splitting a file into
2769 @command{split} creates output files containing consecutive sections of
2770 @var{input} (standard input if none is given or @var{input} is
2771 @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2774 split [@var{option}] [@var{input} [@var{prefix}]]
2777 By default, @command{split} puts 1000 lines of @var{input} (or whatever is
2778 left over for the last section), into each output file.
2780 @cindex output file name prefix
2781 The output files' names consist of @var{prefix} (@samp{x} by default)
2782 followed by a group of characters (@samp{aa}, @samp{ab}, @dots{} by
2783 default), such that concatenating the output files in traditional
2784 sorted order by file name produces
2785 the original input file. If the output file names are exhausted,
2786 @command{split} reports an error without deleting the output files
2789 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2793 @item -a @var{length}
2794 @itemx --suffix-length=@var{length}
2796 @opindex --suffix-length
2797 Use suffixes of length @var{length}. The default @var{length} is 2.
2799 @item -l @var{lines}
2800 @itemx --lines=@var{lines}
2803 Put @var{lines} lines of @var{input} into each output file.
2805 For compatibility @command{split} also supports an obsolete
2806 option syntax @option{-@var{lines}}. New scripts should use @option{-l
2807 @var{lines}} instead.
2809 @item -b @var{bytes}
2810 @itemx --bytes=@var{bytes}
2813 Put the first @var{bytes} bytes of @var{input} into each output file.
2814 Appending @samp{b} multiplies @var{bytes} by 512,
2815 @samp{kB} by 1000, @samp{K} by 1024,
2816 @samp{MB} by 1000*1000, @samp{M} by 1024*1024,
2817 @samp{GB} by 1000*1000*1000, @samp{GB} by 1024*1024*1024,
2818 and so on for @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}.
2820 @item -C @var{bytes}
2821 @itemx --line-bytes=@var{bytes}
2823 @opindex --line-bytes
2824 Put into each output file as many complete lines of @var{input} as
2825 possible without exceeding @var{bytes} bytes. For lines longer than
2826 @var{bytes} bytes, put @var{bytes} bytes into each output file until
2827 less than @var{bytes} bytes of the line are left, then continue
2828 normally. @var{bytes} has the same format as for the @option{--bytes}
2832 @itemx --numeric-suffixes
2834 @opindex --numeric-suffixes
2835 Use digits in suffixes rather than lower-case letters.
2839 Write a diagnostic to standard error just before each output file is opened.
2846 @node csplit invocation
2847 @section @command{csplit}: Split a file into context-determined pieces
2850 @cindex context splitting
2851 @cindex splitting a file into pieces by context
2853 @command{csplit} creates zero or more output files containing sections of
2854 @var{input} (standard input if @var{input} is @samp{-}). Synopsis:
2857 csplit [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{input} @var{pattern}@dots{}
2860 The contents of the output files are determined by the @var{pattern}
2861 arguments, as detailed below. An error occurs if a @var{pattern}
2862 argument refers to a nonexistent line of the input file (e.g., if no
2863 remaining line matches a given regular expression). After every
2864 @var{pattern} has been matched, any remaining input is copied into one
2867 By default, @command{csplit} prints the number of bytes written to each
2868 output file after it has been created.
2870 The types of pattern arguments are:
2875 Create an output file containing the input up to but not including line
2876 @var{n} (a positive integer). If followed by a repeat count, also
2877 create an output file containing the next @var{n} lines of the input
2878 file once for each repeat.
2880 @item /@var{regexp}/[@var{offset}]
2881 Create an output file containing the current line up to (but not
2882 including) the next line of the input file that contains a match for
2883 @var{regexp}. The optional @var{offset} is an integer.
2884 If it is given, the input up to (but not including) the
2885 matching line plus or minus @var{offset} is put into the output file,
2886 and the line after that begins the next section of input.
2888 @item %@var{regexp}%[@var{offset}]
2889 Like the previous type, except that it does not create an output
2890 file, so that section of the input file is effectively ignored.
2892 @item @{@var{repeat-count}@}
2893 Repeat the previous pattern @var{repeat-count} additional
2894 times. The @var{repeat-count} can either be a positive integer or an
2895 asterisk, meaning repeat as many times as necessary until the input is
2900 The output files' names consist of a prefix (@samp{xx} by default)
2901 followed by a suffix. By default, the suffix is an ascending sequence
2902 of two-digit decimal numbers from @samp{00} to @samp{99}. In any case,
2903 concatenating the output files in sorted order by file name produces the
2904 original input file.
2906 By default, if @command{csplit} encounters an error or receives a hangup,
2907 interrupt, quit, or terminate signal, it removes any output files
2908 that it has created so far before it exits.
2910 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
2914 @item -f @var{prefix}
2915 @itemx --prefix=@var{prefix}
2918 @cindex output file name prefix
2919 Use @var{prefix} as the output file name prefix.
2921 @item -b @var{suffix}
2922 @itemx --suffix=@var{suffix}
2925 @cindex output file name suffix
2926 Use @var{suffix} as the output file name suffix. When this option is
2927 specified, the suffix string must include exactly one
2928 @code{printf(3)}-style conversion specification, possibly including
2929 format specification flags, a field width, a precision specifications,
2930 or all of these kinds of modifiers. The format letter must convert a
2931 binary integer argument to readable form; thus, only @samp{d}, @samp{i},
2932 @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{x}, and @samp{X} conversions are allowed. The
2933 entire @var{suffix} is given (with the current output file number) to
2934 @code{sprintf(3)} to form the file name suffixes for each of the
2935 individual output files in turn. If this option is used, the
2936 @option{--digits} option is ignored.
2938 @item -n @var{digits}
2939 @itemx --digits=@var{digits}
2942 Use output file names containing numbers that are @var{digits} digits
2943 long instead of the default 2.
2948 @opindex --keep-files
2949 Do not remove output files when errors are encountered.
2952 @itemx --elide-empty-files
2954 @opindex --elide-empty-files
2955 Suppress the generation of zero-length output files. (In cases where
2956 the section delimiters of the input file are supposed to mark the first
2957 lines of each of the sections, the first output file will generally be a
2958 zero-length file unless you use this option.) The output file sequence
2959 numbers always run consecutively starting from 0, even when this option
2970 Do not print counts of output file sizes.
2977 @node Summarizing files
2978 @chapter Summarizing files
2980 @cindex summarizing files
2982 These commands generate just a few numbers representing entire
2986 * wc invocation:: Print newline, word, and byte counts.
2987 * sum invocation:: Print checksum and block counts.
2988 * cksum invocation:: Print CRC checksum and byte counts.
2989 * md5sum invocation:: Print or check MD5 digests.
2990 * sha1sum invocation:: Print or check SHA-1 digests.
2991 * sha2 utilities:: Print or check SHA-2 digests.
2996 @section @command{wc}: Print newline, word, and byte counts
3000 @cindex character count
3004 @command{wc} counts the number of bytes, characters, whitespace-separated
3005 words, and newlines in each given @var{file}, or standard input if none
3006 are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3009 wc [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3012 @cindex total counts
3013 @command{wc} prints one line of counts for each file, and if the file was
3014 given as an argument, it prints the file name following the counts. If
3015 more than one @var{file} is given, @command{wc} prints a final line
3016 containing the cumulative counts, with the file name @file{total}. The
3017 counts are printed in this order: newlines, words, characters, bytes,
3018 maximum line length.
3019 Each count is printed right-justified in a field with at least one
3020 space between fields so that the numbers and file names normally line
3021 up nicely in columns. The width of the count fields varies depending
3022 on the inputs, so you should not depend on a particular field width.
3023 However, as a @acronym{GNU} extension, if only one count is printed,
3024 it is guaranteed to be printed without leading spaces.
3026 By default, @command{wc} prints three counts: the newline, words, and byte
3027 counts. Options can specify that only certain counts be printed.
3028 Options do not undo others previously given, so
3035 prints both the byte counts and the word counts.
3037 With the @option{--max-line-length} option, @command{wc} prints the length
3038 of the longest line per file, and if there is more than one file it
3039 prints the maximum (not the sum) of those lengths.
3041 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3049 Print only the byte counts.
3055 Print only the character counts.
3061 Print only the word counts.
3067 Print only the newline counts.
3070 @itemx --max-line-length
3072 @opindex --max-line-length
3073 Print only the maximum line lengths.
3075 @itemx --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3076 @opindex --files0-from=@var{FILE}
3077 @cindex including files from @command{du}
3078 Rather than processing files named on the command line, process those
3079 named in file @var{FILE}; each name is terminated by a null byte.
3081 the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
3083 In such cases, running @command{wc} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
3084 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{wc} print a
3085 total for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
3086 One way to produce a list of null-byte-terminated file names is with @sc{gnu}
3087 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate. For example, to find
3088 the length of the longest line in any @file{.c} or @file{.h} file in the
3089 current hierarchy, do this:
3092 find . -name '*.[ch]' -print0 | wc -L --files0-from=- | tail -n1
3095 Do not specify any @var{FILE} on the command line when using this option.
3102 @node sum invocation
3103 @section @command{sum}: Print checksum and block counts
3106 @cindex 16-bit checksum
3107 @cindex checksum, 16-bit
3109 @command{sum} computes a 16-bit checksum for each given @var{file}, or
3110 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3113 sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3116 @command{sum} prints the checksum for each @var{file} followed by the
3117 number of blocks in the file (rounded up). If more than one @var{file}
3118 is given, file names are also printed (by default). (With the
3119 @option{--sysv} option, corresponding file names are printed when there is
3120 at least one file argument.)
3122 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{sum} computes checksums using an algorithm
3123 compatible with BSD @command{sum} and prints file sizes in units of
3126 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3132 @cindex BSD @command{sum}
3133 Use the default (BSD compatible) algorithm. This option is included for
3134 compatibility with the System V @command{sum}. Unless @option{-s} was also
3135 given, it has no effect.
3141 @cindex System V @command{sum}
3142 Compute checksums using an algorithm compatible with System V
3143 @command{sum}'s default, and print file sizes in units of 512-byte blocks.
3147 @command{sum} is provided for compatibility; the @command{cksum} program (see
3148 next section) is preferable in new applications.
3153 @node cksum invocation
3154 @section @command{cksum}: Print CRC checksum and byte counts
3157 @cindex cyclic redundancy check
3158 @cindex CRC checksum
3160 @command{cksum} computes a cyclic redundancy check (CRC) checksum for each
3161 given @var{file}, or standard input if none are given or for a
3162 @var{file} of @samp{-}. Synopsis:
3165 cksum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3168 @command{cksum} prints the CRC checksum for each file along with the number
3169 of bytes in the file, and the file name unless no arguments were given.
3171 @command{cksum} is typically used to ensure that files
3172 transferred by unreliable means (e.g., netnews) have not been corrupted,
3173 by comparing the @command{cksum} output for the received files with the
3174 @command{cksum} output for the original files (typically given in the
3177 The CRC algorithm is specified by the @acronym{POSIX} standard. It is not
3178 compatible with the BSD or System V @command{sum} algorithms (see the
3179 previous section); it is more robust.
3181 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
3187 @node md5sum invocation
3188 @section @command{md5sum}: Print or check MD5 digests
3192 @cindex 128-bit checksum
3193 @cindex checksum, 128-bit
3194 @cindex fingerprint, 128-bit
3195 @cindex message-digest, 128-bit
3197 @command{md5sum} computes a 128-bit checksum (or @dfn{fingerprint} or
3198 @dfn{message-digest}) for each specified @var{file}.
3200 Note: The MD5 digest is more reliable than a simple CRC (provided by
3201 the @command{cksum} command) for detecting accidental file corruption,
3202 as the chances of accidentally having two files with identical MD5
3203 are vanishingly small. However, it should not be considered truly
3204 secure against malicious tampering: although finding a file with a
3205 given MD5 fingerprint, or modifying a file so as to retain its MD5 are
3206 considered infeasible at the moment, it is known how to produce
3207 different files with identical MD5 (a ``collision''), something which
3208 can be a security issue in certain contexts. For more secure hashes,
3209 consider using SHA-1 or SHA-2. @xref{sha1sum invocation}, and
3210 @ref{sha2 utilities}.
3212 If a @var{file} is specified as @samp{-} or if no files are given
3213 @command{md5sum} computes the checksum for the standard input.
3214 @command{md5sum} can also determine whether a file and checksum are
3215 consistent. Synopsis:
3218 md5sum [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3221 For each @var{file}, @samp{md5sum} outputs the MD5 checksum, a flag
3222 indicating a binary or text input file, and the file name.
3223 If @var{file} contains a backslash or newline, the
3224 line is started with a backslash, and each problematic character in
3225 the file name is escaped with a backslash, making the output
3226 unambiguous even in the presence of arbitrary file names.
3227 If @var{file} is omitted or specified as @samp{-}, standard input is read.
3229 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
3237 @cindex binary input files
3238 Treat each input file as binary, by reading it in binary mode and
3239 outputting a @samp{*} flag. This is the inverse of @option{--text}.
3240 On systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not distinguish between binary
3241 and text files, this option merely flags each input file as binary:
3242 the MD5 checksum is unaffected. This option is the default on systems
3243 like MS-DOS that distinguish between binary and text files, except
3244 for reading standard input when standard input is a terminal.
3248 Read file names and checksum information (not data) from each
3249 @var{file} (or from stdin if no @var{file} was specified) and report
3250 whether the checksums match the contents of the named files.
3251 The input to this mode of @command{md5sum} is usually the output of
3252 a prior, checksum-generating run of @samp{md5sum}.
3253 Each valid line of input consists of an MD5 checksum, a binary/text
3254 flag, and then a file name.
3255 Binary files are marked with @samp{*}, text with @samp{ }.
3256 For each such line, @command{md5sum} reads the named file and computes its
3257 MD5 checksum. Then, if the computed message digest does not match the
3258 one on the line with the file name, the file is noted as having
3259 failed the test. Otherwise, the file passes the test.
3260 By default, for each valid line, one line is written to standard
3261 output indicating whether the named file passed the test.
3262 After all checks have been performed, if there were any failures,
3263 a warning is issued to standard error.
3264 Use the @option{--status} option to inhibit that output.
3265 If any listed file cannot be opened or read, if any valid line has
3266 an MD5 checksum inconsistent with the associated file, or if no valid
3267 line is found, @command{md5sum} exits with nonzero status. Otherwise,
3268 it exits successfully.
3272 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3273 This option is useful only when verifying checksums.
3274 When verifying checksums, don't generate the default one-line-per-file
3275 diagnostic and don't output the warning summarizing any failures.
3276 Failures to open or read a file still evoke individual diagnostics to
3278 If all listed files are readable and are consistent with the associated
3279 MD5 checksums, exit successfully. Otherwise exit with a status code
3280 indicating there was a failure.
3286 @cindex text input files
3287 Treat each input file as text, by reading it in text mode and
3288 outputting a @samp{ } flag. This is the inverse of @option{--binary}.
3289 This option is the default on systems like @acronym{GNU} that do not
3290 distinguish between binary and text files. On other systems, it is
3291 the default for reading standard input when standard input is a
3298 @cindex verifying MD5 checksums
3299 When verifying checksums, warn about improperly formatted MD5 checksum lines.
3300 This option is useful only if all but a few lines in the checked input
3308 @node sha1sum invocation
3309 @section @command{sha1sum}: Print or check SHA-1 digests
3313 @cindex 160-bit checksum
3314 @cindex checksum, 160-bit
3315 @cindex fingerprint, 160-bit
3316 @cindex message-digest, 160-bit
3318 @command{sha1sum} computes a 160-bit checksum for each specified
3319 @var{file}. The usage and options of this command are precisely the
3320 same as for @command{md5sum}. @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3322 Note: The SHA-1 digest is more secure than MD5, and no collisions of
3323 it are known (different files having the same fingerprint). However,
3324 it is known that they can be produced with considerable, but not
3325 unreasonable, resources. For this reason, it is generally considered
3326 that SHA-1 should be gradually phased out in favor of the more secure
3327 SHA-2 hash algorithms. @xref{sha2 utilities}.
3330 @node sha2 utilities
3331 @section sha2 utilities: Print or check SHA-2 digests
3338 @cindex 224-bit checksum
3339 @cindex 256-bit checksum
3340 @cindex 384-bit checksum
3341 @cindex 512-bit checksum
3342 @cindex checksum, 224-bit
3343 @cindex checksum, 256-bit
3344 @cindex checksum, 384-bit
3345 @cindex checksum, 512-bit
3346 @cindex fingerprint, 224-bit
3347 @cindex fingerprint, 256-bit
3348 @cindex fingerprint, 384-bit
3349 @cindex fingerprint, 512-bit
3350 @cindex message-digest, 224-bit
3351 @cindex message-digest, 256-bit
3352 @cindex message-digest, 384-bit
3353 @cindex message-digest, 512-bit
3355 The commands @command{sha224sum}, @command{sha256sum},
3356 @command{sha384sum} and @command{sha512sum} compute checksums of
3357 various lengths (respectively 224, 256, 384 and 512 bits),
3358 collectively known as the SHA-2 hashes. The usage and options of
3359 these commands are precisely the same as for @command{md5sum}.
3360 @xref{md5sum invocation}.
3362 Note: The SHA384 and SHA512 digests are considerably slower to
3363 compute, especially on 32-bit computers, than SHA224 or SHA256.
3366 @node Operating on sorted files
3367 @chapter Operating on sorted files
3369 @cindex operating on sorted files
3370 @cindex sorted files, operations on
3372 These commands work with (or produce) sorted files.
3375 * sort invocation:: Sort text files.
3376 * shuf invocation:: Shuffle text files.
3377 * uniq invocation:: Uniquify files.
3378 * comm invocation:: Compare two sorted files line by line.
3379 * ptx invocation:: Produce a permuted index of file contents.
3380 * tsort invocation:: Topological sort.
3381 * tsort background:: Where tsort came from.
3385 @node sort invocation
3386 @section @command{sort}: Sort text files
3389 @cindex sorting files
3391 @command{sort} sorts, merges, or compares all the lines from the given
3392 files, or standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of
3393 @samp{-}. By default, @command{sort} writes the results to standard
3397 sort [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
3400 @command{sort} has three modes of operation: sort (the default), merge,
3401 and check for sortedness. The following options change the operation
3408 @itemx --check=diagnose-first
3411 @cindex checking for sortedness
3412 Check whether the given file is already sorted: if it is not all
3413 sorted, print a diagnostic containing the first out-of-order line and
3414 exit with a status of 1.
3415 Otherwise, exit successfully.
3416 At most one input file can be given.
3419 @itemx --check=quiet
3420 @itemx --check=silent
3423 @cindex checking for sortedness
3424 Exit successfully if the given file is already sorted, and
3425 exit with status 1 otherwise.
3426 At most one input file can be given.
3427 This is like @option{-c}, except it does not print a diagnostic.
3433 @cindex merging sorted files
3434 Merge the given files by sorting them as a group. Each input file must
3435 always be individually sorted. It always works to sort instead of
3436 merge; merging is provided because it is faster, in the case where it
3441 @cindex sort stability
3442 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3443 A pair of lines is compared as follows:
3444 @command{sort} compares each pair of fields, in the
3445 order specified on the command line, according to the associated
3446 ordering options, until a difference is found or no fields are left.
3447 If no key fields are specified, @command{sort} uses a default key of
3448 the entire line. Finally, as a last resort when all keys compare
3449 equal, @command{sort} compares entire lines as if no ordering options
3450 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) were specified. The
3451 @option{--stable} (@option{-s}) option disables this @dfn{last-resort
3452 comparison} so that lines in which all fields compare equal are left
3453 in their original relative order. The @option{--unique}
3454 (@option{-u}) option also disables the last-resort comparison.
3458 Unless otherwise specified, all comparisons use the character collating
3459 sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.@footnote{If you
3460 use a non-@acronym{POSIX} locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL}
3461 to @samp{en_US}), then @command{sort} may produce output that is sorted
3462 differently than you're accustomed to. In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL}
3463 environment variable to @samp{C}. Note that setting only @env{LC_COLLATE}
3464 has two problems. First, it is ineffective if @env{LC_ALL} is also set.
3465 Second, it has undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} (or @env{LANG}, if
3466 @env{LC_CTYPE} is unset) is set to an incompatible value. For example,
3467 you get undefined behavior if @env{LC_CTYPE} is @code{ja_JP.PCK} but
3468 @env{LC_COLLATE} is @code{en_US.UTF-8}.}
3470 @sc{gnu} @command{sort} (as specified for all @sc{gnu} utilities) has no
3471 limit on input line length or restrictions on bytes allowed within lines.
3472 In addition, if the final byte of an input file is not a newline, @sc{gnu}
3473 @command{sort} silently supplies one. A line's trailing newline is not
3474 part of the line for comparison purposes.
3476 @cindex exit status of @command{sort}
3480 0 if no error occurred
3481 1 if invoked with @option{-c} or @option{-C} and the input is not sorted
3482 2 if an error occurred
3486 If the environment variable @env{TMPDIR} is set, @command{sort} uses its
3487 value as the directory for temporary files instead of @file{/tmp}. The
3488 @option{--temporary-directory} (@option{-T}) option in turn overrides
3489 the environment variable.
3491 The following options affect the ordering of output lines. They may be
3492 specified globally or as part of a specific key field. If no key
3493 fields are specified, global options apply to comparison of entire
3494 lines; otherwise the global options are inherited by key fields that do
3495 not specify any special options of their own. In pre-@acronym{POSIX}
3496 versions of @command{sort}, global options affect only later key fields,
3497 so portable shell scripts should specify global options first.
3502 @itemx --ignore-leading-blanks
3504 @opindex --ignore-leading-blanks
3505 @cindex blanks, ignoring leading
3507 Ignore leading blanks when finding sort keys in each line.
3508 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3512 @itemx --dictionary-order
3514 @opindex --dictionary-order
3515 @cindex dictionary order
3516 @cindex phone directory order
3517 @cindex telephone directory order
3519 Sort in @dfn{phone directory} order: ignore all characters except
3520 letters, digits and blanks when sorting.
3521 By default letters and digits are those of @acronym{ASCII} and a blank
3522 is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale can change this.
3525 @itemx --ignore-case
3527 @opindex --ignore-case
3528 @cindex ignoring case
3529 @cindex case folding
3531 Fold lowercase characters into the equivalent uppercase characters when
3532 comparing so that, for example, @samp{b} and @samp{B} sort as equal.
3533 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3536 @itemx --general-numeric-sort
3538 @opindex --general-numeric-sort
3539 @cindex general numeric sort
3541 Sort numerically, using the standard C function @code{strtod} to convert
3542 a prefix of each line to a double-precision floating point number.
3543 This allows floating point numbers to be specified in scientific notation,
3544 like @code{1.0e-34} and @code{10e100}.
3545 The @env{LC_NUMERIC} locale determines the decimal-point character.
3546 Do not report overflow, underflow, or conversion errors.
3547 Use the following collating sequence:
3551 Lines that do not start with numbers (all considered to be equal).
3553 NaNs (``Not a Number'' values, in IEEE floating point arithmetic)
3554 in a consistent but machine-dependent order.
3558 Finite numbers in ascending numeric order (with @math{-0} and @math{+0} equal).
3563 Use this option only if there is no alternative; it is much slower than
3564 @option{--numeric-sort} (@option{-n}) and it can lose information when
3565 converting to floating point.
3568 @itemx --ignore-nonprinting
3570 @opindex --ignore-nonprinting
3571 @cindex nonprinting characters, ignoring
3572 @cindex unprintable characters, ignoring
3574 Ignore nonprinting characters.
3575 The @env{LC_CTYPE} locale determines character types.
3576 This option has no effect if the stronger @option{--dictionary-order}
3577 (@option{-d}) option is also given.
3582 @opindex --month-sort
3583 @cindex months, sorting by
3585 An initial string, consisting of any amount of blanks, followed
3586 by a month name abbreviation, is folded to UPPER case and
3587 compared in the order @samp{JAN} < @samp{FEB} < @dots{} < @samp{DEC}.
3588 Invalid names compare low to valid names. The @env{LC_TIME} locale
3589 category determines the month spellings.
3590 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3594 @itemx --numeric-sort
3596 @opindex --numeric-sort
3597 @cindex numeric sort
3599 Sort numerically. The number begins each line and consists
3600 of optional blanks, an optional @samp{-} sign, and zero or more
3601 digits possibly separated by thousands separators, optionally followed
3602 by a decimal-point character and zero or more digits. An empty
3603 number is treated as @samp{0}. The @env{LC_NUMERIC}
3604 locale specifies the decimal-point character and thousands separator.
3605 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3608 Comparison is exact; there is no rounding error.
3610 Neither a leading @samp{+} nor exponential notation is recognized.
3611 To compare such strings numerically, use the
3612 @option{--general-numeric-sort} (@option{-g}) option.
3618 @cindex reverse sorting
3619 Reverse the result of comparison, so that lines with greater key values
3620 appear earlier in the output instead of later.
3623 @itemx --random-sort
3625 @opindex --random-sort
3627 Sort by hashing the input keys and then sorting the hash values.
3628 Choose the hash function at random, ensuring that it is free of
3629 collisions so that differing keys have differing hash values. This is
3630 like a random permutation of the inputs (@pxref{shuf invocation}),
3631 except that keys with the same value sort together.
3633 If multiple random sort fields are specified, the same random hash
3634 function is used for all fields. To use different random hash
3635 functions for different fields, you can invoke @command{sort} more
3638 The choice of hash function is affected by the
3639 @option{--random-source} option.
3647 @item --compress-program=@var{prog}
3648 Compress any temporary files with the program @var{prog}.
3650 With no arguments, @var{prog} must compress standard input to standard
3651 output, and when given the @option{-d} option it must decompress
3652 standard input to standard output.
3654 Terminate with an error if @var{prog} exits with nonzero status.
3656 Whitespace and the backslash character should not appear in
3657 @var{prog}; they are reserved for future use.
3659 @item -k @var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3660 @itemx --key=@var{pos1}[,@var{pos2}]
3664 Specify a sort field that consists of the part of the line between
3665 @var{pos1} and @var{pos2} (or the end of the line, if @var{pos2} is
3666 omitted), @emph{inclusive}.
3668 Each @var{pos} has the form @samp{@var{f}[.@var{c}][@var{opts}]},
3669 where @var{f} is the number of the field to use, and @var{c} is the number
3670 of the first character from the beginning of the field. Fields and character
3671 positions are numbered starting with 1; a character position of zero in
3672 @var{pos2} indicates the field's last character. If @samp{.@var{c}} is
3673 omitted from @var{pos1}, it defaults to 1 (the beginning of the field);
3674 if omitted from @var{pos2}, it defaults to 0 (the end of the field).
3675 @var{opts} are ordering options, allowing individual keys to be sorted
3676 according to different rules; see below for details. Keys can span
3679 Example: To sort on the second field, use @option{--key=2,2}
3680 (@option{-k 2,2}). See below for more examples.
3682 @item -o @var{output-file}
3683 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
3686 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
3687 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
3688 Normally, @command{sort} reads all input before opening
3689 @var{output-file}, so you can safely sort a file in place by using
3690 commands like @code{sort -o F F} and @code{cat F | sort -o F}.
3691 However, @command{sort} with @option{--merge} (@option{-m}) can open
3692 the output file before reading all input, so a command like @code{cat
3693 F | sort -m -o F - G} is not safe as @command{sort} might start
3694 writing @file{F} before @command{cat} is done reading it.
3696 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3697 On newer systems, @option{-o} cannot appear after an input file if
3698 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, e.g., @samp{sort F -o F}. Portable
3699 scripts should specify @option{-o @var{output-file}} before any input
3702 @item --random-source=@var{file}
3703 @opindex --random-source
3704 @cindex random source for sorting
3705 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
3706 random hash function to use with the @option{-R} option. @xref{Random
3713 @cindex sort stability
3714 @cindex sort's last-resort comparison
3716 Make @command{sort} stable by disabling its last-resort comparison.
3717 This option has no effect if no fields or global ordering options
3718 other than @option{--reverse} (@option{-r}) are specified.
3721 @itemx --buffer-size=@var{size}
3723 @opindex --buffer-size
3724 @cindex size for main memory sorting
3725 Use a main-memory sort buffer of the given @var{size}. By default,
3726 @var{size} is in units of 1024 bytes. Appending @samp{%} causes
3727 @var{size} to be interpreted as a percentage of physical memory.
3728 Appending @samp{K} multiplies @var{size} by 1024 (the default),
3729 @samp{M} by 1,048,576, @samp{G} by 1,073,741,824, and so on for
3730 @samp{T}, @samp{P}, @samp{E}, @samp{Z}, and @samp{Y}. Appending
3731 @samp{b} causes @var{size} to be interpreted as a byte count, with no
3734 This option can improve the performance of @command{sort} by causing it
3735 to start with a larger or smaller sort buffer than the default.
3736 However, this option affects only the initial buffer size. The buffer
3737 grows beyond @var{size} if @command{sort} encounters input lines larger
3740 @item -t @var{separator}
3741 @itemx --field-separator=@var{separator}
3743 @opindex --field-separator
3744 @cindex field separator character
3745 Use character @var{separator} as the field separator when finding the
3746 sort keys in each line. By default, fields are separated by the empty
3747 string between a non-blank character and a blank character.
3748 By default a blank is a space or a tab, but the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale
3751 That is, given the input line @w{@samp{ foo bar}}, @command{sort} breaks it
3752 into fields @w{@samp{ foo}} and @w{@samp{ bar}}. The field separator is
3753 not considered to be part of either the field preceding or the field
3754 following, so with @samp{sort @w{-t " "}} the same input line has
3755 three fields: an empty field, @samp{foo}, and @samp{bar}.
3756 However, fields that extend to the end of the line,
3757 as @option{-k 2}, or fields consisting of a range, as @option{-k 2,3},
3758 retain the field separators present between the endpoints of the range.
3760 To specify a null character (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) as
3761 the field separator, use the two-character string @samp{\0}, e.g.,
3762 @samp{sort -t '\0'}.
3764 @item -T @var{tempdir}
3765 @itemx --temporary-directory=@var{tempdir}
3767 @opindex --temporary-directory
3768 @cindex temporary directory
3770 Use directory @var{tempdir} to store temporary files, overriding the
3771 @env{TMPDIR} environment variable. If this option is given more than
3772 once, temporary files are stored in all the directories given. If you
3773 have a large sort or merge that is I/O-bound, you can often improve
3774 performance by using this option to specify directories on different
3775 disks and controllers.
3781 @cindex uniquifying output
3783 Normally, output only the first of a sequence of lines that compare
3784 equal. For the @option{--check} (@option{-c} or @option{-C}) option,
3785 check that no pair of consecutive lines compares equal.
3787 This option also disables the default last-resort comparison.
3789 The commands @code{sort -u} and @code{sort | uniq} are equivalent, but
3790 this equivalence does not extend to arbitrary @command{sort} options.
3791 For example, @code{sort -n -u} inspects only the value of the initial
3792 numeric string when checking for uniqueness, whereas @code{sort -n |
3793 uniq} inspects the entire line. @xref{uniq invocation}.
3796 @itemx --zero-terminated
3798 @opindex --zero-terminated
3799 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
3800 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
3801 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
3802 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
3803 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
3804 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
3805 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
3806 or other special characters).
3810 Historical (BSD and System V) implementations of @command{sort} have
3811 differed in their interpretation of some options, particularly
3812 @option{-b}, @option{-f}, and @option{-n}. @sc{gnu} sort follows the @acronym{POSIX}
3813 behavior, which is usually (but not always!) like the System V behavior.
3814 According to @acronym{POSIX}, @option{-n} no longer implies @option{-b}. For
3815 consistency, @option{-M} has been changed in the same way. This may
3816 affect the meaning of character positions in field specifications in
3817 obscure cases. The only fix is to add an explicit @option{-b}.
3819 A position in a sort field specified with @option{-k} may have any
3820 of the option letters @samp{Mbdfinr} appended to it, in which case the
3821 global ordering options are not used for that particular field. The
3822 @option{-b} option may be independently attached to either or both of
3823 the start and end positions of a field specification, and if it is
3824 inherited from the global options it will be attached to both.
3825 If input lines can contain leading or adjacent blanks and @option{-t}
3826 is not used, then @option{-k} is typically combined with @option{-b},
3827 @option{-g}, @option{-M}, or @option{-n}; otherwise the varying
3828 numbers of leading blanks in fields can cause confusing results.
3830 If the start position in a sort field specifier falls after the end of
3831 the line or after the end field, the field is empty. If the @option{-b}
3832 option was specified, the @samp{.@var{c}} part of a field specification
3833 is counted from the first nonblank character of the field.
3835 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
3836 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
3837 On older systems, @command{sort} supports an obsolete origin-zero
3838 syntax @samp{+@var{pos1} [-@var{pos2}]} for specifying sort keys.
3839 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
3840 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
3841 conformance}); it can also be enabled when @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is
3842 not set by using the obsolete syntax with @samp{-@var{pos2}} present.
3844 Scripts intended for use on standard hosts should avoid obsolete
3845 syntax and should use @option{-k} instead. For example, avoid
3846 @samp{sort +2}, since it might be interpreted as either @samp{sort
3847 ./+2} or @samp{sort -k 3}. If your script must also run on hosts that
3848 support only the obsolete syntax, it can use a test like @samp{if sort
3849 -k 1 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then @dots{}} to decide which syntax
3852 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options.
3857 Sort in descending (reverse) numeric order.
3864 Sort alphabetically, omitting the first and second fields
3865 and the blanks at the start of the third field.
3866 This uses a single key composed of the characters beginning
3867 at the start of the first nonblank character in field three
3868 and extending to the end of each line.
3875 Sort numerically on the second field and resolve ties by sorting
3876 alphabetically on the third and fourth characters of field five.
3877 Use @samp{:} as the field delimiter.
3880 sort -t : -k 2,2n -k 5.3,5.4
3883 Note that if you had written @option{-k 2n} instead of @option{-k 2,2n}
3884 @command{sort} would have used all characters beginning in the second field
3885 and extending to the end of the line as the primary @emph{numeric}
3886 key. For the large majority of applications, treating keys spanning
3887 more than one field as numeric will not do what you expect.
3889 Also note that the @samp{n} modifier was applied to the field-end
3890 specifier for the first key. It would have been equivalent to
3891 specify @option{-k 2n,2} or @option{-k 2n,2n}. All modifiers except
3892 @samp{b} apply to the associated @emph{field}, regardless of whether
3893 the modifier character is attached to the field-start and/or the
3894 field-end part of the key specifier.
3897 Sort the password file on the fifth field and ignore any
3898 leading blanks. Sort lines with equal values in field five
3899 on the numeric user ID in field three. Fields are separated
3903 sort -t : -k 5b,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
3904 sort -t : -n -k 5b,5 -k 3,3 /etc/passwd
3905 sort -t : -b -k 5,5 -k 3,3n /etc/passwd
3908 These three commands have equivalent effect. The first specifies that
3909 the first key's start position ignores leading blanks and the second
3910 key is sorted numerically. The other two commands rely on global
3911 options being inherited by sort keys that lack modifiers. The inheritance
3912 works in this case because @option{-k 5b,5b} and @option{-k 5b,5} are
3913 equivalent, as the location of a field-end lacking a @samp{.@var{c}}
3914 character position is not affected by whether initial blanks are
3918 Sort a set of log files, primarily by IPv4 address and secondarily by
3919 time stamp. If two lines' primary and secondary keys are identical,
3920 output the lines in the same order that they were input. The log
3921 files contain lines that look like this:
3924 4.150.156.3 - - [01/Apr/2004:06:31:51 +0000] message 1
3925 211.24.3.231 - - [24/Apr/2004:20:17:39 +0000] message 2
3928 Fields are separated by exactly one space. Sort IPv4 addresses
3929 lexicographically, e.g., 212.61.52.2 sorts before 212.129.233.201
3930 because 61 is less than 129.
3933 sort -s -t ' ' -k 4.9n -k 4.5M -k 4.2n -k 4.14,4.21 file*.log |
3934 sort -s -t '.' -k 1,1n -k 2,2n -k 3,3n -k 4,4n
3937 This example cannot be done with a single @command{sort} invocation,
3938 since IPv4 address components are separated by @samp{.} while dates
3939 come just after a space. So it is broken down into two invocations of
3940 @command{sort}: the first sorts by time stamp and the second by IPv4
3941 address. The time stamp is sorted by year, then month, then day, and
3942 finally by hour-minute-second field, using @option{-k} to isolate each
3943 field. Except for hour-minute-second there's no need to specify the
3944 end of each key field, since the @samp{n} and @samp{M} modifiers sort
3945 based on leading prefixes that cannot cross field boundaries. The
3946 IPv4 addresses are sorted lexicographically. The second sort uses
3947 @samp{-s} so that ties in the primary key are broken by the secondary
3948 key; the first sort uses @samp{-s} so that the combination of the two
3952 Generate a tags file in case-insensitive sorted order.
3955 find src -type f -print0 | sort -z -f | xargs -0 etags --append
3958 The use of @option{-print0}, @option{-z}, and @option{-0} in this case means
3959 that file names that contain blanks or other special characters are
3961 by the sort operation.
3963 @c This example is a bit contrived and needs more explanation.
3965 @c Sort records separated by an arbitrary string by using a pipe to convert
3966 @c each record delimiter string to @samp{\0}, then using sort's -z option,
3967 @c and converting each @samp{\0} back to the original record delimiter.
3970 @c printf 'c\n\nb\n\na\n'|perl -0pe 's/\n\n/\n\0/g'|sort -z|perl -0pe 's/\0/\n/g'
3974 Shuffle a list of directories, but preserve the order of files within
3975 each directory. For instance, one could use this to generate a music
3976 playlist in which albums are shuffled but the songs of each album are
3980 ls */* | sort -t / -k 1,1R -k 2,2
3986 @node shuf invocation
3987 @section @command{shuf}: Shuffling text
3990 @cindex shuffling files
3992 @command{shuf} shuffles its input by outputting a random permutation
3993 of its input lines. Each output permutation is equally likely.
3997 shuf [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]
3998 shuf -e [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
3999 shuf -i @var{lo}-@var{hi} [@var{option}]@dots{}
4002 @command{shuf} has three modes of operation that affect where it
4003 obtains its input lines. By default, it reads lines from standard
4004 input. The following options change the operation mode:
4012 @cindex command-line operands to shuffle
4013 Treat each command-line operand as an input line.
4015 @item -i @var{lo}-@var{hi}
4016 @itemx --input-range=@var{lo}-@var{hi}
4018 @opindex --input-range
4019 @cindex input range to shuffle
4020 Act as if input came from a file containing the range of unsigned
4021 decimal integers @var{lo}@dots{}@var{hi}, one per line.
4025 @command{shuf}'s other options can affect its behavior in all
4030 @item -n @var{lines}
4031 @itemx --head-lines=@var{lines}
4033 @opindex --head-lines
4034 @cindex head of output
4035 Output at most @var{lines} lines. By default, all input lines are
4038 @item -o @var{output-file}
4039 @itemx --output=@var{output-file}
4042 @cindex overwriting of input, allowed
4043 Write output to @var{output-file} instead of standard output.
4044 @command{shuf} reads all input before opening
4045 @var{output-file}, so you can safely shuffle a file in place by using
4046 commands like @code{shuf -o F <F} and @code{cat F | shuf -o F}.
4048 @item --random-source=@var{file}
4049 @opindex --random-source
4050 @cindex random source for shuffling
4051 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to determine which
4052 permutation to generate. @xref{Random sources}.
4055 @itemx --zero-terminated
4057 @opindex --zero-terminated
4058 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4059 Treat the input and output as a set of lines, each terminated by a zero byte
4060 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (Null) character) instead of an
4061 @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed).
4062 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{perl -0} or
4063 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4064 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4065 or other special characters).
4081 might produce the output
4091 Similarly, the command:
4094 shuf -e clubs hearts diamonds spades
4108 and the command @samp{shuf -i 1-4} might output:
4118 These examples all have four input lines, so @command{shuf} might
4119 produce any of the twenty-four possible permutations of the input. In
4120 general, if there are @var{N} input lines, there are @var{N}! (i.e.,
4121 @var{N} factorial, or @var{N} * (@var{N} - 1) * @dots{} * 1) possible
4122 output permutations.
4127 @node uniq invocation
4128 @section @command{uniq}: Uniquify files
4131 @cindex uniquify files
4133 @command{uniq} writes the unique lines in the given @file{input}, or
4134 standard input if nothing is given or for an @var{input} name of
4138 uniq [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4141 By default, @command{uniq} prints its input lines, except that
4142 it discards all but the first of adjacent repeated lines, so that
4143 no output lines are repeated. Optionally, it can instead discard
4144 lines that are not repeated, or all repeated lines.
4146 The input need not be sorted, but repeated input lines are detected
4147 only if they are adjacent. If you want to discard non-adjacent
4148 duplicate lines, perhaps you want to use @code{sort -u}.
4149 @xref{sort invocation}.
4152 Comparisons use the character collating sequence specified by the
4153 @env{LC_COLLATE} locale category.
4155 If no @var{output} file is specified, @command{uniq} writes to standard
4158 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4163 @itemx --skip-fields=@var{n}
4165 @opindex --skip-fields
4166 Skip @var{n} fields on each line before checking for uniqueness. Use
4167 a null string for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} fields. Fields
4168 are sequences of non-space non-tab characters that are separated from
4169 each other by at least one space or tab.
4171 For compatibility @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4172 @option{-@var{n}}. New scripts should use @option{-f @var{n}} instead.
4175 @itemx --skip-chars=@var{n}
4177 @opindex --skip-chars
4178 Skip @var{n} characters before checking for uniqueness. Use a null string
4179 for comparison if a line has fewer than @var{n} characters. If you use both
4180 the field and character skipping options, fields are skipped over first.
4182 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
4183 On older systems, @command{uniq} supports an obsolete option syntax
4185 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
4186 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
4187 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
4188 behavior depends on this variable.
4189 For example, use @samp{uniq ./+10} or @samp{uniq -s 10} rather than
4190 the ambiguous @samp{uniq +10}.
4196 Print the number of times each line occurred along with the line.
4199 @itemx --ignore-case
4201 @opindex --ignore-case
4202 Ignore differences in case when comparing lines.
4208 @cindex repeated lines, outputting
4209 Discard lines that are not repeated. When used by itself, this option
4210 causes @command{uniq} to print the first copy of each repeated line,
4214 @itemx --all-repeated[=@var{delimit-method}]
4216 @opindex --all-repeated
4217 @cindex all repeated lines, outputting
4218 Do not discard the second and subsequent repeated input lines,
4219 but discard lines that are not repeated.
4220 This option is useful mainly in conjunction with other options e.g.,
4221 to ignore case or to compare only selected fields.
4222 The optional @var{delimit-method} tells how to delimit
4223 groups of repeated lines, and must be one of the following:
4228 Do not delimit groups of repeated lines.
4229 This is equivalent to @option{--all-repeated} (@option{-D}).
4232 Output a newline before each group of repeated lines.
4233 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4234 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4237 Separate groups of repeated lines with a single newline.
4238 With @option{--zero-terminated} (@option{-z}), use
4239 an @acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul} (zero) byte instead of a newline.
4240 This is the same as using @samp{prepend}, except that
4241 no delimiter is inserted before the first group, and hence
4242 may be better suited for output direct to users.
4245 Note that when groups are delimited and the input stream contains
4246 two or more consecutive blank lines, then the output is ambiguous.
4247 To avoid that, filter the input through @samp{tr -s '\n'} to replace
4248 each sequence of consecutive newlines with a single newline.
4250 This is a @sc{gnu} extension.
4251 @c FIXME: give an example showing *how* it's useful
4257 @cindex unique lines, outputting
4258 Discard the first repeated line. When used by itself, this option
4259 causes @command{uniq} to print unique lines, and nothing else.
4262 @itemx --check-chars=@var{n}
4264 @opindex --check-chars
4265 Compare at most @var{n} characters on each line (after skipping any specified
4266 fields and characters). By default the entire rest of the lines are
4270 @itemx --zero-terminated
4272 @opindex --zero-terminated
4273 @cindex sort zero-terminated lines
4274 Treat the input as a set of lines, each terminated by a null character
4275 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{nul}) instead of a line feed
4276 (@acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf}).
4277 This option can be useful in conjunction with @samp{sort -z}, @samp{perl -0} or
4278 @samp{find -print0} and @samp{xargs -0} which do the same in order to
4279 reliably handle arbitrary file names (even those containing blanks
4280 or other special characters).
4287 @node comm invocation
4288 @section @command{comm}: Compare two sorted files line by line
4291 @cindex line-by-line comparison
4292 @cindex comparing sorted files
4294 @command{comm} writes to standard output lines that are common, and lines
4295 that are unique, to two input files; a file name of @samp{-} means
4296 standard input. Synopsis:
4299 comm [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
4303 Before @command{comm} can be used, the input files must be sorted using the
4304 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
4305 If an input file ends in a non-newline
4306 character, a newline is silently appended. The @command{sort} command with
4307 no options always outputs a file that is suitable input to @command{comm}.
4309 @cindex differing lines
4310 @cindex common lines
4311 With no options, @command{comm} produces three-column output. Column one
4312 contains lines unique to @var{file1}, column two contains lines unique
4313 to @var{file2}, and column three contains lines common to both files.
4314 Columns are separated by a single TAB character.
4315 @c FIXME: when there's an option to supply an alternative separator
4316 @c string, append `by default' to the above sentence.
4321 The options @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and @option{-3} suppress printing of
4322 the corresponding columns. Also see @ref{Common options}.
4324 Unlike some other comparison utilities, @command{comm} has an exit
4325 status that does not depend on the result of the comparison.
4326 Upon normal completion @command{comm} produces an exit code of zero.
4327 If there is an error it exits with nonzero status.
4330 @node tsort invocation
4331 @section @command{tsort}: Topological sort
4334 @cindex topological sort
4336 @command{tsort} performs a topological sort on the given @var{file}, or
4337 standard input if no input file is given or for a @var{file} of
4338 @samp{-}. For more details and some history, see @ref{tsort background}.
4342 tsort [@var{option}] [@var{file}]
4345 @command{tsort} reads its input as pairs of strings, separated by blanks,
4346 indicating a partial ordering. The output is a total ordering that
4347 corresponds to the given partial ordering.
4361 will produce the output
4372 Consider a more realistic example.
4373 You have a large set of functions all in one file, and they may all be
4374 declared static except one. Currently that one (say @code{main}) is the
4375 first function defined in the file, and the ones it calls directly follow
4376 it, followed by those they call, etc. Let's say that you are determined
4377 to take advantage of prototypes, so you have to choose between declaring
4378 all of those functions (which means duplicating a lot of information from
4379 the definitions) and rearranging the functions so that as many as possible
4380 are defined before they are used. One way to automate the latter process
4381 is to get a list for each function of the functions it calls directly.
4382 Many programs can generate such lists. They describe a call graph.
4383 Consider the following list, in which a given line indicates that the
4384 function on the left calls the one on the right directly.
4390 tail_file pretty_name
4391 tail_file write_header
4393 tail_forever recheck
4394 tail_forever pretty_name
4395 tail_forever write_header
4396 tail_forever dump_remainder
4399 tail_lines start_lines
4400 tail_lines dump_remainder
4401 tail_lines file_lines
4402 tail_lines pipe_lines
4404 tail_bytes start_bytes
4405 tail_bytes dump_remainder
4406 tail_bytes pipe_bytes
4407 file_lines dump_remainder
4411 then you can use @command{tsort} to produce an ordering of those
4412 functions that satisfies your requirement.
4415 example$ tsort call-graph | tac
4435 @command{tsort} detects any cycles in the input and writes the first cycle
4436 encountered to standard error.
4438 Note that for a given partial ordering, generally there is no unique
4439 total ordering. In the context of the call graph above, the function
4440 @code{parse_options} may be placed anywhere in the list as long as it
4441 precedes @code{main}.
4443 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
4446 @node tsort background
4447 @section @command{tsort}: Background
4449 @command{tsort} exists because very early versions of the Unix linker processed
4450 an archive file exactly once, and in order. As @command{ld} read each object
4451 in the archive, it decided whether it was needed in the program based on
4452 whether it defined any symbols which were undefined at that point in
4455 This meant that dependencies within the archive had to be handled
4456 specially. For example, @code{scanf} probably calls @code{read}. That means
4457 that in a single pass through an archive, it was important for @code{scanf.o}
4458 to appear before read.o, because otherwise a program which calls
4459 @code{scanf} but not @code{read} might end up with an unexpected unresolved
4460 reference to @code{read}.
4462 The way to address this problem was to first generate a set of
4463 dependencies of one object file on another. This was done by a shell
4464 script called @command{lorder}. The GNU tools don't provide a version of
4465 lorder, as far as I know, but you can still find it in BSD
4468 Then you ran @command{tsort} over the @command{lorder} output, and you used the
4469 resulting sort to define the order in which you added objects to the archive.
4471 This whole procedure has been obsolete since about 1980, because
4472 Unix archives now contain a symbol table (traditionally built by
4473 @command{ranlib}, now generally built by @command{ar} itself), and the Unix
4474 linker uses the symbol table to effectively make multiple passes over
4477 Anyhow, that's where tsort came from. To solve an old problem with
4478 the way the linker handled archive files, which has since been solved
4484 @node ptx invocation
4485 @section @command{ptx}: Produce permuted indexes
4489 @command{ptx} reads a text file and essentially produces a permuted index, with
4490 each keyword in its context. The calling sketch is either one of:
4493 ptx [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{file} @dots{}]
4494 ptx -G [@var{option} @dots{}] [@var{input} [@var{output}]]
4497 The @option{-G} (or its equivalent: @option{--traditional}) option disables
4498 all @sc{gnu} extensions and reverts to traditional mode, thus introducing some
4499 limitations and changing several of the program's default option values.
4500 When @option{-G} is not specified, @sc{gnu} extensions are always enabled.
4501 @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx} are documented wherever appropriate in this
4502 document. For the full list, see @xref{Compatibility in ptx}.
4504 Individual options are explained in the following sections.
4506 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, there may be zero, one or several
4507 @var{file}s after the options. If there is no @var{file}, the program
4508 reads the standard input. If there is one or several @var{file}s, they
4509 give the name of input files which are all read in turn, as if all the
4510 input files were concatenated. However, there is a full contextual
4511 break between each file and, when automatic referencing is requested,
4512 file names and line numbers refer to individual text input files. In
4513 all cases, the program outputs the permuted index to the standard
4516 When @sc{gnu} extensions are @emph{not} enabled, that is, when the program
4517 operates in traditional mode, there may be zero, one or two parameters
4518 besides the options. If there are no parameters, the program reads the
4519 standard input and outputs the permuted index to the standard output.
4520 If there is only one parameter, it names the text @var{input} to be read
4521 instead of the standard input. If two parameters are given, they give
4522 respectively the name of the @var{input} file to read and the name of
4523 the @var{output} file to produce. @emph{Be very careful} to note that,
4524 in this case, the contents of file given by the second parameter is
4525 destroyed. This behavior is dictated by System V @command{ptx}
4526 compatibility; @sc{gnu} Standards normally discourage output parameters not
4527 introduced by an option.
4529 Note that for @emph{any} file named as the value of an option or as an
4530 input text file, a single dash @kbd{-} may be used, in which case
4531 standard input is assumed. However, it would not make sense to use this
4532 convention more than once per program invocation.
4535 * General options in ptx:: Options which affect general program behavior.
4536 * Charset selection in ptx:: Underlying character set considerations.
4537 * Input processing in ptx:: Input fields, contexts, and keyword selection.
4538 * Output formatting in ptx:: Types of output format, and sizing the fields.
4539 * Compatibility in ptx::
4543 @node General options in ptx
4544 @subsection General options
4549 @itemx --traditional
4550 As already explained, this option disables all @sc{gnu} extensions to
4551 @command{ptx} and switches to traditional mode.
4554 Print a short help on standard output, then exit without further
4558 Print the program version on standard output, then exit without further
4566 @node Charset selection in ptx
4567 @subsection Charset selection
4569 @c FIXME: People don't necessarily know what an IBM-PC was these days.
4570 As it is set up now, the program assumes that the input file is coded
4571 using 8-bit @acronym{ISO} 8859-1 code, also known as Latin-1 character set,
4572 @emph{unless} it is compiled for MS-DOS, in which case it uses the
4573 character set of the IBM-PC@. (@sc{gnu} @command{ptx} is not known to work on
4574 smaller MS-DOS machines anymore.) Compared to 7-bit @acronym{ASCII}, the set
4575 of characters which are letters is different; this alters the behavior
4576 of regular expression matching. Thus, the default regular expression
4577 for a keyword allows foreign or diacriticized letters. Keyword sorting,
4578 however, is still crude; it obeys the underlying character set ordering
4584 @itemx --ignore-case
4585 Fold lower case letters to upper case for sorting.
4590 @node Input processing in ptx
4591 @subsection Word selection and input processing
4596 @itemx --break-file=@var{file}
4598 This option provides an alternative (to @option{-W}) method of describing
4599 which characters make up words. It introduces the name of a
4600 file which contains a list of characters which can@emph{not} be part of
4601 one word; this file is called the @dfn{Break file}. Any character which
4602 is not part of the Break file is a word constituent. If both options
4603 @option{-b} and @option{-W} are specified, then @option{-W} has precedence and
4604 @option{-b} is ignored.
4606 When @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the only way to avoid newline as a
4607 break character is to write all the break characters in the file with no
4608 newline at all, not even at the end of the file. When @sc{gnu} extensions
4609 are disabled, spaces, tabs and newlines are always considered as break
4610 characters even if not included in the Break file.
4613 @itemx --ignore-file=@var{file}
4615 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4616 never be taken as keywords in concordance output. It is called the
4617 @dfn{Ignore file}. The file contains exactly one word in each line; the
4618 end of line separation of words is not subject to the value of the
4622 @itemx --only-file=@var{file}
4624 The file associated with this option contains a list of words which will
4625 be retained in concordance output; any word not mentioned in this file
4626 is ignored. The file is called the @dfn{Only file}. The file contains
4627 exactly one word in each line; the end of line separation of words is
4628 not subject to the value of the @option{-S} option.
4630 There is no default for the Only file. When both an Only file and an
4631 Ignore file are specified, a word is considered a keyword only
4632 if it is listed in the Only file and not in the Ignore file.
4637 On each input line, the leading sequence of non-white space characters will be
4638 taken to be a reference that has the purpose of identifying this input
4639 line in the resulting permuted index. For more information about reference
4640 production, see @xref{Output formatting in ptx}.
4641 Using this option changes the default value for option @option{-S}.
4643 Using this option, the program does not try very hard to remove
4644 references from contexts in output, but it succeeds in doing so
4645 @emph{when} the context ends exactly at the newline. If option
4646 @option{-r} is used with @option{-S} default value, or when @sc{gnu} extensions
4647 are disabled, this condition is always met and references are completely
4648 excluded from the output contexts.
4650 @item -S @var{regexp}
4651 @itemx --sentence-regexp=@var{regexp}
4653 This option selects which regular expression will describe the end of a
4654 line or the end of a sentence. In fact, this regular expression is not
4655 the only distinction between end of lines or end of sentences, and input
4656 line boundaries have no special significance outside this option. By
4657 default, when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled and if @option{-r} option is not
4658 used, end of sentences are used. In this case, this @var{regex} is
4659 imported from @sc{gnu} Emacs:
4662 [.?!][]\"')@}]*\\($\\|\t\\| \\)[ \t\n]*
4665 Whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled or if @option{-r} option is used, end
4666 of lines are used; in this case, the default @var{regexp} is just:
4672 Using an empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to completely disabling end of
4673 line or end of sentence recognition. In this case, the whole file is
4674 considered to be a single big line or sentence. The user might want to
4675 disallow all truncation flag generation as well, through option @option{-F
4676 ""}. @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4679 When the keywords happen to be near the beginning of the input line or
4680 sentence, this often creates an unused area at the beginning of the
4681 output context line; when the keywords happen to be near the end of the
4682 input line or sentence, this often creates an unused area at the end of
4683 the output context line. The program tries to fill those unused areas
4684 by wrapping around context in them; the tail of the input line or
4685 sentence is used to fill the unused area on the left of the output line;
4686 the head of the input line or sentence is used to fill the unused area
4687 on the right of the output line.
4689 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4690 sequences from the C language are recognized and converted to the
4691 corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4693 @item -W @var{regexp}
4694 @itemx --word-regexp=@var{regexp}
4696 This option selects which regular expression will describe each keyword.
4697 By default, if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, a word is a sequence of
4698 letters; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{\w+}. When @sc{gnu} extensions are
4699 disabled, a word is by default anything which ends with a space, a tab
4700 or a newline; the @var{regexp} used is @samp{[^ \t\n]+}.
4702 An empty @var{regexp} is equivalent to not using this option.
4703 @xref{Regexps, , Syntax of Regular Expressions, emacs, The GNU Emacs
4706 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4707 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4708 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4713 @node Output formatting in ptx
4714 @subsection Output formatting
4716 Output format is mainly controlled by the @option{-O} and @option{-T} options
4717 described in the table below. When neither @option{-O} nor @option{-T} are
4718 selected, and if @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, the program chooses an
4719 output format suitable for a dumb terminal. Each keyword occurrence is
4720 output to the center of one line, surrounded by its left and right
4721 contexts. Each field is properly justified, so the concordance output
4722 can be readily observed. As a special feature, if automatic
4723 references are selected by option @option{-A} and are output before the
4724 left context, that is, if option @option{-R} is @emph{not} selected, then
4725 a colon is added after the reference; this nicely interfaces with @sc{gnu}
4726 Emacs @code{next-error} processing. In this default output format, each
4727 white space character, like newline and tab, is merely changed to
4728 exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress consecutive
4729 spaces. This might change in the future. Except for those white space
4730 characters, every other character of the underlying set of 256
4731 characters is transmitted verbatim.
4733 Output format is further controlled by the following options.
4737 @item -g @var{number}
4738 @itemx --gap-size=@var{number}
4740 Select the size of the minimum white space gap between the fields on the
4743 @item -w @var{number}
4744 @itemx --width=@var{number}
4746 Select the maximum output width of each final line. If references are
4747 used, they are included or excluded from the maximum output width
4748 depending on the value of option @option{-R}. If this option is not
4749 selected, that is, when references are output before the left context,
4750 the maximum output width takes into account the maximum length of all
4751 references. If this option is selected, that is, when references are
4752 output after the right context, the maximum output width does not take
4753 into account the space taken by references, nor the gap that precedes
4757 @itemx --auto-reference
4759 Select automatic references. Each input line will have an automatic
4760 reference made up of the file name and the line ordinal, with a single
4761 colon between them. However, the file name will be empty when standard
4762 input is being read. If both @option{-A} and @option{-r} are selected, then
4763 the input reference is still read and skipped, but the automatic
4764 reference is used at output time, overriding the input reference.
4767 @itemx --right-side-refs
4769 In the default output format, when option @option{-R} is not used, any
4770 references produced by the effect of options @option{-r} or @option{-A} are
4771 placed to the far right of output lines, after the right context. With
4772 default output format, when the @option{-R} option is specified, references
4773 are rather placed at the beginning of each output line, before the left
4774 context. For any other output format, option @option{-R} is
4775 ignored, with one exception: with @option{-R} the width of references
4776 is @emph{not} taken into account in total output width given by @option{-w}.
4778 This option is automatically selected whenever @sc{gnu} extensions are
4781 @item -F @var{string}
4782 @itemx --flac-truncation=@var{string}
4784 This option will request that any truncation in the output be reported
4785 using the string @var{string}. Most output fields theoretically extend
4786 towards the beginning or the end of the current line, or current
4787 sentence, as selected with option @option{-S}. But there is a maximum
4788 allowed output line width, changeable through option @option{-w}, which is
4789 further divided into space for various output fields. When a field has
4790 to be truncated because it cannot extend beyond the beginning or the end of
4791 the current line to fit in, then a truncation occurs. By default,
4792 the string used is a single slash, as in @option{-F /}.
4794 @var{string} may have more than one character, as in @option{-F ...}.
4795 Also, in the particular case when @var{string} is empty (@option{-F ""}),
4796 truncation flagging is disabled, and no truncation marks are appended in
4799 As a matter of convenience to the user, many usual backslashed escape
4800 sequences, as found in the C language, are recognized and converted to
4801 the corresponding characters by @command{ptx} itself.
4803 @item -M @var{string}
4804 @itemx --macro-name=@var{string}
4806 Select another @var{string} to be used instead of @samp{xx}, while
4807 generating output suitable for @command{nroff}, @command{troff} or @TeX{}.
4810 @itemx --format=roff
4812 Choose an output format suitable for @command{nroff} or @command{troff}
4813 processing. Each output line will look like:
4816 .xx "@var{tail}" "@var{before}" "@var{keyword_and_after}" "@var{head}" "@var{ref}"
4819 so it will be possible to write a @samp{.xx} roff macro to take care of
4820 the output typesetting. This is the default output format when @sc{gnu}
4821 extensions are disabled. Option @option{-M} can be used to change
4822 @samp{xx} to another macro name.
4824 In this output format, each non-graphical character, like newline and
4825 tab, is merely changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to
4826 compress consecutive spaces. Each quote character: @kbd{"} is doubled
4827 so it will be correctly processed by @command{nroff} or @command{troff}.
4832 Choose an output format suitable for @TeX{} processing. Each output
4833 line will look like:
4836 \xx @{@var{tail}@}@{@var{before}@}@{@var{keyword}@}@{@var{after}@}@{@var{head}@}@{@var{ref}@}
4840 so it will be possible to write a @code{\xx} definition to take care of
4841 the output typesetting. Note that when references are not being
4842 produced, that is, neither option @option{-A} nor option @option{-r} is
4843 selected, the last parameter of each @code{\xx} call is inhibited.
4844 Option @option{-M} can be used to change @samp{xx} to another macro
4847 In this output format, some special characters, like @kbd{$}, @kbd{%},
4848 @kbd{&}, @kbd{#} and @kbd{_} are automatically protected with a
4849 backslash. Curly brackets @kbd{@{}, @kbd{@}} are protected with a
4850 backslash and a pair of dollar signs (to force mathematical mode). The
4851 backslash itself produces the sequence @code{\backslash@{@}}.
4852 Circumflex and tilde diacritical marks produce the sequence @code{^\@{ @}} and
4853 @code{~\@{ @}} respectively. Other diacriticized characters of the
4854 underlying character set produce an appropriate @TeX{} sequence as far
4855 as possible. The other non-graphical characters, like newline and tab,
4856 and all other characters which are not part of @acronym{ASCII}, are merely
4857 changed to exactly one space, with no special attempt to compress
4858 consecutive spaces. Let me know how to improve this special character
4859 processing for @TeX{}.
4864 @node Compatibility in ptx
4865 @subsection The @sc{gnu} extensions to @command{ptx}
4867 This version of @command{ptx} contains a few features which do not exist in
4868 System V @command{ptx}. These extra features are suppressed by using the
4869 @option{-G} command line option, unless overridden by other command line
4870 options. Some @sc{gnu} extensions cannot be recovered by overriding, so the
4871 simple rule is to avoid @option{-G} if you care about @sc{gnu} extensions.
4872 Here are the differences between this program and System V @command{ptx}.
4877 This program can read many input files at once, it always writes the
4878 resulting concordance on standard output. On the other hand, System V
4879 @command{ptx} reads only one file and sends the result to standard output
4880 or, if a second @var{file} parameter is given on the command, to that
4883 Having output parameters not introduced by options is a dangerous
4884 practice which @sc{gnu} avoids as far as possible. So, for using @command{ptx}
4885 portably between @sc{gnu} and System V, you should always use it with a
4886 single input file, and always expect the result on standard output. You
4887 might also want to automatically configure in a @option{-G} option to
4888 @command{ptx} calls in products using @command{ptx}, if the configurator finds
4889 that the installed @command{ptx} accepts @option{-G}.
4892 The only options available in System V @command{ptx} are options @option{-b},
4893 @option{-f}, @option{-g}, @option{-i}, @option{-o}, @option{-r}, @option{-t} and
4894 @option{-w}. All other options are @sc{gnu} extensions and are not repeated in
4895 this enumeration. Moreover, some options have a slightly different
4896 meaning when @sc{gnu} extensions are enabled, as explained below.
4899 By default, concordance output is not formatted for @command{troff} or
4900 @command{nroff}. It is rather formatted for a dumb terminal. @command{troff}
4901 or @command{nroff} output may still be selected through option @option{-O}.
4904 Unless @option{-R} option is used, the maximum reference width is
4905 subtracted from the total output line width. With @sc{gnu} extensions
4906 disabled, width of references is not taken into account in the output
4907 line width computations.
4910 All 256 bytes, even null bytes, are always read and processed from
4911 input file with no adverse effect, even if @sc{gnu} extensions are disabled.
4912 However, System V @command{ptx} does not accept 8-bit characters, a few
4913 control characters are rejected, and the tilde @kbd{~} is also rejected.
4916 Input line length is only limited by available memory, even if @sc{gnu}
4917 extensions are disabled. However, System V @command{ptx} processes only
4918 the first 200 characters in each line.
4921 The break (non-word) characters default to be every character except all
4922 letters of the underlying character set, diacriticized or not. When @sc{gnu}
4923 extensions are disabled, the break characters default to space, tab and
4927 The program makes better use of output line width. If @sc{gnu} extensions
4928 are disabled, the program rather tries to imitate System V @command{ptx},
4929 but still, there are some slight disposition glitches this program does
4930 not completely reproduce.
4933 The user can specify both an Ignore file and an Only file. This is not
4934 allowed with System V @command{ptx}.
4939 @node Operating on fields within a line
4940 @chapter Operating on fields within a line
4943 * cut invocation:: Print selected parts of lines.
4944 * paste invocation:: Merge lines of files.
4945 * join invocation:: Join lines on a common field.
4949 @node cut invocation
4950 @section @command{cut}: Print selected parts of lines
4953 @command{cut} writes to standard output selected parts of each line of each
4954 input file, or standard input if no files are given or for a file name of
4958 cut @var{option}@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
4961 In the table which follows, the @var{byte-list}, @var{character-list},
4962 and @var{field-list} are one or more numbers or ranges (two numbers
4963 separated by a dash) separated by commas. Bytes, characters, and
4964 fields are numbered starting at 1. Incomplete ranges may be
4965 given: @option{-@var{m}} means @samp{1-@var{m}}; @samp{@var{n}-} means
4966 @samp{@var{n}} through end of line or last field. The list elements
4967 can be repeated, can overlap, and can be specified in any order; but
4968 the selected input is written in the same order that it is read, and
4969 is written exactly once.
4971 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common
4976 @item -b @var{byte-list}
4977 @itemx --bytes=@var{byte-list}
4980 Select for printing only the bytes in positions listed in
4981 @var{byte-list}. Tabs and backspaces are treated like any other
4982 character; they take up 1 byte. If an output delimiter is specified,
4983 (see the description of @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that
4984 string between ranges of selected bytes.
4986 @item -c @var{character-list}
4987 @itemx --characters=@var{character-list}
4989 @opindex --characters
4990 Select for printing only the characters in positions listed in
4991 @var{character-list}. The same as @option{-b} for now, but
4992 internationalization will change that. Tabs and backspaces are
4993 treated like any other character; they take up 1 character. If an
4994 output delimiter is specified, (see the description of
4995 @option{--output-delimiter}), then output that string between ranges
4998 @item -f @var{field-list}
4999 @itemx --fields=@var{field-list}
5002 Select for printing only the fields listed in @var{field-list}.
5003 Fields are separated by a TAB character by default. Also print any
5004 line that contains no delimiter character, unless the
5005 @option{--only-delimited} (@option{-s}) option is specified
5007 @item -d @var{input_delim_byte}
5008 @itemx --delimiter=@var{input_delim_byte}
5010 @opindex --delimiter
5011 With @option{-f}, use the first byte of @var{input_delim_byte} as
5012 the input fields separator (default is TAB).
5016 Do not split multi-byte characters (no-op for now).
5019 @itemx --only-delimited
5021 @opindex --only-delimited
5022 For @option{-f}, do not print lines that do not contain the field separator
5023 character. Normally, any line without a field separator is printed verbatim.
5025 @item --output-delimiter=@var{output_delim_string}
5026 @opindex --output-delimiter
5027 With @option{-f}, output fields are separated by @var{output_delim_string}.
5028 The default with @option{-f} is to use the input delimiter.
5029 When using @option{-b} or @option{-c} to select ranges of byte or
5030 character offsets (as opposed to ranges of fields),
5031 output @var{output_delim_string} between non-overlapping
5032 ranges of selected bytes.
5035 @opindex --complement
5036 This option is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
5037 Select for printing the complement of the bytes, characters or fields
5038 selected with the @option{-b}, @option{-c} or @option{-f} options.
5039 In other words, do @emph{not} print the bytes, characters or fields
5040 specified via those options. This option is useful when you have
5041 many fields and want to print all but a few of them.
5048 @node paste invocation
5049 @section @command{paste}: Merge lines of files
5052 @cindex merging files
5054 @command{paste} writes to standard output lines consisting of sequentially
5055 corresponding lines of each given file, separated by a TAB character.
5056 Standard input is used for a file name of @samp{-} or if no input files
5078 paste [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5081 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5089 Paste the lines of one file at a time rather than one line from each
5090 file. Using the above example data:
5093 $ paste -s num2 let3
5098 @item -d @var{delim-list}
5099 @itemx --delimiters=@var{delim-list}
5101 @opindex --delimiters
5102 Consecutively use the characters in @var{delim-list} instead of
5103 TAB to separate merged lines. When @var{delim-list} is
5104 exhausted, start again at its beginning. Using the above example data:
5107 $ paste -d '%_' num2 let3 num2
5118 @node join invocation
5119 @section @command{join}: Join lines on a common field
5122 @cindex common field, joining on
5124 @command{join} writes to standard output a line for each pair of input
5125 lines that have identical join fields. Synopsis:
5128 join [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file1} @var{file2}
5131 Either @var{file1} or @var{file2} (but not both) can be @samp{-},
5132 meaning standard input. @var{file1} and @var{file2} should be
5133 sorted on the join fields.
5136 Normally, the sort order is that of the
5137 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale. Unless
5138 the @option{-t} option is given, the sort comparison ignores blanks at
5139 the start of the join field, as in @code{sort -b}. If the
5140 @option{--ignore-case} option is given, the sort comparison ignores
5141 the case of characters in the join field, as in @code{sort -f}.
5143 The @command{sort} and @command{join} commands should use consistent
5144 locales and options if the output of @command{sort} is fed to
5145 @command{join}. You can use a command like @samp{sort -k 1b,1} to
5146 sort a file on its default join field, but if you select a non-default
5147 locale, join field, separator, or comparison options, then you should
5148 do so consistently between @command{join} and @command{sort}.
5150 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, if the input has no unpairable lines the
5151 sort order can be any order that considers two fields to be equal if and
5152 only if the sort comparison described above considers them to be equal.
5172 @item the join field is the first field in each line;
5173 @item fields in the input are separated by one or more blanks, with leading
5174 blanks on the line ignored;
5175 @item fields in the output are separated by a space;
5176 @item each output line consists of the join field, the remaining
5177 fields from @var{file1}, then the remaining fields from @var{file2}.
5180 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5184 @item -a @var{file-number}
5186 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number} (either
5187 @samp{1} or @samp{2}), in addition to the normal output.
5189 @item -e @var{string}
5191 Replace those output fields that are missing in the input with
5195 @itemx --ignore-case
5197 @opindex --ignore-case
5198 Ignore differences in case when comparing keys.
5199 With this option, the lines of the input files must be ordered in the same way.
5200 Use @samp{sort -f} to produce this ordering.
5202 @item -1 @var{field}
5204 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 1.
5206 @item -2 @var{field}
5208 Join on field @var{field} (a positive integer) of file 2.
5210 @item -j @var{field}
5211 Equivalent to @option{-1 @var{field} -2 @var{field}}.
5213 @item -o @var{field-list}
5214 Construct each output line according to the format in @var{field-list}.
5215 Each element in @var{field-list} is either the single character @samp{0} or
5216 has the form @var{m.n} where the file number, @var{m}, is @samp{1} or
5217 @samp{2} and @var{n} is a positive field number.
5219 A field specification of @samp{0} denotes the join field.
5220 In most cases, the functionality of the @samp{0} field spec
5221 may be reproduced using the explicit @var{m.n} that corresponds
5222 to the join field. However, when printing unpairable lines
5223 (using either of the @option{-a} or @option{-v} options), there is no way
5224 to specify the join field using @var{m.n} in @var{field-list}
5225 if there are unpairable lines in both files.
5226 To give @command{join} that functionality, @acronym{POSIX} invented the @samp{0}
5227 field specification notation.
5229 The elements in @var{field-list}
5230 are separated by commas or blanks.
5231 Blank separators typically need to be quoted for the shell. For
5232 example, the commands @samp{join -o 1.2,2.2} and @samp{join -o '1.2
5233 2.2'} are equivalent.
5235 All output lines---including those printed because of any -a or -v
5236 option---are subject to the specified @var{field-list}.
5239 Use character @var{char} as the input and output field separator.
5240 Treat as significant each occurrence of @var{char} in the input file.
5241 Use @samp{sort -t @var{char}}, without the @option{-b} option of
5242 @samp{sort}, to produce this ordering.
5244 @item -v @var{file-number}
5245 Print a line for each unpairable line in file @var{file-number}
5246 (either @samp{1} or @samp{2}), instead of the normal output.
5253 @node Operating on characters
5254 @chapter Operating on characters
5256 @cindex operating on characters
5258 This commands operate on individual characters.
5261 * tr invocation:: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters.
5262 * expand invocation:: Convert tabs to spaces.
5263 * unexpand invocation:: Convert spaces to tabs.
5268 @section @command{tr}: Translate, squeeze, and/or delete characters
5275 tr [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{set1} [@var{set2}]
5278 @command{tr} copies standard input to standard output, performing
5279 one of the following operations:
5283 translate, and optionally squeeze repeated characters in the result,
5285 squeeze repeated characters,
5289 delete characters, then squeeze repeated characters from the result.
5292 The @var{set1} and (if given) @var{set2} arguments define ordered
5293 sets of characters, referred to below as @var{set1} and @var{set2}. These
5294 sets are the characters of the input that @command{tr} operates on.
5295 The @option{--complement} (@option{-c}, @option{-C}) option replaces
5297 complement (all of the characters that are not in @var{set1}).
5299 Currently @command{tr} fully supports only single-byte characters.
5300 Eventually it will support multibyte characters; when it does, the
5301 @option{-C} option will cause it to complement the set of characters,
5302 whereas @option{-c} will cause it to complement the set of values.
5303 This distinction will matter only when some values are not characters,
5304 and this is possible only in locales using multibyte encodings when
5305 the input contains encoding errors.
5307 The program accepts the @option{--help} and @option{--version}
5308 options. @xref{Common options}. Options must precede operands.
5313 * Character sets:: Specifying sets of characters.
5314 * Translating:: Changing one set of characters to another.
5315 * Squeezing:: Squeezing repeats and deleting.
5319 @node Character sets
5320 @subsection Specifying sets of characters
5322 @cindex specifying sets of characters
5324 The format of the @var{set1} and @var{set2} arguments resembles
5325 the format of regular expressions; however, they are not regular
5326 expressions, only lists of characters. Most characters simply
5327 represent themselves in these strings, but the strings can contain
5328 the shorthands listed below, for convenience. Some of them can be
5329 used only in @var{set1} or @var{set2}, as noted below.
5333 @item Backslash escapes
5334 @cindex backslash escapes
5336 The following backslash escape sequences are recognized:
5354 The character with the value given by @var{ooo}, which is 1 to 3
5360 While a backslash followed by a character not listed above is
5361 interpreted as that character, the backslash also effectively
5362 removes any special significance, so it is useful to escape
5363 @samp{[}, @samp{]}, @samp{*}, and @samp{-}.
5368 The notation @samp{@var{m}-@var{n}} expands to all of the characters
5369 from @var{m} through @var{n}, in ascending order. @var{m} should
5370 collate before @var{n}; if it doesn't, an error results. As an example,
5371 @samp{0-9} is the same as @samp{0123456789}.
5373 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} does not support the System V syntax that uses square
5374 brackets to enclose ranges. Translations specified in that format
5375 sometimes work as expected, since the brackets are often transliterated
5376 to themselves. However, they should be avoided because they sometimes
5377 behave unexpectedly. For example, @samp{tr -d '[0-9]'} deletes brackets
5380 Many historically common and even accepted uses of ranges are not
5381 portable. For example, on @acronym{EBCDIC} hosts using the @samp{A-Z}
5382 range will not do what most would expect because @samp{A} through @samp{Z}
5383 are not contiguous as they are in @acronym{ASCII}.
5384 If you can rely on a @acronym{POSIX} compliant version of @command{tr}, then
5385 the best way to work around this is to use character classes (see below).
5386 Otherwise, it is most portable (and most ugly) to enumerate the members
5389 @item Repeated characters
5390 @cindex repeated characters
5392 The notation @samp{[@var{c}*@var{n}]} in @var{set2} expands to @var{n}
5393 copies of character @var{c}. Thus, @samp{[y*6]} is the same as
5394 @samp{yyyyyy}. The notation @samp{[@var{c}*]} in @var{string2} expands
5395 to as many copies of @var{c} as are needed to make @var{set2} as long as
5396 @var{set1}. If @var{n} begins with @samp{0}, it is interpreted in
5397 octal, otherwise in decimal.
5399 @item Character classes
5400 @cindex character classes
5402 The notation @samp{[:@var{class}:]} expands to all of the characters in
5403 the (predefined) class @var{class}. The characters expand in no
5404 particular order, except for the @code{upper} and @code{lower} classes,
5405 which expand in ascending order. When the @option{--delete} (@option{-d})
5406 and @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) options are both given, any
5407 character class can be used in @var{set2}. Otherwise, only the
5408 character classes @code{lower} and @code{upper} are accepted in
5409 @var{set2}, and then only if the corresponding character class
5410 (@code{upper} and @code{lower}, respectively) is specified in the same
5411 relative position in @var{set1}. Doing this specifies case conversion.
5412 The class names are given below; an error results when an invalid class
5424 Horizontal whitespace.
5433 Printable characters, not including space.
5439 Printable characters, including space.
5442 Punctuation characters.
5445 Horizontal or vertical whitespace.
5454 @item Equivalence classes
5455 @cindex equivalence classes
5457 The syntax @samp{[=@var{c}=]} expands to all of the characters that are
5458 equivalent to @var{c}, in no particular order. Equivalence classes are
5459 a relatively recent invention intended to support non-English alphabets.
5460 But there seems to be no standard way to define them or determine their
5461 contents. Therefore, they are not fully implemented in @sc{gnu} @command{tr};
5462 each character's equivalence class consists only of that character,
5463 which is of no particular use.
5469 @subsection Translating
5471 @cindex translating characters
5473 @command{tr} performs translation when @var{set1} and @var{set2} are
5474 both given and the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option is not given.
5475 @command{tr} translates each character of its input that is in @var{set1}
5476 to the corresponding character in @var{set2}. Characters not in
5477 @var{set1} are passed through unchanged. When a character appears more
5478 than once in @var{set1} and the corresponding characters in @var{set2}
5479 are not all the same, only the final one is used. For example, these
5480 two commands are equivalent:
5487 A common use of @command{tr} is to convert lowercase characters to
5488 uppercase. This can be done in many ways. Here are three of them:
5491 tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ
5493 tr '[:lower:]' '[:upper:]'
5497 But note that using ranges like @code{a-z} above is not portable.
5499 When @command{tr} is performing translation, @var{set1} and @var{set2}
5500 typically have the same length. If @var{set1} is shorter than
5501 @var{set2}, the extra characters at the end of @var{set2} are ignored.
5503 On the other hand, making @var{set1} longer than @var{set2} is not
5504 portable; @acronym{POSIX} says that the result is undefined. In this situation,
5505 BSD @command{tr} pads @var{set2} to the length of @var{set1} by repeating
5506 the last character of @var{set2} as many times as necessary. System V
5507 @command{tr} truncates @var{set1} to the length of @var{set2}.
5509 By default, @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like BSD @command{tr}.
5510 When the @option{--truncate-set1} (@option{-t}) option is given,
5511 @sc{gnu} @command{tr} handles this case like the System V @command{tr}
5512 instead. This option is ignored for operations other than translation.
5514 Acting like System V @command{tr} in this case breaks the relatively common
5518 tr -cs A-Za-z0-9 '\012'
5522 because it converts only zero bytes (the first element in the
5523 complement of @var{set1}), rather than all non-alphanumerics, to
5527 By the way, the above idiom is not portable because it uses ranges, and
5528 it assumes that the octal code for newline is 012.
5529 Assuming a @acronym{POSIX} compliant @command{tr}, here is a better way to write it:
5532 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5537 @subsection Squeezing repeats and deleting
5539 @cindex squeezing repeat characters
5540 @cindex deleting characters
5542 When given just the @option{--delete} (@option{-d}) option, @command{tr}
5543 removes any input characters that are in @var{set1}.
5545 When given just the @option{--squeeze-repeats} (@option{-s}) option,
5546 @command{tr} replaces each input sequence of a repeated character that
5547 is in @var{set1} with a single occurrence of that character.
5549 When given both @option{--delete} and @option{--squeeze-repeats}, @command{tr}
5550 first performs any deletions using @var{set1}, then squeezes repeats
5551 from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5553 The @option{--squeeze-repeats} option may also be used when translating,
5554 in which case @command{tr} first performs translation, then squeezes
5555 repeats from any remaining characters using @var{set2}.
5557 Here are some examples to illustrate various combinations of options:
5562 Remove all zero bytes:
5569 Put all words on lines by themselves. This converts all
5570 non-alphanumeric characters to newlines, then squeezes each string
5571 of repeated newlines into a single newline:
5574 tr -cs '[:alnum:]' '[\n*]'
5578 Convert each sequence of repeated newlines to a single newline:
5585 Find doubled occurrences of words in a document.
5586 @c Separate the following two "the"s, so typo checkers don't complain.
5587 For example, people often write ``the @w{}the'' with the repeated words
5588 separated by a newline. The Bourne shell script below works first
5589 by converting each sequence of punctuation and blank characters to a
5590 single newline. That puts each ``word'' on a line by itself.
5591 Next it maps all uppercase characters to lower case, and finally it
5592 runs @command{uniq} with the @option{-d} option to print out only the words
5598 | tr -s '[:punct:][:blank:]' '[\n*]' \
5599 | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' \
5604 Deleting a small set of characters is usually straightforward. For example,
5605 to remove all @samp{a}s, @samp{x}s, and @samp{M}s you would do this:
5611 However, when @samp{-} is one of those characters, it can be tricky because
5612 @samp{-} has special meanings. Performing the same task as above but also
5613 removing all @samp{-} characters, we might try @code{tr -d -axM}, but
5614 that would fail because @command{tr} would try to interpret @option{-a} as
5615 a command-line option. Alternatively, we could try putting the hyphen
5616 inside the string, @code{tr -d a-xM}, but that wouldn't work either because
5617 it would make @command{tr} interpret @code{a-x} as the range of characters
5618 @samp{a}@dots{}@samp{x} rather than the three.
5619 One way to solve the problem is to put the hyphen at the end of the list
5626 Or you can use @samp{--} to terminate option processing:
5632 More generally, use the character class notation @code{[=c=]}
5633 with @samp{-} (or any other character) in place of the @samp{c}:
5639 Note how single quotes are used in the above example to protect the
5640 square brackets from interpretation by a shell.
5645 @node expand invocation
5646 @section @command{expand}: Convert tabs to spaces
5649 @cindex tabs to spaces, converting
5650 @cindex converting tabs to spaces
5652 @command{expand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or standard
5653 input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to standard
5654 output, with tab characters converted to the appropriate number of
5658 expand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5661 By default, @command{expand} converts all tabs to spaces. It preserves
5662 backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column count for
5663 tab calculations. The default action is equivalent to @option{-t 8} (set
5664 tabs every 8 columns).
5666 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5670 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5671 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5674 @cindex tab stops, setting
5675 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} spaces apart
5676 (default is 8). Otherwise, set the tabs at columns @var{tab1},
5677 @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and replace any tabs beyond the
5678 last tab stop given with single spaces. Tab stops can be separated by
5679 blanks as well as by commas.
5681 For compatibility, GNU @command{expand} also accepts the obsolete
5682 option syntax, @option{-@var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}}. New scripts
5683 should use @option{-t @var{t1}[,@var{t2}]@dots{}} instead.
5689 @cindex initial tabs, converting
5690 Only convert initial tabs (those that precede all non-space or non-tab
5691 characters) on each line to spaces.
5698 @node unexpand invocation
5699 @section @command{unexpand}: Convert spaces to tabs
5703 @command{unexpand} writes the contents of each given @var{file}, or
5704 standard input if none are given or for a @var{file} of @samp{-}, to
5705 standard output, converting blanks at the beginning of each line into
5706 as many tab characters as needed. In the default @acronym{POSIX}
5707 locale, a @dfn{blank} is a space or a tab; other locales may specify
5708 additional blank characters. Synopsis:
5711 unexpand [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
5714 By default, @command{unexpand} converts only initial blanks (those
5715 that precede all non-blank characters) on each line. It
5716 preserves backspace characters in the output; they decrement the column
5717 count for tab calculations. By default, tabs are set at every 8th
5720 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
5724 @item -t @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5725 @itemx --tabs=@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}
5728 If only one tab stop is given, set the tabs @var{tab1} columns apart
5729 instead of the default 8. Otherwise, set the tabs at columns
5730 @var{tab1}, @var{tab2}, @dots{} (numbered from 0), and leave blanks
5731 beyond the tab stops given unchanged. Tab stops can be separated by
5732 blanks as well as by commas. This option implies the @option{-a} option.
5734 For compatibility, GNU @command{unexpand} supports the obsolete option syntax,
5735 @option{-@var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}}, where tab stops must be
5736 separated by commas. (Unlike @option{-t}, this obsolete option does
5737 not imply @option{-a}.) New scripts should use @option{--first-only -t
5738 @var{tab1}[,@var{tab2}]@dots{}} instead.
5744 Also convert all sequences of two or more blanks just before a tab stop,
5745 even if they occur after non-blank characters in a line.
5752 @node Directory listing
5753 @chapter Directory listing
5755 This chapter describes the @command{ls} command and its variants @command{dir}
5756 and @command{vdir}, which list information about files.
5759 * ls invocation:: List directory contents.
5760 * dir invocation:: Briefly ls.
5761 * vdir invocation:: Verbosely ls.
5762 * dircolors invocation:: Color setup for ls, etc.
5767 @section @command{ls}: List directory contents
5770 @cindex directory listing
5772 The @command{ls} program lists information about files (of any type,
5773 including directories). Options and file arguments can be intermixed
5774 arbitrarily, as usual.
5776 For non-option command-line arguments that are directories, by default
5777 @command{ls} lists the contents of directories, not recursively, and
5778 omitting files with names beginning with @samp{.}. For other non-option
5779 arguments, by default @command{ls} lists just the file name. If no
5780 non-option argument is specified, @command{ls} operates on the current
5781 directory, acting as if it had been invoked with a single argument of @samp{.}.
5784 By default, the output is sorted alphabetically, according to the locale
5785 settings in effect.@footnote{If you use a non-@acronym{POSIX}
5786 locale (e.g., by setting @env{LC_ALL} to @samp{en_US}), then @command{ls} may
5787 produce output that is sorted differently than you're accustomed to.
5788 In that case, set the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable to @samp{C}.}
5789 If standard output is
5790 a terminal, the output is in columns (sorted vertically) and control
5791 characters are output as question marks; otherwise, the output is listed
5792 one per line and control characters are output as-is.
5794 Because @command{ls} is such a fundamental program, it has accumulated many
5795 options over the years. They are described in the subsections below;
5796 within each section, options are listed alphabetically (ignoring case).
5797 The division of options into the subsections is not absolute, since some
5798 options affect more than one aspect of @command{ls}'s operation.
5800 @cindex exit status of @command{ls}
5805 1 minor problems (e.g., a subdirectory was not found)
5806 2 serious trouble (e.g., memory exhausted)
5809 Also see @ref{Common options}.
5812 * Which files are listed::
5813 * What information is listed::
5814 * Sorting the output::
5815 * More details about version sort::
5816 * General output formatting::
5817 * Formatting file timestamps::
5818 * Formatting the file names::
5822 @node Which files are listed
5823 @subsection Which files are listed
5825 These options determine which files @command{ls} lists information for.
5826 By default, @command{ls} lists files and the contents of any
5827 directories on the command line, except that in directories it ignores
5828 files whose names start with @samp{.}.
5836 In directories, do not ignore file names that start with @samp{.}.
5841 @opindex --almost-all
5842 In directories, do not ignore all file names that start with @samp{.};
5843 ignore only @file{.} and @file{..}. The @option{--all} (@option{-a})
5844 option overrides this option.
5847 @itemx --ignore-backups
5849 @opindex --ignore-backups
5850 @cindex backup files, ignoring
5851 In directories, ignore files that end with @samp{~}. This option is
5852 equivalent to @samp{--ignore='*~' --ignore='.*~'}.
5857 @opindex --directory
5858 List just the names of directories, as with other types of files, rather
5859 than listing their contents.
5860 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -F.
5861 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
5862 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
5863 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
5864 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
5867 @itemx --dereference-command-line
5869 @opindex --dereference-command-line
5870 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5871 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, show information
5872 for the file the link references rather than for the link itself.
5874 @itemx --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
5875 @opindex --dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir
5876 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5877 Do not dereference symbolic links, with one exception:
5878 if a command line argument specifies a symbolic link that refers to
5879 a directory, show information for that directory rather than for the
5881 This is the default behavior when no other dereferencing-related
5882 option has been specified (@option{--classify} (@option{-F}),
5883 @option{--directory} (@option{-d}),
5885 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
5886 @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H})).
5888 @item --group-directories-first
5889 @opindex --group-directories-first
5890 Group all the directories before the files and then sort the
5891 directories and the files separately using the selected sort key
5892 (see --sort option).
5893 That is, this option specifies a primary sort key,
5894 and the --sort option specifies a secondary key.
5896 @item --hide=PATTERN
5897 @opindex --hide=@var{pattern}
5898 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
5899 @var{pattern}, unless the @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or
5900 @option{--almost-all} (@option{-A}) is also given. This
5901 option acts like @option{--ignore=@var{pattern}} except that it has no
5902 effect if @option{--all} (@option{-a}) or @option{--almost-all}
5903 (@option{-A}) is also given.
5905 This option can be useful in shell aliases. For example, if
5906 @command{lx} is an alias for @samp{ls --hide='*~'} and @command{ly} is
5907 an alias for @samp{ls --ignore='*~'}, then the command @samp{lx -A}
5908 lists the file @file{README~} even though @samp{ly -A} would not.
5910 @item -I @var{pattern}
5911 @itemx --ignore=@var{pattern}
5913 @opindex --ignore=@var{pattern}
5914 In directories, ignore files whose names match the shell pattern
5915 (not regular expression) @var{pattern}. As
5916 in the shell, an initial @samp{.} in a file name does not match a
5917 wildcard at the start of @var{pattern}. Sometimes it is useful
5918 to give this option several times. For example,
5921 $ ls --ignore='.??*' --ignore='.[^.]' --ignore='#*'
5924 The first option ignores names of length 3 or more that start with @samp{.},
5925 the second ignores all two-character names that start with @samp{.}
5926 except @samp{..}, and the third ignores names that start with @samp{#}.
5929 @itemx --dereference
5931 @opindex --dereference
5932 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing
5933 When showing file information for a symbolic link, show information
5934 for the file the link references rather than the link itself.
5935 However, even with this option, @command{ls} still prints the name
5936 of the link itself, not the name of the file that the link points to.
5941 @opindex --recursive
5942 @cindex recursive directory listing
5943 @cindex directory listing, recursive
5944 List the contents of all directories recursively.
5949 @node What information is listed
5950 @subsection What information is listed
5952 These options affect the information that @command{ls} displays. By
5953 default, only file names are shown.
5959 @cindex hurd, author, printing
5960 List each file's author when producing long format directory listings.
5961 In GNU/Hurd, file authors can differ from their owners, but in other
5962 operating systems the two are the same.
5968 @cindex dired Emacs mode support
5969 With the long listing (@option{-l}) format, print an additional line after
5973 //DIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @var{beg2} @var{end2} @dots{}
5977 The @var{begN} and @var{endN} are unsigned integers that record the
5978 byte position of the beginning and end of each file name in the output.
5979 This makes it easy for Emacs to find the names, even when they contain
5980 unusual characters such as space or newline, without fancy searching.
5982 If directories are being listed recursively (@option{-R}), output a similar
5983 line with offsets for each subdirectory name:
5986 //SUBDIRED// @var{beg1} @var{end1} @dots{}
5989 Finally, output a line of the form:
5992 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=@var{word}
5996 where @var{word} is the quoting style (@pxref{Formatting the file names}).
5998 Here is an actual example:
6001 $ mkdir -p a/sub/deeper a/sub2
6003 $ touch a/sub/deeper/file
6004 $ ls -gloRF --dired a
6007 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f1
6008 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 f2
6009 drwxr-xr-x 3 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub/
6010 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 sub2/
6014 drwxr-xr-x 2 4096 Jun 10 12:27 deeper/
6018 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:27 file
6022 //DIRED// 48 50 84 86 120 123 158 162 217 223 282 286
6023 //SUBDIRED// 2 3 167 172 228 240 290 296
6024 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=literal
6027 Note that the pairs of offsets on the @samp{//DIRED//} line above delimit
6028 these names: @file{f1}, @file{f2}, @file{sub}, @file{sub2}, @file{deeper},
6030 The offsets on the @samp{//SUBDIRED//} line delimit the following
6031 directory names: @file{a}, @file{a/sub}, @file{a/sub/deeper}, @file{a/sub2}.
6033 Here is an example of how to extract the fifth entry name, @samp{deeper},
6034 corresponding to the pair of offsets, 222 and 228:
6037 $ ls -gloRF --dired a > out
6038 $ dd bs=1 skip=222 count=6 < out 2>/dev/null; echo
6042 Note that although the listing above includes a trailing slash
6043 for the @samp{deeper} entry, the offsets select the name without
6044 the trailing slash. However, if you invoke @command{ls} with @option{--dired}
6045 along with an option like @option{--escape} (aka @option{-b}) and operate
6046 on a file whose name contains special characters, notice that the backslash
6051 $ ls -blog --dired 'a b'
6052 -rw-r--r-- 1 0 Jun 10 12:28 a\ b
6054 //DIRED-OPTIONS// --quoting-style=escape
6057 If you use a quoting style that adds quote marks
6058 (e.g., @option{--quoting-style=c}), then the offsets include the quote marks.
6059 So beware that the user may select the quoting style via the environment
6060 variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. Hence, applications using @option{--dired}
6061 should either specify an explicit @option{--quoting-style=literal} option
6062 (aka @option{-N} or @option{--literal}) on the command line, or else be
6063 prepared to parse the escaped names.
6066 @opindex --full-time
6067 Produce long format directory listings, and list times in full. It is
6068 equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with
6069 @option{--time-style=full-iso} (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}).
6073 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display owner information.
6079 Inhibit display of group information in a long format directory listing.
6080 (This is the default in some non-@sc{gnu} versions of @command{ls}, so we
6081 provide this option for compatibility.)
6089 @cindex inode number, printing
6090 Print the inode number (also called the file serial number and index
6091 number) of each file to the left of the file name. (This number
6092 uniquely identifies each file within a particular file system.)
6095 @itemx --format=long
6096 @itemx --format=verbose
6099 @opindex long ls @r{format}
6100 @opindex verbose ls @r{format}
6101 In addition to the name of each file, print the file type, file mode bits,
6102 number of hard links, owner name, group name, size, and
6103 timestamp (@pxref{Formatting file timestamps}), normally
6104 the modification time. Print question marks for information that
6105 cannot be determined.
6107 Normally the size is printed as a byte count without punctuation, but
6108 this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}). For example, @option{-h}
6109 prints an abbreviated, human-readable count, and
6110 @samp{--block-size="'1"} prints a byte count with the thousands
6111 separator of the current locale.
6113 For each directory that is listed, preface the files with a line
6114 @samp{total @var{blocks}}, where @var{blocks} is the total disk allocation
6115 for all files in that directory. The block size currently defaults to 1024
6116 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6117 The @var{blocks} computed counts each hard link separately;
6118 this is arguably a deficiency.
6120 The file type is one of the following characters:
6122 @c The commented-out entries are ones we're not sure about.
6130 character special file
6132 high performance (``contiguous data'') file
6136 door (Solaris 2.5 and up)
6138 @c semaphore, if this is a distinct file type
6142 @c multiplexed file (7th edition Unix; obsolete)
6144 off-line (``migrated'') file (Cray DMF)
6146 network special file (HP-UX)
6150 port (Solaris 10 and up)
6152 @c message queue, if this is a distinct file type
6156 @c shared memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6158 @c typed memory object, if this is a distinct file type
6160 @c whiteout (4.4BSD; not implemented)
6162 some other file type
6165 @cindex permissions, output by @command{ls}
6166 The file mode bits listed are similar to symbolic mode specifications
6167 (@pxref{Symbolic Modes}). But @command{ls} combines multiple bits into the
6168 third character of each set of permissions as follows:
6172 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit and the corresponding executable bit
6176 If the set-user-ID or set-group-ID bit is set but the corresponding
6177 executable bit is not set.
6180 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit, and the
6181 other-executable bit, are both set. The restricted deletion flag is
6182 another name for the sticky bit. @xref{Mode Structure}.
6185 If the restricted deletion flag or sticky bit is set but the
6186 other-executable bit is not set.
6189 If the executable bit is set and none of the above apply.
6195 Following the file mode bits is a single character that specifies
6196 whether an alternate access method such as an access control list
6197 applies to the file. When the character following the file mode bits is a
6198 space, there is no alternate access method. When it is a printing
6199 character, then there is such a method.
6201 For a file with an extended access control list, a @samp{+} character is
6202 listed. Basic access control lists are equivalent to the permissions
6203 listed, and are not considered an alternate access method.
6206 @itemx --numeric-uid-gid
6208 @opindex --numeric-uid-gid
6209 @cindex numeric uid and gid
6210 @cindex numeric user and group IDs
6211 Produce long format directory listings, but
6212 display numeric user and group IDs instead of the owner and group names.
6216 Produce long format directory listings, but don't display group information.
6217 It is equivalent to using @option{--format=long} with @option{--no-group} .
6223 @cindex disk allocation
6224 @cindex size of files, reporting
6225 Print the disk allocation of each file to the left of the file name.
6226 This is the amount of disk space used by the file, which is usually a
6227 bit more than the file's size, but it can be less if the file has holes.
6229 Normally the disk allocation is printed in units of
6230 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
6232 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
6233 For files that are NFS-mounted from an HP-UX system to a BSD system,
6234 this option reports sizes that are half the correct values. On HP-UX
6235 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for files
6236 that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw in HP-UX;
6237 it also affects the HP-UX @command{ls} program.
6244 @node Sorting the output
6245 @subsection Sorting the output
6247 @cindex sorting @command{ls} output
6248 These options change the order in which @command{ls} sorts the information
6249 it outputs. By default, sorting is done by character code
6250 (e.g., @acronym{ASCII} order).
6256 @itemx --time=status
6259 @opindex ctime@r{, printing or sorting by}
6260 @opindex status time@r{, printing or sorting by}
6261 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6262 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{-l}, @option{-o}) is being used,
6263 print the status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) instead of
6264 the modification time.
6265 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6266 or when not using a long listing format,
6267 sort according to the status change time.
6271 @cindex unsorted directory listing
6272 @cindex directory order, listing by
6273 Primarily, like @option{-U}---do not sort; list the files in whatever
6274 order they are stored in the directory. But also enable @option{-a} (list
6275 all files) and disable @option{-l}, @option{--color}, and @option{-s} (if they
6276 were specified before the @option{-f}).
6282 @cindex reverse sorting
6283 Reverse whatever the sorting method is---e.g., list files in reverse
6284 alphabetical order, youngest first, smallest first, or whatever.
6290 @opindex size of files@r{, sorting files by}
6291 Sort by file size, largest first.
6297 @opindex modification time@r{, sorting files by}
6298 Sort by modification time (the @samp{mtime} in the inode), newest first.
6302 @itemx --time=access
6306 @opindex use time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6307 @opindex atime@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6308 @opindex access time@r{, printing or sorting files by}
6309 If the long listing format (e.g., @option{--format=long}) is being used,
6310 print the last access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode).
6311 When explicitly sorting by time (@option{--sort=time} or @option{-t})
6312 or when not using a long listing format, sort according to the access time.
6318 @opindex none@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6319 Do not sort; list the files in whatever order they are
6320 stored in the directory. (Do not do any of the other unrelated things
6321 that @option{-f} does.) This is especially useful when listing very large
6322 directories, since not doing any sorting can be noticeably faster.
6325 @itemx --sort=version
6328 @opindex version@r{, sorting option for @command{ls}}
6329 Sort by version name and number, lowest first. It behaves like a default
6330 sort, except that each sequence of decimal digits is treated numerically
6331 as an index/version number. (@xref{More details about version sort}.)
6334 @itemx --sort=extension
6337 @opindex extension@r{, sorting files by}
6338 Sort directory contents alphabetically by file extension (characters
6339 after the last @samp{.}); files with no extension are sorted first.
6344 @node More details about version sort
6345 @subsection More details about version sort
6347 The version sort takes into account the fact that file names frequently include
6348 indices or version numbers. Standard sorting functions usually do not produce
6349 the ordering that people expect because comparisons are made on a
6350 character-by-character basis. The version
6351 sort addresses this problem, and is especially useful when browsing
6352 directories that contain many files with indices/version numbers in their
6357 foo.zml-1.gz foo.zml-1.gz
6358 foo.zml-100.gz foo.zml-2.gz
6359 foo.zml-12.gz foo.zml-6.gz
6360 foo.zml-13.gz foo.zml-12.gz
6361 foo.zml-2.gz foo.zml-13.gz
6362 foo.zml-25.gz foo.zml-25.gz
6363 foo.zml-6.gz foo.zml-100.gz
6366 Note also that numeric parts with leading zeros are considered as
6371 abc-1.007.tgz abc-1.007.tgz
6372 abc-1.012b.tgz abc-1.01a.tgz
6373 abc-1.01a.tgz abc-1.012b.tgz
6376 This functionality is implemented using the @code{strverscmp} function.
6377 @xref{String/Array Comparison, , , libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
6378 One result of that implementation decision is that @code{ls -v} does not
6379 use the locale category, @env{LC_COLLATE}. As a result, non-numeric prefixes
6380 are sorted as if @env{LC_COLLATE} were set to @code{C}.
6382 @node General output formatting
6383 @subsection General output formatting
6385 These options affect the appearance of the overall output.
6390 @itemx --format=single-column
6393 @opindex single-column @r{output of files}
6394 List one file per line. This is the default for @command{ls} when standard
6395 output is not a terminal.
6398 @itemx --format=vertical
6401 @opindex vertical @r{sorted files in columns}
6402 List files in columns, sorted vertically. This is the default for
6403 @command{ls} if standard output is a terminal. It is always the default
6404 for the @command{dir} program.
6405 @sc{gnu} @command{ls} uses variable width columns to display as many files as
6406 possible in the fewest lines.
6408 @item --color [=@var{when}]
6410 @cindex color, distinguishing file types with
6411 Specify whether to use color for distinguishing file types. @var{when}
6412 may be omitted, or one of:
6415 @vindex none @r{color option}
6416 - Do not use color at all. This is the default.
6418 @vindex auto @r{color option}
6419 @cindex terminal, using color iff
6420 - Only use color if standard output is a terminal.
6422 @vindex always @r{color option}
6425 Specifying @option{--color} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
6426 @option{--color=always}.
6427 Piping a colorized listing through a pager like @command{more} or
6428 @command{less} usually produces unreadable results. However, using
6429 @code{more -f} does seem to work.
6433 @itemx --indicator-style=classify
6436 @opindex --indicator-style
6437 @cindex file type and executables, marking
6438 @cindex executables and file type, marking
6439 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. Also,
6440 for regular files that are executable, append @samp{*}. The file type
6441 indicators are @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links,
6442 @samp{|} for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, @samp{>} for doors,
6443 and nothing for regular files.
6444 @c The following sentence is the same as the one for -d.
6445 Do not follow symbolic links listed on the
6446 command line unless the @option{--dereference-command-line} (@option{-H}),
6447 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), or
6448 @option{--dereference-command-line-symlink-to-dir} options are specified.
6451 @itemx --indicator-style=file-type
6452 @opindex --file-type
6453 @opindex --indicator-style
6454 @cindex file type, marking
6455 Append a character to each file name indicating the file type. This is
6456 like @option{-F}, except that executables are not marked.
6458 @item --indicator-style=@var{word}
6459 @opindex --indicator-style
6460 Append a character indicator with style @var{word} to entry names,
6465 Do not append any character indicator; this is the default.
6467 Append @samp{/} for directories. This is the same as the @option{-p}
6470 Append @samp{/} for directories, @samp{@@} for symbolic links, @samp{|}
6471 for FIFOs, @samp{=} for sockets, and nothing for regular files. This is
6472 the same as the @option{--file-type} option.
6474 Append @samp{*} for executable regular files, otherwise behave as for
6475 @samp{file-type}. This is the same as the @option{-F} or
6476 @option{--classify} option.
6481 Print file sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block
6482 size (@pxref{Block size}).
6483 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
6486 @itemx --format=commas
6489 @opindex commas@r{, outputting between files}
6490 List files horizontally, with as many as will fit on each line,
6491 separated by @samp{, } (a comma and a space).
6494 @itemx --indicator-style=slash
6496 @opindex --indicator-style
6497 @cindex file type, marking
6498 Append a @samp{/} to directory names.
6501 @itemx --format=across
6502 @itemx --format=horizontal
6505 @opindex across@r{, listing files}
6506 @opindex horizontal@r{, listing files}
6507 List the files in columns, sorted horizontally.
6510 @itemx --tabsize=@var{cols}
6513 Assume that each tab stop is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is 8.
6514 @command{ls} uses tabs where possible in the output, for efficiency. If
6515 @var{cols} is zero, do not use tabs at all.
6517 @c FIXME: remove in 2009, if Apple Terminal has been fixed for long enough.
6518 Some terminal emulators (at least Apple Terminal 1.5 (133) from Mac OS X 10.4.8)
6519 do not properly align columns to the right of a TAB following a
6520 non-@acronym{ASCII} byte. If you use such a terminal emulator, use the
6521 @option{-T0} option or put @code{TABSIZE=0} in your environment to tell
6522 @command{ls} to align using spaces, not tabs.
6525 @itemx --width=@var{cols}
6529 Assume the screen is @var{cols} columns wide. The default is taken
6530 from the terminal settings if possible; otherwise the environment
6531 variable @env{COLUMNS} is used if it is set; otherwise the default
6537 @node Formatting file timestamps
6538 @subsection Formatting file timestamps
6540 By default, file timestamps are listed in abbreviated form. Most
6541 locales use a timestamp like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. However, the
6542 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses a date like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002}
6543 for non-recent timestamps, and a date-without-year and time like
6544 @samp{Mar 30 23:45} for recent timestamps.
6546 A timestamp is considered to be @dfn{recent} if it is less than six
6547 months old, and is not dated in the future. If a timestamp dated
6548 today is not listed in recent form, the timestamp is in the future,
6549 which means you probably have clock skew problems which may break
6550 programs like @command{make} that rely on file timestamps.
6553 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
6554 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
6555 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
6556 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
6558 The following option changes how file timestamps are printed.
6561 @item --time-style=@var{style}
6562 @opindex --time-style
6564 List timestamps in style @var{style}. The @var{style} should
6565 be one of the following:
6570 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
6571 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
6572 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
6573 @command{ls} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
6574 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
6575 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
6577 If @var{format} contains two format strings separated by a newline,
6578 the former is used for non-recent files and the latter for recent
6579 files; if you want output columns to line up, you may need to insert
6580 spaces in one of the two formats.
6583 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
6584 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
6585 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
6586 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
6588 This is useful because the time output includes all the information that
6589 is available from the operating system. For example, this can help
6590 explain @command{make}'s behavior, since @acronym{GNU} @command{make}
6591 uses the full timestamp to determine whether a file is out of date.
6594 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
6595 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
6596 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
6597 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
6600 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for non-recent timestamps (e.g.,
6601 @samp{2002-03-30@ }), and @acronym{ISO} 8601 month, day, hour, and
6602 minute for recent timestamps (e.g., @samp{03-30 23:45}). These
6603 timestamps are uglier than @samp{long-iso} timestamps, but they carry
6604 nearly the same information in a smaller space and their brevity helps
6605 @command{ls} output fit within traditional 80-column output lines.
6606 The following two @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6611 ls -l --time-style="+%Y-%m-%d $newline%m-%d %H:%M"
6612 ls -l --time-style="iso"
6617 List timestamps in a locale-dependent form. For example, a Finnish
6618 locale might list non-recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30@ @ 2002}
6619 and recent timestamps like @samp{maalis 30 23:45}. Locale-dependent
6620 timestamps typically consume more space than @samp{iso} timestamps and
6621 are harder for programs to parse because locale conventions vary so
6622 widely, but they are easier for many people to read.
6624 The @env{LC_TIME} locale category specifies the timestamp format. The
6625 default @acronym{POSIX} locale uses timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@
6626 @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45}; in this locale, the following two
6627 @command{ls} invocations are equivalent:
6632 ls -l --time-style="+%b %e %Y$newline%b %e %H:%M"
6633 ls -l --time-style="locale"
6636 Other locales behave differently. For example, in a German locale,
6637 @option{--time-style="locale"} might be equivalent to
6638 @option{--time-style="+%e. %b %Y $newline%e. %b %H:%M"}
6639 and might generate timestamps like @samp{30. M@"ar 2002@ } and
6640 @samp{30. M@"ar 23:45}.
6642 @item posix-@var{style}
6644 List @acronym{POSIX}-locale timestamps if the @env{LC_TIME} locale
6645 category is @acronym{POSIX}, @var{style} timestamps otherwise. For
6646 example, the @samp{posix-long-iso} style lists
6647 timestamps like @samp{Mar 30@ @ 2002} and @samp{Mar 30 23:45} when in
6648 the @acronym{POSIX} locale, and like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45} otherwise.
6653 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
6654 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
6655 the default style is @samp{locale}. @acronym{GNU} Emacs 21.3 and
6656 later use the @option{--dired} option and therefore can parse any date
6657 format, but if you are using Emacs 21.1 or 21.2 and specify a
6658 non-@acronym{POSIX} locale you may need to set
6659 @samp{TIME_STYLE="posix-long-iso"}.
6661 To avoid certain denial-of-service attacks, timestamps that would be
6662 longer than 1000 bytes may be treated as errors.
6665 @node Formatting the file names
6666 @subsection Formatting the file names
6668 These options change how file names themselves are printed.
6674 @itemx --quoting-style=escape
6677 @opindex --quoting-style
6678 @cindex backslash sequences for file names
6679 Quote nongraphic characters in file names using alphabetic and octal
6680 backslash sequences like those used in C.
6684 @itemx --quoting-style=literal
6687 @opindex --quoting-style
6688 Do not quote file names. However, with @command{ls} nongraphic
6689 characters are still printed as question marks if the output is a
6690 terminal and you do not specify the @option{--show-control-chars}
6694 @itemx --hide-control-chars
6696 @opindex --hide-control-chars
6697 Print question marks instead of nongraphic characters in file names.
6698 This is the default if the output is a terminal and the program is
6703 @itemx --quoting-style=c
6705 @opindex --quote-name
6706 @opindex --quoting-style
6707 Enclose file names in double quotes and quote nongraphic characters as
6710 @item --quoting-style=@var{word}
6711 @opindex --quoting-style
6712 @cindex quoting style
6713 Use style @var{word} to quote file names and other strings that may
6714 contain arbitrary characters. The @var{word} should
6715 be one of the following:
6719 Output strings as-is; this is the same as the @option{-N} or
6720 @option{--literal} option.
6722 Quote strings for the shell if they contain shell metacharacters or would
6723 cause ambiguous output.
6724 The quoting is suitable for @acronym{POSIX}-compatible shells like
6725 @command{bash}, but it does not always work for incompatible shells
6728 Quote strings for the shell, even if they would normally not require quoting.
6730 Quote strings as for C character string literals, including the
6731 surrounding double-quote characters; this is the same as the
6732 @option{-Q} or @option{--quote-name} option.
6734 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except omit the
6735 surrounding double-quote
6736 characters; this is the same as the @option{-b} or @option{--escape} option.
6738 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6739 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the
6742 @c Use @t instead of @samp to avoid duplicate quoting in some output styles.
6743 Quote strings as for C character string literals, except use
6744 surrounding quotation marks appropriate for the locale, and quote
6745 @t{`like this'} instead of @t{"like
6746 this"} in the default C locale. This looks nicer on many displays.
6749 You can specify the default value of the @option{--quoting-style} option
6750 with the environment variable @env{QUOTING_STYLE}. If that environment
6751 variable is not set, the default value is @samp{literal}, but this
6752 default may change to @samp{shell} in a future version of this package.
6754 @item --show-control-chars
6755 @opindex --show-control-chars
6756 Print nongraphic characters as-is in file names.
6757 This is the default unless the output is a terminal and the program is
6763 @node dir invocation
6764 @section @command{dir}: Briefly list directory contents
6767 @cindex directory listing, brief
6769 @command{dir} is equivalent to @code{ls -C
6770 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in columns, sorted vertically,
6771 and special characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6773 @xref{ls invocation, @command{ls}}.
6776 @node vdir invocation
6777 @section @command{vdir}: Verbosely list directory contents
6780 @cindex directory listing, verbose
6782 @command{vdir} is equivalent to @code{ls -l
6783 -b}; that is, by default files are listed in long format and special
6784 characters are represented by backslash escape sequences.
6786 @node dircolors invocation
6787 @section @command{dircolors}: Color setup for @command{ls}
6791 @cindex setup for color
6793 @command{dircolors} outputs a sequence of shell commands to set up the
6794 terminal for color output from @command{ls} (and @command{dir}, etc.).
6798 eval "`dircolors [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]`"
6801 If @var{file} is specified, @command{dircolors} reads it to determine which
6802 colors to use for which file types and extensions. Otherwise, a
6803 precompiled database is used. For details on the format of these files,
6804 run @samp{dircolors --print-database}.
6807 @vindex SHELL @r{environment variable, and color}
6808 The output is a shell command to set the @env{LS_COLORS} environment
6809 variable. You can specify the shell syntax to use on the command line,
6810 or @command{dircolors} will guess it from the value of the @env{SHELL}
6811 environment variable.
6813 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6818 @itemx --bourne-shell
6821 @opindex --bourne-shell
6822 @cindex Bourne shell syntax for color setup
6823 @cindex @command{sh} syntax for color setup
6824 Output Bourne shell commands. This is the default if the @env{SHELL}
6825 environment variable is set and does not end with @samp{csh} or
6834 @cindex C shell syntax for color setup
6835 @cindex @command{csh} syntax for color setup
6836 Output C shell commands. This is the default if @code{SHELL} ends with
6837 @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}.
6840 @itemx --print-database
6842 @opindex --print-database
6843 @cindex color database, printing
6844 @cindex database for color setup, printing
6845 @cindex printing color database
6846 Print the (compiled-in) default color configuration database. This
6847 output is itself a valid configuration file, and is fairly descriptive
6848 of the possibilities.
6855 @node Basic operations
6856 @chapter Basic operations
6858 @cindex manipulating files
6860 This chapter describes the commands for basic file manipulation:
6861 copying, moving (renaming), and deleting (removing).
6864 * cp invocation:: Copy files.
6865 * dd invocation:: Convert and copy a file.
6866 * install invocation:: Copy files and set attributes.
6867 * mv invocation:: Move (rename) files.
6868 * rm invocation:: Remove files or directories.
6869 * shred invocation:: Remove files more securely.
6874 @section @command{cp}: Copy files and directories
6877 @cindex copying files and directories
6878 @cindex files, copying
6879 @cindex directories, copying
6881 @command{cp} copies files (or, optionally, directories). The copy is
6882 completely independent of the original. You can either copy one file to
6883 another, or copy arbitrarily many files to a destination directory.
6887 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
6888 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
6889 cp [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
6894 If two file names are given, @command{cp} copies the first file to the
6898 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
6899 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
6900 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
6901 @command{cp} copies each @var{source} file to the specified directory,
6902 using the @var{source}s' names.
6905 Generally, files are written just as they are read. For exceptions,
6906 see the @option{--sparse} option below.
6908 By default, @command{cp} does not copy directories. However, the
6909 @option{-R}, @option{-a}, and @option{-r} options cause @command{cp} to
6910 copy recursively by descending into source directories and copying files
6911 to corresponding destination directories.
6913 When copying from a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
6914 link only when not copying
6915 recursively. This default can be overridden with the
6916 @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d}, @option{--dereference}
6917 (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference} (@option{-P}), and
6918 @option{-H} options. If more than one of these options is specified,
6919 the last one silently overrides the others.
6921 When copying to a symbolic link, @command{cp} normally follows the
6922 link when creating or copying to a regular file, even if the link is
6923 dangling. However, @command{cp} does not follow these links when
6924 creating directories or special files. Also, when an option like
6925 @option{--backup} or @option{--link} acts to rename or remove the
6926 destination before copying, @command{cp} renames or removes the
6927 symbolic link rather than the file it points to.
6929 By default, @command{cp} copies the contents of special files only
6930 when not copying recursively. This default can be overridden with the
6931 @option{--copy-contents} option.
6933 @cindex self-backups
6934 @cindex backups, making only
6935 @command{cp} generally refuses to copy a file onto itself, with the
6936 following exception: if @option{--force --backup} is specified with
6937 @var{source} and @var{dest} identical, and referring to a regular file,
6938 @command{cp} will make a backup file, either regular or numbered, as
6939 specified in the usual ways (@pxref{Backup options}). This is useful when
6940 you simply want to make a backup of an existing file before changing it.
6942 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
6949 Preserve as much as possible of the structure and attributes of the
6950 original files in the copy (but do not attempt to preserve internal
6951 directory structure; i.e., @samp{ls -U} may list the entries in a copied
6952 directory in a different order).
6953 Equivalent to @option{-dpPR}.
6956 @itemx @w{@kbd{--backup}[=@var{method}]}
6959 @vindex VERSION_CONTROL
6960 @cindex backups, making
6961 @xref{Backup options}.
6962 Make a backup of each file that would otherwise be overwritten or removed.
6963 As a special case, @command{cp} makes a backup of @var{source} when the force
6964 and backup options are given and @var{source} and @var{dest} are the same
6965 name for an existing, regular file. One useful application of this
6966 combination of options is this tiny Bourne shell script:
6970 # Usage: backup FILE...
6971 # Create a @sc{gnu}-style backup of each listed FILE.
6973 cp --backup --force -- "$i" "$i"
6977 @item --copy-contents
6978 @cindex directories, copying recursively
6979 @cindex copying directories recursively
6980 @cindex recursively copying directories
6981 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
6982 If copying recursively, copy the contents of any special files (e.g.,
6983 FIFOs and device files) as if they were regular files. This means
6984 trying to read the data in each source file and writing it to the
6985 destination. It is usually a mistake to use this option, as it
6986 normally has undesirable effects on special files like FIFOs and the
6987 ones typically found in the @file{/dev} directory. In most cases,
6988 @code{cp -R --copy-contents} will hang indefinitely trying to read
6989 from FIFOs and special files like @file{/dev/console}, and it will
6990 fill up your destination disk if you use it to copy @file{/dev/zero}.
6991 This option has no effect unless copying recursively, and it does not
6992 affect the copying of symbolic links.
6996 @cindex symbolic links, copying
6997 @cindex hard links, preserving
6998 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
6999 they point to, and preserve hard links between source files in the copies.
7000 Equivalent to @option{--no-dereference --preserve=links}.
7006 When copying without this option and an existing destination file cannot
7007 be opened for writing, the copy fails. However, with @option{--force}),
7008 when a destination file cannot be opened, @command{cp} then removes it and
7009 tries to open it again. Contrast this behavior with that enabled by
7010 @option{--link} and @option{--symbolic-link}, whereby the destination file
7011 is never opened but rather is removed unconditionally. Also see the
7012 description of @option{--remove-destination}.
7014 This option is independent of the @option{--interactive} or
7015 @option{-i} option: neither cancels the effect of the other.
7019 If a command line argument specifies a symbolic link, then copy the
7020 file it points to rather than the symbolic link itself. However,
7021 copy (preserving its nature) any symbolic link that is encountered
7022 via recursive traversal.
7025 @itemx --interactive
7027 @opindex --interactive
7028 When copying a file other than a directory, prompt whether to
7029 overwrite an existing destination file.
7035 Make hard links instead of copies of non-directories.
7038 @itemx --dereference
7040 @opindex --dereference
7041 Follow symbolic links when copying from them.
7044 @itemx --no-dereference
7046 @opindex --no-dereference
7047 @cindex symbolic links, copying
7048 Copy symbolic links as symbolic links rather than copying the files that
7049 they point to. This option affects only symbolic links in the source;
7050 symbolic links in the destination are always followed if possible.
7053 @itemx @w{@kbd{--preserve}[=@var{attribute_list}]}
7056 @cindex file information, preserving
7057 Preserve the specified attributes of the original files.
7058 If specified, the @var{attribute_list} must be a comma-separated list
7059 of one or more of the following strings:
7063 Preserve the file mode bits and access control lists.
7065 Preserve the owner and group. On most modern systems,
7066 only users with appropriate privileges may change the owner of a file,
7068 may preserve the group ownership of a file only if they happen to be
7069 a member of the desired group.
7071 Preserve the times of last access and last modification, when possible.
7072 In general, it is not possible to preserve these attributes
7073 when the affected file is a symbolic link.
7074 However, FreeBSD now provides the @code{lutimes} function, which makes
7075 it possibile even for symbolic links. However, this implementation does
7076 not yet take advantage of that.
7077 @c FIXME: once we provide lutimes support, update the above.
7079 Preserve in the destination files
7080 any links between corresponding source files.
7081 @c Give examples illustrating how hard links are preserved.
7082 @c Also, show how soft links map to hard links with -L and -H.
7084 Preserve all file attributes.
7085 Equivalent to specifying all of the above.
7088 Using @option{--preserve} with no @var{attribute_list} is equivalent
7089 to @option{--preserve=mode,ownership,timestamps}.
7091 In the absence of this option, each destination file is created with the
7092 mode bits of the corresponding source file, minus the bits set in the
7093 umask and minus the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits.
7094 @xref{File permissions}.
7096 @itemx @w{@kbd{--no-preserve}=@var{attribute_list}}
7097 @cindex file information, preserving
7098 Do not preserve the specified attributes. The @var{attribute_list}
7099 has the same form as for @option{--preserve}.
7103 @cindex parent directories and @command{cp}
7104 Form the name of each destination file by appending to the target
7105 directory a slash and the specified name of the source file. The last
7106 argument given to @command{cp} must be the name of an existing directory.
7107 For example, the command:
7110 cp --parents a/b/c existing_dir
7114 copies the file @file{a/b/c} to @file{existing_dir/a/b/c}, creating
7115 any missing intermediate directories.
7117 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
7119 @cindex interactivity
7120 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
7121 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
7122 Using @option{--reply=yes} makes @command{cp} act as if @samp{yes} were
7123 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file. That effectively
7124 cancels any preceding @option{--interactive} or @option{-i} option.
7125 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{cp} act as if @samp{no} were
7126 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
7127 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{cp} prompt the user
7128 about each existing destination file.
7135 @opindex --recursive
7136 @cindex directories, copying recursively
7137 @cindex copying directories recursively
7138 @cindex recursively copying directories
7139 @cindex non-directories, copying as special files
7140 Copy directories recursively. By default, do not follow symbolic
7141 links in the source; see the @option{--archive} (@option{-a}), @option{-d},
7142 @option{--dereference} (@option{-L}), @option{--no-dereference}
7143 (@option{-P}), and @option{-H} options. Special files are copied by
7144 creating a destination file of the same type as the source; see the
7145 @option{--copy-contents} option. It is not portable to use
7146 @option{-r} to copy symbolic links or special files. On some
7147 non-@sc{gnu} systems, @option{-r} implies the equivalent of
7148 @option{-L} and @option{--copy-contents} for historical reasons.
7149 Also, it is not portable to use @option{-R} to copy symbolic links
7150 unless you also specify @option{-P}, as @acronym{POSIX} allows
7151 implementations that dereference symbolic links by default.
7153 @item --remove-destination
7154 @opindex --remove-destination
7155 Remove each existing destination file before attempting to open it
7156 (contrast with @option{-f} above).
7158 @item --sparse=@var{when}
7159 @opindex --sparse=@var{when}
7160 @cindex sparse files, copying
7161 @cindex holes, copying files with
7162 @findex read @r{system call, and holes}
7163 A @dfn{sparse file} contains @dfn{holes}---a sequence of zero bytes that
7164 does not occupy any physical disk blocks; the @samp{read} system call
7165 reads these as zeros. This can both save considerable disk space and
7166 increase speed, since many binary files contain lots of consecutive zero
7167 bytes. By default, @command{cp} detects holes in input source files via a crude
7168 heuristic and makes the corresponding output file sparse as well.
7169 Only regular files may be sparse.
7171 The @var{when} value can be one of the following:
7175 The default behavior: if the input file is sparse, attempt to make
7176 the output file sparse, too. However, if an output file exists but
7177 refers to a non-regular file, then do not attempt to make it sparse.
7180 For each sufficiently long sequence of zero bytes in the input file,
7181 attempt to create a corresponding hole in the output file, even if the
7182 input file does not appear to be sparse.
7183 This is useful when the input file resides on a file system
7184 that does not support sparse files
7185 (for example, @samp{efs} file systems in SGI IRIX 5.3 and earlier),
7186 but the output file is on a type of file system that does support them.
7187 Holes may be created only in regular files, so if the destination file
7188 is of some other type, @command{cp} does not even try to make it sparse.
7191 Never make the output file sparse.
7192 This is useful in creating a file for use with the @command{mkswap} command,
7193 since such a file must not have any holes.
7196 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7199 @itemx --symbolic-link
7201 @opindex --symbolic-link
7202 @cindex symbolic links, copying with
7203 Make symbolic links instead of copies of non-directories. All source
7204 file names must be absolute (starting with @samp{/}) unless the
7205 destination files are in the current directory. This option merely
7206 results in an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
7212 @optNoTargetDirectory
7218 @cindex newer files, copying only
7219 Do not copy a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7220 same or newer modification time. If time stamps are being preserved,
7221 the comparison is to the source time stamp truncated to the
7222 resolutions of the destination file system and of the system calls
7223 used to update time stamps; this avoids duplicate work if several
7224 @samp{cp -pu} commands are executed with the same source and
7231 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7234 @itemx --one-file-system
7236 @opindex --one-file-system
7237 @cindex file systems, omitting copying to different
7238 Skip subdirectories that are on different file systems from the one that
7239 the copy started on.
7240 However, mount point directories @emph{are} copied.
7248 @section @command{dd}: Convert and copy a file
7251 @cindex converting while copying a file
7253 @command{dd} copies a file (from standard input to standard output, by
7254 default) with a changeable I/O block size, while optionally performing
7255 conversions on it. Synopses:
7258 dd [@var{operand}]@dots{}
7262 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
7263 @xref{Common options}. @command{dd} accepts the following operands.
7269 Read from @var{file} instead of standard input.
7273 Write to @var{file} instead of standard output. Unless
7274 @samp{conv=notrunc} is given, @command{dd} truncates @var{file} to zero
7275 bytes (or the size specified with @samp{seek=}).
7277 @item ibs=@var{bytes}
7279 @cindex block size of input
7280 @cindex input block size
7281 Set the input block size to @var{bytes}.
7282 This makes @command{dd} read @var{bytes} per block.
7284 @item obs=@var{bytes}
7286 @cindex block size of output
7287 @cindex output block size
7288 Set the output block size to @var{bytes}.
7289 This makes @command{dd} write @var{bytes} per block.
7291 @item bs=@var{bytes}
7294 Set both input and output block sizes to @var{bytes}.
7295 This makes @command{dd} read and write @var{bytes} per block,
7296 overriding any @samp{ibs} and @samp{obs} settings.
7298 @item cbs=@var{bytes}
7300 @cindex block size of conversion
7301 @cindex conversion block size
7302 @cindex fixed-length records, converting to variable-length
7303 @cindex variable-length records, converting to fixed-length
7304 Set the conversion block size to @var{bytes}.
7305 When converting variable-length records to fixed-length ones
7306 (@option{conv=block}) or the reverse (@option{conv=unblock}),
7307 use @var{bytes} as the fixed record length.
7309 @item skip=@var{blocks}
7311 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks in the input file before copying.
7313 @item seek=@var{blocks}
7315 Skip @var{blocks} @samp{obs}-byte blocks in the output file before copying.
7317 @item count=@var{blocks}
7319 Copy @var{blocks} @samp{ibs}-byte blocks from the input file, instead
7320 of everything until the end of the file.
7322 @item conv=@var{conversion}[,@var{conversion}]@dots{}
7324 Convert the file as specified by the @var{conversion} argument(s).
7325 (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7332 @opindex ascii@r{, converting to}
7333 Convert @acronym{EBCDIC} to @acronym{ASCII},
7334 using the conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7335 This provides a 1:1 translation for all 256 bytes.
7338 @opindex ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7339 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to @acronym{EBCDIC}.
7340 This is the inverse of the @samp{ascii} conversion.
7343 @opindex alternate ebcdic@r{, converting to}
7344 Convert @acronym{ASCII} to alternate @acronym{EBCDIC},
7345 using the alternate conversion table specified by @acronym{POSIX}.
7346 This is not a 1:1 translation, but reflects common historical practice
7347 for @samp{~}, @samp{[}, and @samp{]}.
7349 The @samp{ascii}, @samp{ebcdic}, and @samp{ibm} conversions are
7353 @opindex block @r{(space-padding)}
7354 For each line in the input, output @samp{cbs} bytes, replacing the
7355 input newline with a space and padding with spaces as necessary.
7359 Replace trailing spaces in each @samp{cbs}-sized input block with a
7362 The @samp{block} and @samp{unblock} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7365 @opindex lcase@r{, converting to}
7366 Change uppercase letters to lowercase.
7369 @opindex ucase@r{, converting to}
7370 Change lowercase letters to uppercase.
7372 The @samp{lcase} and @samp{ucase} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7375 @opindex swab @r{(byte-swapping)}
7376 @cindex byte-swapping
7377 Swap every pair of input bytes. @sc{gnu} @command{dd}, unlike others, works
7378 when an odd number of bytes are read---the last byte is simply copied
7379 (since there is nothing to swap it with).
7383 @cindex read errors, ignoring
7384 Continue after read errors.
7388 @cindex creating output file, avoiding
7389 Do not create the output file; the output file must already exist.
7393 @cindex creating output file, requiring
7394 Fail if the output file already exists; @command{dd} must create the
7397 The @samp{excl} and @samp{nocreat} conversions are mutually exclusive.
7401 @cindex truncating output file, avoiding
7402 Do not truncate the output file.
7405 @opindex sync @r{(padding with nulls)}
7406 Pad every input block to size of @samp{ibs} with trailing zero bytes.
7407 When used with @samp{block} or @samp{unblock}, pad with spaces instead of
7412 @cindex synchronized data writes, before finishing
7413 Synchronize output data just before finishing. This forces a physical
7414 write of output data.
7418 @cindex synchronized data and metadata writes, before finishing
7419 Synchronize output data and metadata just before finishing. This
7420 forces a physical write of output data and metadata.
7424 @item iflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7426 Access the input file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7427 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7429 @item oflag=@var{flag}[,@var{flag}]@dots{}
7431 Access the output file using the flags specified by the @var{flag}
7432 argument(s). (No spaces around any comma(s).)
7434 Here are the flags. Not every flag is supported on every operating
7441 @cindex appending to the output file
7442 Write in append mode, so that even if some other process is writing to
7443 this file, every @command{dd} write will append to the current
7444 contents of the file. This flag makes sense only for output.
7445 If you combine this flag with the @samp{of=@var{file}} operand,
7446 you should also specify @samp{conv=notrunc} unless you want the
7447 output file to be truncated before being appended to.
7452 Use direct I/O for data, avoiding the buffer cache.
7456 @cindex directory I/O
7458 Fail unless the file is a directory. Most operating systems do not
7459 allow I/O to a directory, so this flag has limited utility.
7463 @cindex synchronized data reads
7464 Use synchronized I/O for data. For the output file, this forces a
7465 physical write of output data on each write. For the input file,
7466 this flag can matter when reading from a remote file that has been
7467 written to synchronously by some other process. Metadata (e.g.,
7468 last-access and last-modified time) is not necessarily synchronized.
7472 @cindex synchronized data and metadata I/O
7473 Use synchronized I/O for both data and metadata.
7477 @cindex nonblocking I/O
7478 Use non-blocking I/O.
7483 Do not update the file's access time.
7484 Some older file systems silently ignore this flag, so it is a good
7485 idea to test it on your files before relying on it.
7489 @cindex controlling terminal
7490 Do not assign the file to be a controlling terminal for @command{dd}.
7491 This has no effect when the file is not a terminal.
7492 On many hosts (e.g., @acronym{GNU}/Linux hosts), this option has no effect
7497 @cindex symbolic links, following
7498 Do not follow symbolic links.
7503 Fail if the file has multiple hard links.
7508 Use binary I/O. This option has an effect only on nonstandard
7509 platforms that distinguish binary from text I/O.
7514 Use text I/O. Like @samp{binary}, this option has no effect on
7519 These flags are not supported on all systems, and @samp{dd} rejects
7520 attempts to use them when they are not supported. When reading from
7521 standard input or writing to standard output, the @samp{nofollow} and
7522 @samp{noctty} flags should not be specified, and the other flags
7523 (e.g., @samp{nonblock}) can affect how other processes behave with the
7524 affected file descriptors, even after @command{dd} exits.
7528 @cindex multipliers after numbers
7529 The numeric-valued strings above (@var{bytes} and @var{blocks}) can be
7530 followed by a multiplier: @samp{b}=512, @samp{c}=1,
7531 @samp{w}=2, @samp{x@var{m}}=@var{m}, or any of the
7532 standard block size suffixes like @samp{k}=1024 (@pxref{Block size}).
7534 Use different @command{dd} invocations to use different block sizes for
7535 skipping and I/O@. For example, the following shell commands copy data
7536 in 512 KiB blocks between a disk and a tape, but do not save or restore a
7537 4 KiB label at the start of the disk:
7540 disk=/dev/rdsk/c0t1d0s2
7543 # Copy all but the label from disk to tape.
7544 (dd bs=4k skip=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$disk >$tape
7546 # Copy from tape back to disk, but leave the disk label alone.
7547 (dd bs=4k seek=1 count=0 && dd bs=512k) <$tape >$disk
7550 Sending an @samp{INFO} signal to a running @command{dd}
7551 process makes it print I/O statistics to standard error
7552 and then resume copying. In the example below,
7553 @command{dd} is run in the background to copy 10 million blocks.
7554 The @command{kill} command makes it output intermediate I/O statistics,
7555 and when @command{dd} completes, it outputs the final statistics.
7558 $ dd if=/dev/zero of=/dev/null count=10MB & pid=$!
7559 $ kill -s INFO $pid; wait $pid
7560 3385223+0 records in
7561 3385223+0 records out
7562 1733234176 bytes (1.7 GB) copied, 6.42173 seconds, 270 MB/s
7563 10000000+0 records in
7564 10000000+0 records out
7565 5120000000 bytes (5.1 GB) copied, 18.913 seconds, 271 MB/s
7568 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
7569 On systems lacking the @samp{INFO} signal @command{dd} responds to the
7570 @samp{USR1} signal instead, unless the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}
7571 environment variable is set.
7576 @node install invocation
7577 @section @command{install}: Copy files and set attributes
7580 @cindex copying files and setting attributes
7582 @command{install} copies files while setting their file mode bits and, if
7583 possible, their owner and group. Synopses:
7586 install [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7587 install [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7588 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7589 install [@var{option}]@dots{} -d @var{directory}@dots{}
7594 If two file names are given, @command{install} copies the first file to the
7598 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7599 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7600 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7601 @command{install} copies each @var{source} file to the specified
7602 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7605 If the @option{--directory} (@option{-d}) option is given,
7606 @command{install} creates each @var{directory} and any missing parent
7607 directories. Parent directories are created with mode
7608 @samp{u=rwx,go=rx} (755), regardless of the @option{-m} option or the
7609 current umask. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
7610 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of parent directories are inherited.
7613 @cindex Makefiles, installing programs in
7614 @command{install} is similar to @command{cp}, but allows you to control the
7615 attributes of destination files. It is typically used in Makefiles to
7616 copy programs into their destination directories. It refuses to copy
7617 files onto themselves.
7619 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7627 Ignored; for compatibility with old Unix versions of @command{install}.
7632 @opindex --directory
7633 @cindex directories, creating with given attributes
7634 @cindex parent directories, creating missing
7635 @cindex leading directories, creating missing
7636 Create any missing parent directories, giving them the default
7637 attributes. Then create each given directory, setting their owner,
7638 group and mode as given on the command line or to the defaults.
7640 @item -g @var{group}
7641 @itemx --group=@var{group}
7644 @cindex group ownership of installed files, setting
7645 Set the group ownership of installed files or directories to
7646 @var{group}. The default is the process's current group. @var{group}
7647 may be either a group name or a numeric group ID.
7650 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
7653 @cindex permissions of installed files, setting
7654 Set the file mode bits for the installed file or directory to @var{mode},
7655 which can be either an octal number, or a symbolic mode as in
7656 @command{chmod}, with @samp{a=} (no access allowed to anyone) as the
7657 point of departure (@pxref{File permissions}).
7658 The default mode is @samp{u=rwx,go=rx,a-s}---read, write, and
7659 execute for the owner, read and execute for group and other, and with
7660 set-user-ID and set-group-ID disabled.
7661 This default is not quite the same as @samp{755}, since it disables
7662 instead of preserving set-user-ID and set-group-ID on directories.
7663 @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}.
7665 @item -o @var{owner}
7666 @itemx --owner=@var{owner}
7669 @cindex ownership of installed files, setting
7670 @cindex appropriate privileges
7671 @vindex root @r{as default owner}
7672 If @command{install} has appropriate privileges (is run as root), set the
7673 ownership of installed files or directories to @var{owner}. The default
7674 is @code{root}. @var{owner} may be either a user name or a numeric user
7678 @itemx --preserve-timestamps
7680 @opindex --preserve-timestamps
7681 @cindex timestamps of installed files, preserving
7682 Set the time of last access and the time of last modification of each
7683 installed file to match those of each corresponding original file.
7684 When a file is installed without this option, its last access and
7685 last modification times are both set to the time of installation.
7686 This option is useful if you want to use the last modification times
7687 of installed files to keep track of when they were last built as opposed
7688 to when they were last installed.
7694 @cindex symbol table information, stripping
7695 @cindex stripping symbol table information
7696 Strip the symbol tables from installed binary executables.
7702 @optNoTargetDirectory
7708 Print the name of each file before copying it.
7716 @section @command{mv}: Move (rename) files
7720 @command{mv} moves or renames files (or directories). Synopses:
7723 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{source} @var{dest}
7724 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{source}@dots{} @var{directory}
7725 mv [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{source}@dots{}
7730 If two file names are given, @command{mv} moves the first file to the
7734 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
7735 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
7736 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
7737 @command{mv} moves each @var{source} file to the specified
7738 directory, using the @var{source}s' names.
7741 @command{mv} can move any type of file from one file system to another.
7742 Prior to version @code{4.0} of the fileutils,
7743 @command{mv} could move only regular files between file systems.
7744 For example, now @command{mv} can move an entire directory hierarchy
7745 including special device files from one partition to another. It first
7746 uses some of the same code that's used by @code{cp -a} to copy the
7747 requested directories and files, then (assuming the copy succeeded)
7748 it removes the originals. If the copy fails, then the part that was
7749 copied to the destination partition is removed. If you were to copy
7750 three directories from one partition to another and the copy of the first
7751 directory succeeded, but the second didn't, the first would be left on
7752 the destination partition and the second and third would be left on the
7755 @cindex prompting, and @command{mv}
7756 If a destination file exists but is normally unwritable, standard input
7757 is a terminal, and the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given,
7758 @command{mv} prompts the user for whether to replace the file. (You might
7759 own the file, or have write permission on its directory.) If the
7760 response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7762 @emph{Warning}: If you try to move a symlink that points to a directory,
7763 and you specify the symlink with a trailing slash, then @command{mv}
7764 doesn't move the symlink but instead moves the directory referenced
7765 by the symlink. @xref{Trailing slashes}.
7767 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7777 @cindex prompts, omitting
7778 Do not prompt the user before removing a destination file.
7781 @itemx --interactive
7783 @opindex --interactive
7784 @cindex prompts, forcing
7785 Prompt whether to overwrite each existing destination file, regardless
7787 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7789 @itemx @w{@kbd{--reply}=@var{how}}
7791 @cindex interactivity
7792 @c FIXME: remove in 2008
7793 @strong{Deprecated: to be removed in 2008.}@*
7794 Specifying @option{--reply=yes} is equivalent to using @option{--force}.
7795 Specify @option{--reply=no} to make @command{mv} act as if @samp{no} were
7796 given as a response to every prompt about a destination file.
7797 Specify @option{--reply=query} to make @command{mv} prompt the user
7798 about each existing destination file.
7799 Note that @option{--reply=no} has an effect only when @command{mv} would prompt
7800 without @option{-i} or equivalent, i.e., when a destination file exists and is
7801 not writable, standard input is a terminal, and no @option{-f} (or equivalent)
7802 option is specified.
7808 @cindex newer files, moving only
7809 Do not move a non-directory that has an existing destination with the
7810 same or newer modification time.
7811 If the move is across file system boundaries, the comparison is to the
7812 source time stamp truncated to the resolutions of the destination file
7813 system and of the system calls used to update time stamps; this avoids
7814 duplicate work if several @samp{mv -u} commands are executed with the
7815 same source and destination.
7821 Print the name of each file before moving it.
7823 @optStripTrailingSlashes
7829 @optNoTargetDirectory
7837 @section @command{rm}: Remove files or directories
7840 @cindex removing files or directories
7842 @command{rm} removes each given @var{file}. By default, it does not remove
7843 directories. Synopsis:
7846 rm [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
7849 @cindex prompting, and @command{rm}
7850 If the @option{-I} or @option{--interactive=once} option is given,
7851 and there are more than three files or the @option{-r}, @option{-R},
7852 or @option{--recursive} are given, then @command{rm} prompts the user
7853 for whether to proceed with the entire operation. If the response is
7854 not affirmative, the entire command is aborted.
7856 Otherwise, if a file is unwritable, standard input is a terminal, and
7857 the @option{-f} or @option{--force} option is not given, or the
7858 @option{-i} or @option{--interactive=always} option @emph{is} given,
7859 @command{rm} prompts the user for whether to remove the file.
7860 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7862 Any attempt to remove a file whose last file name component is
7863 @file{.} or @file{..} is rejected without any prompting.
7865 @emph{Warning}: If you use @command{rm} to remove a file, it is usually
7866 possible to recover the contents of that file. If you want more assurance
7867 that the contents are truly unrecoverable, consider using @command{shred}.
7869 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
7877 Ignore nonexistent files and never prompt the user.
7878 Ignore any previous @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option.
7882 Prompt whether to remove each file.
7883 If the response is not affirmative, the file is skipped.
7884 Ignore any previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option.
7885 Equivalent to @option{--interactive=always}.
7889 Prompt once whether to proceed with the command, if more than three
7890 files are named or if a recursive removal is requested. Ignore any
7891 previous @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option. Equivalent to
7892 @option{--interactive=once}.
7894 @itemx --interactive [=@var{when}]
7895 @opindex --interactive
7896 Specify when to issue an interactive prompt. @var{when} may be
7900 @vindex never @r{interactive option}
7901 - Do not prompt at all.
7903 @vindex once @r{interactive option}
7904 - Prompt once if more than three files are named or if a recursive
7905 removal is requested. Equivalent to @option{-I}.
7907 @vindex always @r{interactive option}
7908 - Prompt for every file being removed. Equivalent to @option{-i}.
7910 Specifying @option{--interactive} and no @var{when} is equivalent to
7911 @option{--interactive=always}.
7913 @itemx --one-file-system
7914 @opindex --one-file-system
7915 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{rm} to
7916 When removing a hierarchy recursively, skip any directory that is on a
7917 file system different from that of the corresponding command line argument.
7919 This option is useful when removing a build ``chroot'' hierarchy,
7920 which normally contains no valuable data. However, it is not uncommon
7921 to bind-mount @file{/home} into such a hierarchy, to make it easier to
7922 use one's start-up file. The catch is that it's easy to forget to
7923 unmount @file{/home}. Then, when you use @command{rm -rf} to remove
7924 your normally throw-away chroot, that command will remove everything
7925 under @file{/home}, too.
7926 Use the @option{--one-file-system} option, and it will
7927 warn about and skip directories on other file systems.
7928 Of course, this will not save your @file{/home} if it and your
7929 chroot happen to be on the same file system.
7931 @itemx --preserve-root
7932 @opindex --preserve-root
7933 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive destruction
7934 Fail upon any attempt to remove the root directory, @file{/},
7935 when used with the @option{--recursive} option.
7936 This is the default behavior.
7937 @xref{Treating / specially}.
7939 @itemx --no-preserve-root
7940 @opindex --no-preserve-root
7941 @cindex root directory, allow recursive destruction
7942 Do not treat @file{/} specially when removing recursively.
7943 This option is not recommended unless you really want to
7944 remove all the files on your computer.
7945 @xref{Treating / specially}.
7952 @opindex --recursive
7953 @cindex directories, removing (recursively)
7954 Remove the listed directories and their contents recursively.
7960 Print the name of each file before removing it.
7964 @cindex files beginning with @samp{-}, removing
7965 @cindex @samp{-}, removing files beginning with
7966 One common question is how to remove files whose names begin with a
7967 @samp{-}. @sc{gnu} @command{rm}, like every program that uses the @code{getopt}
7968 function to parse its arguments, lets you use the @samp{--} option to
7969 indicate that all following arguments are non-options. To remove a file
7970 called @file{-f} in the current directory, you could type either:
7983 @opindex - @r{and Unix @command{rm}}
7984 The Unix @command{rm} program's use of a single @samp{-} for this purpose
7985 predates the development of the getopt standard syntax.
7990 @node shred invocation
7991 @section @command{shred}: Remove files more securely
7994 @cindex data, erasing
7995 @cindex erasing data
7997 @command{shred} overwrites devices or files, to help prevent even
7998 very expensive hardware from recovering the data.
8000 Ordinarily when you remove a file (@pxref{rm invocation}), the data is
8001 not actually destroyed. Only the index listing where the file is
8002 stored is destroyed, and the storage is made available for reuse.
8003 There are undelete utilities that will attempt to reconstruct the index
8004 and can bring the file back if the parts were not reused.
8006 On a busy system with a nearly-full drive, space can get reused in a few
8007 seconds. But there is no way to know for sure. If you have sensitive
8008 data, you may want to be sure that recovery is not possible by actually
8009 overwriting the file with non-sensitive data.
8011 However, even after doing that, it is possible to take the disk back
8012 to a laboratory and use a lot of sensitive (and expensive) equipment
8013 to look for the faint ``echoes'' of the original data underneath the
8014 overwritten data. If the data has only been overwritten once, it's not
8017 The best way to remove something irretrievably is to destroy the media
8018 it's on with acid, melt it down, or the like. For cheap removable media
8019 like floppy disks, this is the preferred method. However, hard drives
8020 are expensive and hard to melt, so the @command{shred} utility tries
8021 to achieve a similar effect non-destructively.
8023 This uses many overwrite passes, with the data patterns chosen to
8024 maximize the damage they do to the old data. While this will work on
8025 floppies, the patterns are designed for best effect on hard drives.
8026 For more details, see the source code and Peter Gutmann's paper
8027 @uref{http://www.cs.auckland.ac.nz/~pgut001/pubs/secure_del.html,
8028 @cite{Secure Deletion of Data from Magnetic and Solid-State Memory}},
8029 from the proceedings of the Sixth @acronym{USENIX} Security Symposium (San Jose,
8030 California, July 22--25, 1996).
8032 @strong{Please note} that @command{shred} relies on a very important assumption:
8033 that the file system overwrites data in place. This is the traditional
8034 way to do things, but many modern file system designs do not satisfy this
8035 assumption. Exceptions include:
8040 Log-structured or journaled file systems, such as those supplied with
8041 AIX and Solaris, and JFS, ReiserFS, XFS, Ext3 (in @code{data=journal} mode),
8042 BFS, NTFS, etc.@: when they are configured to journal @emph{data}.
8045 File systems that write redundant data and carry on even if some writes
8046 fail, such as RAID-based file systems.
8049 File systems that make snapshots, such as Network Appliance's NFS server.
8052 File systems that cache in temporary locations, such as NFS version 3
8056 Compressed file systems.
8059 In the particular case of ext3 file systems, the above disclaimer applies (and
8060 @command{shred} is thus of limited effectiveness) only in @code{data=journal}
8061 mode, which journals file data in addition to just metadata. In both
8062 the @code{data=ordered} (default) and @code{data=writeback} modes,
8063 @command{shred} works as usual. Ext3 journaling modes can be changed
8064 by adding the @code{data=something} option to the mount options for a
8065 particular file system in the @file{/etc/fstab} file, as documented in
8066 the mount man page (man mount).
8068 If you are not sure how your file system operates, then you should assume
8069 that it does not overwrite data in place, which means that shred cannot
8070 reliably operate on regular files in your file system.
8072 Generally speaking, it is more reliable to shred a device than a file,
8073 since this bypasses the problem of file system design mentioned above.
8074 However, even shredding devices is not always completely reliable. For
8075 example, most disks map out bad sectors invisibly to the application; if
8076 the bad sectors contain sensitive data, @command{shred} won't be able to
8079 @command{shred} makes no attempt to detect or report this problem, just as
8080 it makes no attempt to do anything about backups. However, since it is
8081 more reliable to shred devices than files, @command{shred} by default does
8082 not truncate or remove the output file. This default is more suitable
8083 for devices, which typically cannot be truncated and should not be
8086 Finally, consider the risk of backups and mirrors.
8087 File system backups and remote mirrors may contain copies of the
8088 file that cannot be removed, and that will allow a shredded file
8089 to be recovered later. So if you keep any data you may later want
8090 to destroy using @command{shred}, be sure that it is not backed up or mirrored.
8093 shred [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}[@dots{}]
8096 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8104 @cindex force deletion
8105 Override file permissions if necessary to allow overwriting.
8108 @itemx -n @var{NUMBER}
8109 @itemx --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8110 @opindex -n @var{NUMBER}
8111 @opindex --iterations=@var{NUMBER}
8112 @cindex iterations, selecting the number of
8113 By default, @command{shred} uses 25 passes of overwrite. This is enough
8114 for all of the useful overwrite patterns to be used at least once.
8115 You can reduce this to save time, or increase it if you have a lot of
8118 @item --random-source=@var{file}
8119 @opindex --random-source
8120 @cindex random source for shredding
8121 Use @var{file} as a source of random data used to overwrite and to
8122 choose pass ordering. @xref{Random sources}.
8124 @item -s @var{BYTES}
8125 @itemx --size=@var{BYTES}
8126 @opindex -s @var{BYTES}
8127 @opindex --size=@var{BYTES}
8128 @cindex size of file to shred
8129 Shred the first @var{BYTES} bytes of the file. The default is to shred
8130 the whole file. @var{BYTES} can be followed by a size specification like
8131 @samp{K}, @samp{M}, or @samp{G} to specify a multiple. @xref{Block size}.
8137 @cindex removing files after shredding
8138 After shredding a file, truncate it (if possible) and then remove it.
8139 If a file has multiple links, only the named links will be removed.
8145 Display status updates as sterilization proceeds.
8151 By default, @command{shred} rounds the size of a regular file up to the next
8152 multiple of the file system block size to fully erase the last block of the file.
8153 Use @option{--exact} to suppress that behavior.
8154 Thus, by default if you shred a 10-byte regular file on a system with 512-byte
8155 blocks, the resulting file will be 512 bytes long. With this option,
8156 shred does not increase the apparent size of the file.
8162 Normally, the last pass that @command{shred} writes is made up of
8163 random data. If this would be conspicuous on your hard drive (for
8164 example, because it looks like encrypted data), or you just think
8165 it's tidier, the @option{--zero} option adds an additional overwrite pass with
8166 all zero bits. This is in addition to the number of passes specified
8167 by the @option{--iterations} option.
8171 You might use the following command to erase all trace of the
8172 file system you'd created on the floppy disk in your first drive.
8173 That command takes about 20 minutes to erase a ``1.44MB'' (actually
8177 shred --verbose /dev/fd0
8180 Similarly, to erase all data on a selected partition of
8181 your hard disk, you could give a command like this:
8184 shred --verbose /dev/sda5
8187 A @var{file} of @samp{-} denotes standard output.
8188 The intended use of this is to shred a removed temporary file.
8192 i=`tempfile -m 0600`
8195 echo "Hello, world" >&3
8200 However, the command @samp{shred - >file} does not shred the contents
8201 of @var{file}, since the shell truncates @var{file} before invoking
8202 @command{shred}. Use the command @samp{shred file} or (if using a
8203 Bourne-compatible shell) the command @samp{shred - 1<>file} instead.
8208 @node Special file types
8209 @chapter Special file types
8211 @cindex special file types
8212 @cindex file types, special
8214 This chapter describes commands which create special types of files (and
8215 @command{rmdir}, which removes directories, one special file type).
8217 @cindex special file types
8219 Although Unix-like operating systems have markedly fewer special file
8220 types than others, not @emph{everything} can be treated only as the
8221 undifferentiated byte stream of @dfn{normal files}. For example, when a
8222 file is created or removed, the system must record this information,
8223 which it does in a @dfn{directory}---a special type of file. Although
8224 you can read directories as normal files, if you're curious, in order
8225 for the system to do its job it must impose a structure, a certain
8226 order, on the bytes of the file. Thus it is a ``special'' type of file.
8228 Besides directories, other special file types include named pipes
8229 (FIFOs), symbolic links, sockets, and so-called @dfn{special files}.
8232 * link invocation:: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8233 * ln invocation:: Make links between files.
8234 * mkdir invocation:: Make directories.
8235 * mkfifo invocation:: Make FIFOs (named pipes).
8236 * mknod invocation:: Make block or character special files.
8237 * readlink invocation:: Print the referent of a symbolic link.
8238 * rmdir invocation:: Remove empty directories.
8239 * unlink invocation:: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8243 @node link invocation
8244 @section @command{link}: Make a hard link via the link syscall
8247 @cindex links, creating
8248 @cindex hard links, creating
8249 @cindex creating links (hard only)
8251 @command{link} creates a single hard link at a time.
8252 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
8253 @code{link} function. @xref{Hard Links, , , libc,
8254 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8255 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
8256 @command{ln} command (@pxref{ln invocation}).
8260 link @var{filename} @var{linkname}
8263 @var{filename} must specify an existing file, and @var{linkname}
8264 must specify a nonexistent entry in an existing directory.
8265 @command{link} simply calls @code{link (@var{filename}, @var{linkname})}
8268 On a @acronym{GNU} system, this command acts like @samp{ln --directory
8269 --no-target-directory @var{filename} @var{linkname}}. However, the
8270 @option{--directory} and @option{--no-target-directory} options are
8271 not specified by @acronym{POSIX}, and the @command{link} command is
8272 more portable in practice.
8278 @section @command{ln}: Make links between files
8281 @cindex links, creating
8282 @cindex hard links, creating
8283 @cindex symbolic (soft) links, creating
8284 @cindex creating links (hard or soft)
8286 @cindex file systems and hard links
8287 @command{ln} makes links between files. By default, it makes hard links;
8288 with the @option{-s} option, it makes symbolic (or @dfn{soft}) links.
8292 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} [-T] @var{target} @var{linkname}
8293 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}
8294 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{target}@dots{} @var{directory}
8295 ln [@var{option}]@dots{} -t @var{directory} @var{target}@dots{}
8301 If two file names are given, @command{ln} creates a link to the first
8302 file from the second.
8305 If one @var{target} is given, @command{ln} creates a link to that file
8306 in the current directory.
8309 If the @option{--target-directory} (@option{-t}) option is given, or
8310 failing that if the last file is a directory and the
8311 @option{--no-target-directory} (@option{-T}) option is not given,
8312 @command{ln} creates a link to each @var{target} file in the specified
8313 directory, using the @var{target}s' names.
8317 Normally @command{ln} does not remove existing files. Use the
8318 @option{--force} (@option{-f}) option to remove them unconditionally,
8319 the @option{--interactive} (@option{-i}) option to remove them
8320 conditionally, and the @option{--backup} (@option{-b}) option to
8323 @cindex hard link, defined
8324 @cindex inode, and hard links
8325 A @dfn{hard link} is another name for an existing file; the link and the
8326 original are indistinguishable. Technically speaking, they share the
8327 same inode, and the inode contains all the information about a
8328 file---indeed, it is not incorrect to say that the inode @emph{is} the
8329 file. On all existing implementations, you cannot make a hard link to
8330 a directory, and hard links cannot cross file system boundaries. (These
8331 restrictions are not mandated by @acronym{POSIX}, however.)
8333 @cindex dereferencing symbolic links
8334 @cindex symbolic link, defined
8335 @dfn{Symbolic links} (@dfn{symlinks} for short), on the other hand, are
8336 a special file type (which not all kernels support: System V release 3
8337 (and older) systems lack symlinks) in which the link file actually
8338 refers to a different file, by name. When most operations (opening,
8339 reading, writing, and so on) are passed the symbolic link file, the
8340 kernel automatically @dfn{dereferences} the link and operates on the
8341 target of the link. But some operations (e.g., removing) work on the
8342 link file itself, rather than on its target. @xref{Symbolic Links,,,
8343 libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}.
8345 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8356 @opindex --directory
8357 @cindex hard links to directories
8358 Allow users with appropriate privileges to attempt to make hard links
8360 However, note that this will probably fail due to
8361 system restrictions, even for the super-user.
8367 Remove existing destination files.
8370 @itemx --interactive
8372 @opindex --interactive
8373 @cindex prompting, and @command{ln}
8374 Prompt whether to remove existing destination files.
8377 @itemx --no-dereference
8379 @opindex --no-dereference
8380 Do not treat the last operand specially when it is a symbolic link to
8381 a directory. Instead, treat it as if it were a normal file.
8383 When the destination is an actual directory (not a symlink to one),
8384 there is no ambiguity. The link is created in that directory.
8385 But when the specified destination is a symlink to a directory,
8386 there are two ways to treat the user's request. @command{ln} can
8387 treat the destination just as it would a normal directory and create
8388 the link in it. On the other hand, the destination can be viewed as a
8389 non-directory---as the symlink itself. In that case, @command{ln}
8390 must delete or backup that symlink before creating the new link.
8391 The default is to treat a destination that is a symlink to a directory
8392 just like a directory.
8394 This option is weaker than the @option{--no-target-directory}
8395 (@option{-T}) option, so it has no effect if both options are given.
8401 Make symbolic links instead of hard links. This option merely produces
8402 an error message on systems that do not support symbolic links.
8408 @optNoTargetDirectory
8414 Print the name of each file after linking it successfully.
8425 # Create link ../a pointing to a in that directory.
8426 # Not really useful because it points to itself.
8431 # Change to the target before creating symlinks to avoid being confused.
8437 # Hard coded file names don't move well.
8438 ln -s $(pwd)/a /some/dir/
8442 # Relative file names survive directory moves and also
8443 # work across networked file systems.
8444 ln -s afile anotherfile
8445 ln -s ../adir/afile yetanotherfile
8449 @node mkdir invocation
8450 @section @command{mkdir}: Make directories
8453 @cindex directories, creating
8454 @cindex creating directories
8456 @command{mkdir} creates directories with the specified names. Synopsis:
8459 mkdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
8462 @command{mkdir} creates each directory @var{name} in the order given.
8463 It reports an error if @var{name} already exists, unless the
8464 @option{-p} option is given and @var{name} is a directory.
8466 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8471 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8474 @cindex modes of created directories, setting
8475 Set the file permission bits of created directories to @var{mode},
8476 which uses the same syntax as
8477 in @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rwx} (read, write and execute allowed for
8478 everyone) for the point of the departure. @xref{File permissions}.
8480 Normally the directory has the desired file mode bits at the moment it
8481 is created. As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @var{mode} may also mention
8482 special mode bits, but in this case there may be a temporary window
8483 during which the directory exists but its special mode bits are
8484 incorrect. @xref{Directory Setuid and Setgid}, for how the
8485 set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of directories are inherited unless
8486 overridden in this way.
8492 @cindex parent directories, creating
8493 Make any missing parent directories for each argument, setting their
8494 file permission bits to the umask modified by @samp{u+wx}. Ignore
8495 existing parent directories, and do not change their file permission
8498 To set the file permission bits of any newly-created parent
8499 directories to a value that includes @samp{u+wx}, you can set the
8500 umask before invoking @command{mkdir}. For example, if the shell
8501 command @samp{(umask u=rwx,go=rx; mkdir -p P/Q)} creates the parent
8502 @file{P} it sets the parent's permission bits to @samp{u=rwx,go=rx}.
8503 To set a parent's special mode bits as well, you can invoke
8504 @command{chmod} after @command{mkdir}. @xref{Directory Setuid and
8505 Setgid}, for how the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of
8506 newly-created parent directories are inherited.
8512 Print a message for each created directory. This is most useful with
8519 @node mkfifo invocation
8520 @section @command{mkfifo}: Make FIFOs (named pipes)
8523 @cindex FIFOs, creating
8524 @cindex named pipes, creating
8525 @cindex creating FIFOs (named pipes)
8527 @command{mkfifo} creates FIFOs (also called @dfn{named pipes}) with the
8528 specified names. Synopsis:
8531 mkfifo [@var{option}] @var{name}@dots{}
8534 A @dfn{FIFO} is a special file type that permits independent processes
8535 to communicate. One process opens the FIFO file for writing, and
8536 another for reading, after which data can flow as with the usual
8537 anonymous pipe in shells or elsewhere.
8539 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8544 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8547 @cindex modes of created FIFOs, setting
8548 Set the mode of created FIFOs to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8549 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} (read and write allowed for everyone)
8550 for the point of departure. @var{mode} should specify only file
8551 permission bits. @xref{File permissions}.
8558 @node mknod invocation
8559 @section @command{mknod}: Make block or character special files
8562 @cindex block special files, creating
8563 @cindex character special files, creating
8565 @command{mknod} creates a FIFO, character special file, or block special
8566 file with the specified name. Synopsis:
8569 mknod [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name} @var{type} [@var{major} @var{minor}]
8572 @cindex special files
8573 @cindex block special files
8574 @cindex character special files
8575 Unlike the phrase ``special file type'' above, the term @dfn{special
8576 file} has a technical meaning on Unix: something that can generate or
8577 receive data. Usually this corresponds to a physical piece of hardware,
8578 e.g., a printer or a disk. (These files are typically created at
8579 system-configuration time.) The @command{mknod} command is what creates
8580 files of this type. Such devices can be read either a character at a
8581 time or a ``block'' (many characters) at a time, hence we say there are
8582 @dfn{block special} files and @dfn{character special} files.
8584 The arguments after @var{name} specify the type of file to make:
8589 @opindex p @r{for FIFO file}
8593 @opindex b @r{for block special file}
8594 for a block special file
8597 @c Don't document the `u' option -- it's just a synonym for `c'.
8598 @c Do *any* versions of mknod still use it?
8600 @opindex c @r{for character special file}
8601 @c @opindex u @r{for character special file}
8602 for a character special file
8606 When making a block or character special file, the major and minor
8607 device numbers must be given after the file type.
8608 If a major or minor device number begins with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X},
8609 it is interpreted as hexadecimal; otherwise, if it begins with @samp{0},
8610 as octal; otherwise, as decimal.
8612 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8617 @itemx --mode=@var{mode}
8620 Set the mode of created files to @var{mode}, which is symbolic as in
8621 @command{chmod} and uses @samp{a=rw} as the point of departure.
8622 @var{mode} should specify only file permission bits.
8623 @xref{File permissions}.
8630 @node readlink invocation
8631 @section @command{readlink}: Print the referent of a symbolic link
8634 @cindex displaying value of a symbolic link
8636 @command{readlink} may work in one of two supported modes:
8642 @command{readlink} outputs the value of the given symbolic link.
8643 If @command{readlink} is invoked with an argument other than the name
8644 of a symbolic link, it produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8646 @item Canonicalize mode
8648 @command{readlink} outputs the absolute name of the given file which contains
8649 no @file{.}, @file{..} components nor any repeated separators
8650 (@file{/}) or symbolic links.
8655 readlink [@var{option}] @var{file}
8658 By default, @command{readlink} operates in readlink mode.
8660 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8665 @itemx --canonicalize
8667 @opindex --canonicalize
8668 Activate canonicalize mode.
8669 If any component of the file name except the last one is missing or unavailable,
8670 @command{readlink} produces no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8673 @itemx --canonicalize-existing
8675 @opindex --canonicalize-existing
8676 Activate canonicalize mode.
8677 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} produces
8678 no output and exits with a nonzero exit code.
8681 @itemx --canonicalize-missing
8683 @opindex --canonicalize-missing
8684 Activate canonicalize mode.
8685 If any component is missing or unavailable, @command{readlink} treats it
8691 @opindex --no-newline
8692 Do not output the trailing newline.
8702 Suppress most error messages.
8708 Report error messages.
8712 The @command{readlink} utility first appeared in OpenBSD 2.1.
8717 @node rmdir invocation
8718 @section @command{rmdir}: Remove empty directories
8721 @cindex removing empty directories
8722 @cindex directories, removing empty
8724 @command{rmdir} removes empty directories. Synopsis:
8727 rmdir [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{directory}@dots{}
8730 If any @var{directory} argument does not refer to an existing empty
8731 directory, it is an error.
8733 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8737 @item --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8738 @opindex --ignore-fail-on-non-empty
8739 @cindex directory deletion, ignoring failures
8740 Ignore each failure to remove a directory that is solely because
8741 the directory is non-empty.
8747 @cindex parent directories, removing
8748 Remove @var{directory}, then try to remove each component of @var{directory}.
8749 So, for example, @samp{rmdir -p a/b/c} is similar to @samp{rmdir a/b/c a/b a}.
8750 As such, it fails if any of those directories turns out not to be empty.
8751 Use the @option{--ignore-fail-on-non-empty} option to make it so such
8752 a failure does not evoke a diagnostic and does not cause @command{rmdir} to
8753 exit unsuccessfully.
8759 @cindex directory deletion, reporting
8760 Give a diagnostic for each successful removal.
8761 @var{directory} is removed.
8765 @xref{rm invocation}, for how to remove non-empty directories (recursively).
8770 @node unlink invocation
8771 @section @command{unlink}: Remove files via the unlink syscall
8774 @cindex removing files or directories (via the unlink syscall)
8776 @command{unlink} deletes a single specified file name.
8777 It is a minimalist interface to the system-provided
8778 @code{unlink} function. @xref{Deleting Files, , , libc,
8779 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}. Synopsis:
8780 It avoids the bells and whistles of the more commonly-used
8781 @command{rm} command (@pxref{rm invocation}).
8784 unlink @var{filename}
8787 On some systems @code{unlink} can be used to delete the name of a
8788 directory. On others, it can be used that way only by a privileged user.
8789 In the GNU system @code{unlink} can never delete the name of a directory.
8791 The @command{unlink} command honors the @option{--help} and
8792 @option{--version} options. To remove a file whose name begins with
8793 @samp{-}, prefix the name with @samp{./}, e.g., @samp{unlink ./--help}.
8798 @node Changing file attributes
8799 @chapter Changing file attributes
8801 @cindex changing file attributes
8802 @cindex file attributes, changing
8803 @cindex attributes, file
8805 A file is not merely its contents, a name, and a file type
8806 (@pxref{Special file types}). A file also has an owner (a user ID), a
8807 group (a group ID), permissions (what the owner can do with the file,
8808 what people in the group can do, and what everyone else can do), various
8809 timestamps, and other information. Collectively, we call these a file's
8812 These commands change file attributes.
8815 * chgrp invocation:: Change file groups.
8816 * chmod invocation:: Change access permissions.
8817 * chown invocation:: Change file owners and groups.
8818 * touch invocation:: Change file timestamps.
8822 @node chown invocation
8823 @section @command{chown}: Change file owner and group
8826 @cindex file ownership, changing
8827 @cindex group ownership, changing
8828 @cindex changing file ownership
8829 @cindex changing group ownership
8831 @command{chown} changes the user and/or group ownership of each given @var{file}
8832 to @var{new-owner} or to the user and group of an existing reference file.
8836 chown [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{new-owner} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
8839 If used, @var{new-owner} specifies the new owner and/or group as follows
8840 (with no embedded white space):
8843 [@var{owner}] [ : [@var{group}] ]
8850 If only an @var{owner} (a user name or numeric user ID) is given, that
8851 user is made the owner of each given file, and the files' group is not
8854 @item owner@samp{:}group
8855 If the @var{owner} is followed by a colon and a @var{group} (a
8856 group name or numeric group ID), with no spaces between them, the group
8857 ownership of the files is changed as well (to @var{group}).
8860 If a colon but no group name follows @var{owner}, that user is
8861 made the owner of the files and the group of the files is changed to
8862 @var{owner}'s login group.
8865 If the colon and following @var{group} are given, but the owner
8866 is omitted, only the group of the files is changed; in this case,
8867 @command{chown} performs the same function as @command{chgrp}.
8870 If only a colon is given, or if @var{new-owner} is empty, neither the
8871 owner nor the group is changed.
8875 If @var{owner} or @var{group} is intended to represent a numeric user
8876 or group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
8877 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
8879 Some older scripts may still use @samp{.} in place of the @samp{:} separator.
8880 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) does not
8881 require support for that, but for backward compatibility @acronym{GNU}
8882 @command{chown} supports @samp{.} so long as no ambiguity results.
8883 New scripts should avoid the use of @samp{.} because it is not
8884 portable, and because it has undesirable results if the entire
8885 @var{owner@samp{.}group} happens to identify a user whose name
8888 The @command{chown} command sometimes clears the set-user-ID or
8889 set-group-ID permission bits. This behavior depends on the policy and
8890 functionality of the underlying @code{chown} system call, which may
8891 make system-dependent file mode modifications outside the control of
8892 the @command{chown} command. For example, the @command{chown} command
8893 might not affect those bits when invoked by a user with appropriate
8894 privileges, or when the
8895 bits signify some function other than executable permission (e.g.,
8897 When in doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
8899 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
8907 @cindex changed owners, verbosely describing
8908 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose ownership
8917 @cindex error messages, omitting
8918 Do not print error messages about files whose ownership cannot be
8921 @itemx @w{@kbd{--from}=@var{old-owner}}
8923 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
8924 Change a @var{file}'s ownership only if it has current attributes specified
8925 by @var{old-owner}. @var{old-owner} has the same form as @var{new-owner}
8927 This option is useful primarily from a security standpoint in that
8928 it narrows considerably the window of potential abuse.
8929 For example, to reflect a user ID numbering change for one user's files
8930 without an option like this, @code{root} might run
8933 find / -owner OLDUSER -print0 | xargs -0 chown -h NEWUSER
8936 But that is dangerous because the interval between when the @command{find}
8937 tests the existing file's owner and when the @command{chown} is actually run
8939 One way to narrow the gap would be to invoke chown for each file
8943 find / -owner OLDUSER -exec chown -h NEWUSER @{@} \;
8946 But that is very slow if there are many affected files.
8947 With this option, it is safer (the gap is narrower still)
8948 though still not perfect:
8951 chown -h -R --from=OLDUSER NEWUSER /
8955 @opindex --dereference
8956 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
8958 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
8959 This is the default.
8962 @itemx --no-dereference
8964 @opindex --no-dereference
8965 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
8967 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
8968 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
8969 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
8970 @command{chown} fails when a file specified on the command line
8972 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
8973 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
8975 @itemx --preserve-root
8976 @opindex --preserve-root
8977 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
8978 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
8979 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
8980 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8982 @itemx --no-preserve-root
8983 @opindex --no-preserve-root
8984 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
8985 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
8986 @xref{Treating / specially}.
8988 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
8989 @opindex --reference
8990 Change the user and group of each @var{file} to be the same as those of
8991 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
8992 user and group of the symbolic link, but rather those of the file it
8999 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9000 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9001 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9002 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9003 its referent is being changed.
9008 @opindex --recursive
9009 @cindex recursively changing file ownership
9010 Recursively change ownership of directories and their contents.
9013 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9016 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9019 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9028 # Change the owner of /u to "root".
9031 # Likewise, but also change its group to "staff".
9034 # Change the owner of /u and subfiles to "root".
9039 @node chgrp invocation
9040 @section @command{chgrp}: Change group ownership
9043 @cindex group ownership, changing
9044 @cindex changing group ownership
9046 @command{chgrp} changes the group ownership of each given @var{file}
9047 to @var{group} (which can be either a group name or a numeric group ID)
9048 or to the group of an existing reference file. Synopsis:
9051 chgrp [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{group} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9054 If @var{group} is intended to represent a
9055 numeric group ID, then you may specify it with a leading @samp{+}.
9056 @xref{Disambiguating names and IDs}.
9058 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9066 @cindex changed files, verbosely describing
9067 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose group actually
9076 @cindex error messages, omitting
9077 Do not print error messages about files whose group cannot be
9081 @opindex --dereference
9082 @cindex symbolic links, changing owner
9084 Do not act on symbolic links themselves but rather on what they point to.
9085 This is the default.
9088 @itemx --no-dereference
9090 @opindex --no-dereference
9091 @cindex symbolic links, changing group
9093 Act on symbolic links themselves instead of what they point to.
9094 This mode relies on the @code{lchown} system call.
9095 On systems that do not provide the @code{lchown} system call,
9096 @command{chgrp} fails when a file specified on the command line
9098 By default, no diagnostic is issued for symbolic links encountered
9099 during a recursive traversal, but see @option{--verbose}.
9101 @itemx --preserve-root
9102 @opindex --preserve-root
9103 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9104 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9105 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9106 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9108 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9109 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9110 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9111 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9112 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9114 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9115 @opindex --reference
9116 Change the group of each @var{file} to be the same as that of
9117 @var{ref_file}. If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the
9118 group of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9124 Output a diagnostic for every file processed.
9125 If a symbolic link is encountered during a recursive traversal
9126 on a system without the @code{lchown} system call, and @option{--no-dereference}
9127 is in effect, then issue a diagnostic saying neither the symbolic link nor
9128 its referent is being changed.
9133 @opindex --recursive
9134 @cindex recursively changing group ownership
9135 Recursively change the group ownership of directories and their contents.
9138 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9141 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9144 @xref{Traversing symlinks}.
9153 # Change the group of /u to "staff".
9156 # Change the group of /u and subfiles to "staff".
9161 @node chmod invocation
9162 @section @command{chmod}: Change access permissions
9165 @cindex changing access permissions
9166 @cindex access permissions, changing
9167 @cindex permissions, changing access
9169 @command{chmod} changes the access permissions of the named files. Synopsis:
9172 chmod [@var{option}]@dots{} @{@var{mode} | --reference=@var{ref_file}@} @var{file}@dots{}
9175 @cindex symbolic links, permissions of
9176 @command{chmod} never changes the permissions of symbolic links, since
9177 the @command{chmod} system call cannot change their permissions.
9178 This is not a problem since the permissions of symbolic links are
9179 never used. However, for each symbolic link listed on the command
9180 line, @command{chmod} changes the permissions of the pointed-to file.
9181 In contrast, @command{chmod} ignores symbolic links encountered during
9182 recursive directory traversals.
9184 A successful use of @command{chmod} clears the set-group-ID bit of a
9185 regular file if the file's group ID does not match the user's
9186 effective group ID or one of the user's supplementary group IDs,
9187 unless the user has appropriate privileges. Additional restrictions
9188 may cause the set-user-ID and set-group-ID bits of @var{mode} or
9189 @var{ref_file} to be ignored. This behavior depends on the policy and
9190 functionality of the underlying @code{chmod} system call. When in
9191 doubt, check the underlying system behavior.
9193 If used, @var{mode} specifies the new file mode bits.
9194 For details, see the section on @ref{File permissions}.
9195 If you really want @var{mode} to have a leading @samp{-}, you should
9196 use @option{--} first, e.g., @samp{chmod -- -w file}. Typically,
9197 though, @samp{chmod a-w file} is preferable, and @command{chmod -w
9198 file} (without the @option{--}) complains if it behaves differently
9199 from what @samp{chmod a-w file} would do.
9201 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9209 Verbosely describe the action for each @var{file} whose permissions
9218 @cindex error messages, omitting
9219 Do not print error messages about files whose permissions cannot be
9222 @itemx --preserve-root
9223 @opindex --preserve-root
9224 @cindex root directory, disallow recursive modification
9225 Fail upon any attempt to recursively change the root directory, @file{/}.
9226 Without @option{--recursive}, this option has no effect.
9227 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9229 @itemx --no-preserve-root
9230 @opindex --no-preserve-root
9231 @cindex root directory, allow recursive modification
9232 Cancel the effect of any preceding @option{--preserve-root} option.
9233 @xref{Treating / specially}.
9239 Verbosely describe the action or non-action taken for every @var{file}.
9241 @item --reference=@var{ref_file}
9242 @opindex --reference
9243 Change the mode of each @var{file} to be the same as that of @var{ref_file}.
9244 @xref{File permissions}.
9245 If @var{ref_file} is a symbolic link, do not use the mode
9246 of the symbolic link, but rather that of the file it refers to.
9251 @opindex --recursive
9252 @cindex recursively changing access permissions
9253 Recursively change permissions of directories and their contents.
9260 @node touch invocation
9261 @section @command{touch}: Change file timestamps
9264 @cindex changing file timestamps
9265 @cindex file timestamps, changing
9266 @cindex timestamps, changing file
9268 @command{touch} changes the access and/or modification times of the
9269 specified files. Synopsis:
9272 touch [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{file}@dots{}
9275 @cindex empty files, creating
9276 Any @var{file} that does not exist is created empty.
9278 A @var{file} of @samp{-} causes @command{touch} to change the
9279 times of the file associated with standard output.
9281 @cindex permissions, for changing file timestamps
9282 If changing both the access and modification times to the current
9283 time, @command{touch} can change the timestamps for files that the user
9284 running it does not own but has write permission for. Otherwise, the
9285 user must own the files.
9287 Although @command{touch} provides options for changing two of the times---the
9288 times of last access and modification---of a file, there is actually
9289 a third one as well: the inode change time. This is often referred to
9290 as a file's @code{ctime}.
9291 The inode change time represents the time when the file's meta-information
9292 last changed. One common example of this is when the permissions of a
9293 file change. Changing the permissions doesn't access the file, so
9294 the atime doesn't change, nor does it modify the file, so the mtime
9295 doesn't change. Yet, something about the file itself has changed,
9296 and this must be noted somewhere. This is the job of the ctime field.
9297 This is necessary, so that, for example, a backup program can make a
9298 fresh copy of the file, including the new permissions value.
9299 Another operation that modifies a file's ctime without affecting
9300 the others is renaming. In any case, it is not possible, in normal
9301 operations, for a user to change the ctime field to a user-specified value.
9304 Time stamps assume the time zone rules specified by the @env{TZ}
9305 environment variable, or by the system default rules if @env{TZ} is
9306 not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with @env{TZ},
9307 libc, The GNU C Library}. You can avoid ambiguities during
9308 daylight saving transitions by using @sc{utc} time stamps.
9310 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9316 @itemx --time=access
9320 @opindex atime@r{, changing}
9321 @opindex access @r{time, changing}
9322 @opindex use @r{time, changing}
9323 Change the access time only.
9328 @opindex --no-create
9329 Do not create files that do not exist.
9332 @itemx --date=@var{time}
9336 Use @var{time} instead of the current time. It can contain month names,
9337 time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm}, @samp{yesterday}, etc. For
9338 example, @option{--date="2004-02-27 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"}
9339 specifies the instant of time that is 489,392,193 nanoseconds after
9340 February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a time zone that is 5 hours and 30
9341 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. @xref{Date input formats}.
9342 File systems that do not support high-resolution time stamps
9343 silently ignore any excess precision here.
9347 @cindex BSD @command{touch} compatibility
9348 Ignored; for compatibility with BSD versions of @command{touch}.
9352 @itemx --time=modify
9355 @opindex mtime@r{, changing}
9356 @opindex modify @r{time, changing}
9357 Change the modification time only.
9360 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
9362 @opindex --reference
9363 Use the times of the reference @var{file} instead of the current time.
9364 If this option is combined with the @option{--date=@var{time}}
9365 (@option{-d @var{time}}) option, the reference @var{file}'s time is
9366 the origin for any relative @var{time}s given, but is otherwise ignored.
9367 For example, @samp{-r foo -d '-5 seconds'} specifies a time stamp
9368 equal to five seconds before the corresponding time stamp for @file{foo}.
9370 @item -t [[@var{CC}]@var{YY}]@var{MMDDhhmm}[.@var{ss}]
9371 Use the argument (optional four-digit or two-digit years, months,
9372 days, hours, minutes, optional seconds) instead of the current time.
9373 If the year is specified with only two digits, then @var{CC}
9374 is 20 for years in the range 0 @dots{} 68, and 19 for years in
9375 69 @dots{} 99. If no digits of the year are specified,
9376 the argument is interpreted as a date in the current year.
9380 @vindex _POSIX2_VERSION
9381 On older systems, @command{touch} supports an obsolete syntax, as follows.
9382 If no timestamp is given with any of the @option{-d}, @option{-r}, or
9383 @option{-t} options, and if there are two or more @var{file}s and the
9384 first @var{file} is of the form @samp{@var{MMDDhhmm}[@var{YY}]} and this
9385 would be a valid argument to the @option{-t} option (if the @var{YY}, if
9386 any, were moved to the front), and if the represented year
9387 is in the range 1969--1999, that argument is interpreted as the time
9388 for the other files instead of as a file name.
9389 This obsolete behavior can be enabled or disabled with the
9390 @env{_POSIX2_VERSION} environment variable (@pxref{Standards
9391 conformance}), but portable scripts should avoid commands whose
9392 behavior depends on this variable.
9393 For example, use @samp{touch ./12312359 main.c} or @samp{touch -t
9394 12312359 main.c} rather than the ambiguous @samp{touch 12312359 main.c}.
9404 No disk can hold an infinite amount of data. These commands report
9405 how much disk storage is in use or available, report other file and
9406 file status information, and write buffers to disk.
9409 * df invocation:: Report file system disk space usage.
9410 * du invocation:: Estimate file space usage.
9411 * stat invocation:: Report file or file system status.
9412 * sync invocation:: Synchronize memory and disk.
9417 @section @command{df}: Report file system disk space usage
9420 @cindex file system disk usage
9421 @cindex disk usage by file system
9423 @command{df} reports the amount of disk space used and available on
9424 file systems. Synopsis:
9427 df [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9430 With no arguments, @command{df} reports the space used and available on all
9431 currently mounted file systems (of all types). Otherwise, @command{df}
9432 reports on the file system containing each argument @var{file}.
9434 Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9435 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9436 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9438 @cindex disk device file
9439 @cindex device file, disk
9440 If an argument @var{file} is a disk device file containing a mounted
9441 file system, @command{df} shows the space available on that file system
9442 rather than on the file system containing the device node (i.e., the root
9443 file system). @sc{gnu} @command{df} does not attempt to determine the disk usage
9444 on unmounted file systems, because on most kinds of systems doing so
9445 requires extremely nonportable intimate knowledge of file system
9448 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9456 @cindex automounter file systems
9457 @cindex ignore file systems
9458 Include in the listing dummy file systems, which
9459 are omitted by default. Such file systems are typically special-purpose
9460 pseudo-file-systems, such as automounter entries.
9463 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9465 @opindex --block-size
9466 @cindex file system sizes
9467 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9468 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9474 Equivalent to @option{--si}.
9481 List inode usage information instead of block usage. An inode (short
9482 for index node) contains information about a file such as its owner,
9483 permissions, timestamps, and location on the disk.
9487 @cindex kibibytes for file system sizes
9488 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9489 (@pxref{Block size}).
9490 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9496 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9497 Limit the listing to local file systems. By default, remote file systems
9502 @cindex file system space, retrieving old data more quickly
9503 Do not invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data.
9504 This may make @command{df} run significantly faster on systems with many
9505 disks, but on some systems (notably SunOS) the results may be slightly
9506 out of date. This is the default.
9509 @itemx --portability
9511 @opindex --portability
9512 @cindex one-line output format
9513 @cindex @acronym{POSIX} output format
9514 @cindex portable output format
9515 @cindex output format, portable
9516 Use the @acronym{POSIX} output format. This is like the default format except
9521 The information about each file system is always printed on exactly
9522 one line; a mount device is never put on a line by itself. This means
9523 that if the mount device name is more than 20 characters long (e.g., for
9524 some network mounts), the columns are misaligned.
9527 The labels in the header output line are changed to conform to @acronym{POSIX}.
9530 The default block size and output format are unaffected by the
9531 @env{DF_BLOCK_SIZE}, @env{BLOCK_SIZE} and @env{BLOCKSIZE} environment
9532 variables. However, the default block size is still affected by
9533 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT}: it is 512 if @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} is set, 1024
9534 otherwise. @xref{Block size}.
9541 @cindex file system space, retrieving current data more slowly
9542 Invoke the @code{sync} system call before getting any usage data. On
9543 some systems (notably SunOS), doing this yields more up to date results,
9544 but in general this option makes @command{df} much slower, especially when
9545 there are many or very busy file systems.
9547 @item -t @var{fstype}
9548 @itemx --type=@var{fstype}
9551 @cindex file system types, limiting output to certain
9552 Limit the listing to file systems of type @var{fstype}. Multiple
9553 file system types can be specified by giving multiple @option{-t} options.
9554 By default, nothing is omitted.
9559 @opindex --print-type
9560 @cindex file system types, printing
9561 Print each file system's type. The types printed here are the same ones
9562 you can include or exclude with @option{-t} and @option{-x}. The particular
9563 types printed are whatever is supported by the system. Here are some of
9564 the common names (this list is certainly not exhaustive):
9569 @cindex @acronym{NFS} file system type
9570 An @acronym{NFS} file system, i.e., one mounted over a network from another
9571 machine. This is the one type name which seems to be used uniformly by
9574 @item 4.2@r{, }ufs@r{, }efs@dots{}
9575 @cindex Linux file system types
9576 @cindex local file system types
9577 @opindex 4.2 @r{file system type}
9578 @opindex ufs @r{file system type}
9579 @opindex efs @r{file system type}
9580 A file system on a locally-mounted hard disk. (The system might even
9581 support more than one type here; Linux does.)
9583 @item hsfs@r{, }cdfs
9584 @cindex CD-ROM file system type
9585 @cindex High Sierra file system
9586 @opindex hsfs @r{file system type}
9587 @opindex cdfs @r{file system type}
9588 A file system on a CD-ROM drive. HP-UX uses @samp{cdfs}, most other
9589 systems use @samp{hsfs} (@samp{hs} for ``High Sierra'').
9592 @cindex PC file system
9593 @cindex DOS file system
9594 @cindex MS-DOS file system
9595 @cindex diskette file system
9597 An MS-DOS file system, usually on a diskette.
9601 @item -x @var{fstype}
9602 @itemx --exclude-type=@var{fstype}
9604 @opindex --exclude-type
9605 Limit the listing to file systems not of type @var{fstype}.
9606 Multiple file system types can be eliminated by giving multiple
9607 @option{-x} options. By default, no file system types are omitted.
9610 Ignored; for compatibility with System V versions of @command{df}.
9615 Failure includes the case where no output is generated, so you can
9616 inspect the exit status of a command like @samp{df -t ext3 -t reiserfs
9617 @var{dir}} to test whether @var{dir} is on a file system of type
9618 @samp{ext3} or @samp{reiserfs}.
9622 @section @command{du}: Estimate file space usage
9625 @cindex file space usage
9626 @cindex disk usage for files
9628 @command{du} reports the amount of disk space used by the specified files
9629 and for each subdirectory (of directory arguments). Synopsis:
9632 du [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9635 With no arguments, @command{du} reports the disk space for the current
9636 directory. Normally the disk space is printed in units of
9637 1024 bytes, but this can be overridden (@pxref{Block size}).
9638 Non-integer quantities are rounded up to the next higher unit.
9640 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
9648 Show counts for all files, not just directories.
9650 @itemx --apparent-size
9651 @opindex --apparent-size
9652 Print apparent sizes, rather than disk usage. The apparent size of a
9653 file is the number of bytes reported by @code{wc -c} on regular files,
9654 or more generally, @code{ls -l --block-size=1} or @code{stat --format=%s}.
9655 For example, a file containing the word @samp{zoo} with no newline would,
9656 of course, have an apparent size of 3. Such a small file may require
9657 anywhere from 0 to 16 KiB or more of disk space, depending on
9658 the type and configuration of the file system on which the file resides.
9659 However, a sparse file created with this command:
9662 dd bs=1 seek=2GiB if=/dev/null of=big
9666 has an apparent size of 2 GiB, yet on most modern
9667 systems, it actually uses almost no disk space.
9673 Equivalent to @code{--apparent-size --block-size=1}.
9676 @itemx --block-size=@var{size}
9678 @opindex --block-size
9680 Scale sizes by @var{size} before printing them (@pxref{Block size}).
9681 For example, @option{-BG} prints sizes in units of 1,073,741,824 bytes.
9687 @cindex grand total of disk space
9688 Print a grand total of all arguments after all arguments have
9689 been processed. This can be used to find out the total disk usage of
9690 a given set of files or directories.
9693 @itemx --dereference-args
9695 @opindex --dereference-args
9696 Dereference symbolic links that are command line arguments.
9697 Does not affect other symbolic links. This is helpful for finding
9698 out the disk usage of directories, such as @file{/usr/tmp}, which
9699 are often symbolic links.
9701 @itemx --files0-from=@var{FILE}
9702 @opindex --files0-from=@var{FILE}
9703 @cindex including files from @command{du}
9704 Rather than processing files named on the command line, process those
9705 named in file @var{FILE}; each name is terminated by a null byte.
9706 This is useful with the @option{--total} (@option{-c}) option when
9707 the list of file names is so long that it may exceed a command line
9709 In such cases, running @command{du} via @command{xargs} is undesirable
9710 because it splits the list into pieces and makes @command{du} print a
9711 total for each sublist rather than for the entire list.
9712 One way to produce a list of null-byte-terminated file names is with @sc{gnu}
9713 @command{find}, using its @option{-print0} predicate.
9714 Do not specify any @var{FILE} on the command line when using this option.
9720 Currently, @option{-H} is the same as @option{--si},
9721 except that @option{-H} evokes a warning.
9722 This option will be changed to be equivalent to
9723 @option{--dereference-args} (@option{-D}).
9727 @cindex kibibytes for file sizes
9728 Print sizes in 1024-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9729 (@pxref{Block size}).
9730 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1K}.
9733 @itemx --count-links
9735 @opindex --count-links
9736 @cindex hard links, counting in @command{du}
9737 Count the size of all files, even if they have appeared already (as a
9741 @itemx --dereference
9743 @opindex --dereference
9744 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9745 Dereference symbolic links (show the disk space used by the file
9746 or directory that the link points to instead of the space used by
9751 @cindex mebibytes for file sizes
9752 Print sizes in 1,048,576-byte blocks, overriding the default block size
9753 (@pxref{Block size}).
9754 This option is equivalent to @option{--block-size=1M}.
9757 @itemx --no-dereference
9759 @opindex --no-dereference
9760 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{du}
9761 For each symbolic links encountered by @command{du},
9762 consider the disk space used by the symbolic link.
9764 @item --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9765 @opindex --max-depth=@var{DEPTH}
9766 @cindex limiting output of @command{du}
9767 Show the total for each directory (and file if --all) that is at
9768 most MAX_DEPTH levels down from the root of the hierarchy. The root
9769 is at level 0, so @code{du --max-depth=0} is equivalent to @code{du -s}.
9775 @cindex output null-byte-terminated lines
9776 Output a null byte at the end of each line, rather than a newline.
9777 This option enables other programs to parse the output of @command{du}
9778 even when that output would contain file names with embedded newlines.
9785 @opindex --summarize
9786 Display only a total for each argument.
9789 @itemx --separate-dirs
9791 @opindex --separate-dirs
9792 Report the size of each directory separately, not including the sizes
9797 @cindex last modified dates, displaying in @command{du}
9798 Show time of the most recent modification of any file in the directory,
9799 or any of its subdirectories.
9802 @itemx --time=status
9805 @opindex ctime@r{, show the most recent}
9806 @opindex status time@r{, show the most recent}
9807 @opindex use time@r{, show the most recent}
9808 Show the most recent status change time (the @samp{ctime} in the inode) of
9809 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
9812 @itemx --time=access
9814 @opindex atime@r{, show the most recent}
9815 @opindex access time@r{, show the most recent}
9816 Show the most recent access time (the @samp{atime} in the inode) of
9817 any file in the directory, instead of the modification time.
9819 @item --time-style=@var{style}
9820 @opindex --time-style
9822 List timestamps in style @var{style}. This option has an effect only if
9823 the @option{--time} option is also specified. The @var{style} should
9824 be one of the following:
9829 List timestamps using @var{format}, where @var{format} is interpreted
9830 like the format argument of @command{date} (@pxref{date invocation}).
9831 For example, @option{--time-style="+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S"} causes
9832 @command{du} to list timestamps like @samp{2002-03-30 23:45:56}. As
9833 with @command{date}, @var{format}'s interpretation is affected by the
9834 @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
9837 List timestamps in full using @acronym{ISO} 8601 date, time, and time zone
9838 format with nanosecond precision, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30
9839 23:45:56.477817180 -0700}. This style is equivalent to
9840 @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N %z}.
9843 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 date and time in minutes, e.g.,
9844 @samp{2002-03-30 23:45}. These timestamps are shorter than
9845 @samp{full-iso} timestamps, and are usually good enough for everyday
9846 work. This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d %H:%M}.
9849 List @acronym{ISO} 8601 dates for timestamps, e.g., @samp{2002-03-30}.
9850 This style is equivalent to @samp{+%Y-%m-%d}.
9854 You can specify the default value of the @option{--time-style} option
9855 with the environment variable @env{TIME_STYLE}; if @env{TIME_STYLE} is not set
9856 the default style is @samp{long-iso}. For compatibility with @command{ls},
9857 if @env{TIME_STYLE} begins with @samp{+} and contains a newline,
9858 the newline and any later characters are ignored; if @env{TIME_STYLE}
9859 begins with @samp{posix-} the @samp{posix-} is ignored; and if
9860 @env{TIME_STYLE} is @samp{locale} it is ignored.
9863 @itemx --one-file-system
9865 @opindex --one-file-system
9866 @cindex one file system, restricting @command{du} to
9867 Skip directories that are on different file systems from the one that
9868 the argument being processed is on.
9870 @item --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
9871 @opindex --exclude=@var{PATTERN}
9872 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
9873 When recursing, skip subdirectories or files matching @var{PATTERN}.
9874 For example, @code{du --exclude='*.o'} excludes files whose names
9878 @itemx --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
9879 @opindex -X @var{FILE}
9880 @opindex --exclude-from=@var{FILE}
9881 @cindex excluding files from @command{du}
9882 Like @option{--exclude}, except take the patterns to exclude from @var{FILE},
9883 one per line. If @var{FILE} is @samp{-}, take the patterns from standard
9888 @cindex NFS mounts from BSD to HP-UX
9889 On BSD systems, @command{du} reports sizes that are half the correct
9890 values for files that are NFS-mounted from HP-UX systems. On HP-UX
9891 systems, it reports sizes that are twice the correct values for
9892 files that are NFS-mounted from BSD systems. This is due to a flaw
9893 in HP-UX; it also affects the HP-UX @command{du} program.
9898 @node stat invocation
9899 @section @command{stat}: Report file or file system status
9903 @cindex file system status
9905 @command{stat} displays information about the specified file(s). Synopsis:
9908 stat [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
9911 With no option, @command{stat} reports all information about the given files.
9912 But it also can be used to report the information of the file systems the
9913 given files are located on. If the files are links, @command{stat} can
9914 also give information about the files the links point to.
9920 @itemx --dereference
9922 @opindex --dereference
9923 @cindex symbolic links, dereferencing in @command{stat}
9924 Change how @command{stat} treats symbolic links.
9925 With this option, @command{stat} acts on the file referenced
9926 by each symbolic link argument.
9927 Without it, @command{stat} acts on any symbolic link argument directly.
9930 @itemx --file-system
9932 @opindex --file-system
9933 @cindex file systems
9934 Report information about the file systems where the given files are located
9935 instead of information about the files themselves.
9938 @itemx --format=@var{format}
9940 @opindex --format=@var{format}
9941 @cindex output format
9942 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
9943 @var{format} is automatically newline-terminated, so
9944 running a command like the following with two or more @var{file}
9945 operands produces a line of output for each operand:
9947 $ stat --format=%d:%i / /usr
9952 @itemx --printf=@var{format}
9953 @opindex --printf=@var{format}
9954 @cindex output format
9955 Use @var{format} rather than the default format.
9956 Like @option{--format}, but interpret backslash escapes,
9957 and do not output a mandatory trailing newline.
9958 If you want a newline, include @samp{\n} in the @var{format}.
9959 Here's how you would use @option{--printf} to print the device
9960 and inode numbers of @file{/} and @file{/usr}:
9962 $ stat --printf='%d:%i\n' / /usr
9971 @cindex terse output
9972 Print the information in terse form, suitable for parsing by other programs.
9974 The valid format sequences for files are:
9977 @item %a - Access rights in octal
9978 @item %A - Access rights in human readable form
9979 @item %b - Number of blocks allocated (see @samp{%B})
9980 @item %B - The size in bytes of each block reported by @samp{%b}
9981 @item %d - Device number in decimal
9982 @item %D - Device number in hex
9983 @item %f - Raw mode in hex
9984 @item %F - File type
9985 @item %g - Group ID of owner
9986 @item %G - Group name of owner
9987 @item %h - Number of hard links
9988 @item %i - Inode number
9989 @item %n - File name
9990 @item %N - Quoted file name with dereference if symbolic link
9991 @item %o - I/O block size
9992 @item %s - Total size, in bytes
9993 @item %t - Major device type in hex
9994 @item %T - Minor device type in hex
9995 @item %u - User ID of owner
9996 @item %U - User name of owner
9997 @item %x - Time of last access
9998 @item %X - Time of last access as seconds since Epoch
9999 @item %y - Time of last modification
10000 @item %Y - Time of last modification as seconds since Epoch
10001 @item %z - Time of last change
10002 @item %Z - Time of last change as seconds since Epoch
10005 The valid format sequences for file systems are:
10008 @item %a - Free blocks available to non-super-user
10009 @item %b - Total data blocks in file system
10010 @item %c - Total file nodes in file system
10011 @item %d - Free file nodes in file system
10012 @item %f - Free blocks in file system
10013 @item %i - File System ID in hex
10014 @item %l - Maximum length of file names
10015 @item %n - File name
10016 @item %s - Block size (for faster transfers)
10017 @item %S - Fundamental block size (for block counts)
10018 @item %t - Type in hex
10019 @item %T - Type in human readable form
10023 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
10024 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
10025 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
10026 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
10032 @node sync invocation
10033 @section @command{sync}: Synchronize data on disk with memory
10036 @cindex synchronize disk and memory
10038 @cindex superblock, writing
10039 @cindex inodes, written buffered
10040 @command{sync} writes any data buffered in memory out to disk. This can
10041 include (but is not limited to) modified superblocks, modified inodes,
10042 and delayed reads and writes. This must be implemented by the kernel;
10043 The @command{sync} program does nothing but exercise the @code{sync} system
10046 @cindex crashes and corruption
10047 The kernel keeps data in memory to avoid doing (relatively slow) disk
10048 reads and writes. This improves performance, but if the computer
10049 crashes, data may be lost or the file system corrupted as a
10050 result. The @command{sync} command ensures everything in memory
10051 is written to disk.
10053 Any arguments are ignored, except for a lone @option{--help} or
10054 @option{--version} (@pxref{Common options}).
10059 @node Printing text
10060 @chapter Printing text
10062 @cindex printing text, commands for
10063 @cindex commands for printing text
10065 This section describes commands that display text strings.
10068 * echo invocation:: Print a line of text.
10069 * printf invocation:: Format and print data.
10070 * yes invocation:: Print a string until interrupted.
10074 @node echo invocation
10075 @section @command{echo}: Print a line of text
10078 @cindex displaying text
10079 @cindex printing text
10080 @cindex text, displaying
10081 @cindex arbitrary text, displaying
10083 @command{echo} writes each given @var{string} to standard output, with a
10084 space between each and a newline after the last one. Synopsis:
10087 echo [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{string}]@dots{}
10090 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
10091 Options must precede operands, and the normally-special argument
10092 @samp{--} has no special meaning and is treated like any other
10098 Do not output the trailing newline.
10102 @cindex backslash escapes
10103 Enable interpretation of the following backslash-escaped characters in
10112 suppress trailing newline
10126 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10127 (zero to three octal digits)
10129 the eight-bit value that is the octal number @var{nnn}
10130 (one to three octal digits)
10132 the eight-bit value that is the hexadecimal number @var{hh}
10133 (one or two hexadecimal digits)
10138 @cindex backslash escapes
10139 Disable interpretation of backslash escapes in each @var{string}.
10140 This is the default. If @option{-e} and @option{-E} are both
10141 specified, the last one given takes effect.
10145 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10146 If the @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set, then when
10147 @command{echo}'s first argument is not @option{-n} it outputs
10148 option-like arguments instead of treating them as options. For
10149 example, @code{echo -ne hello} outputs @samp{-ne hello} instead of
10150 plain @samp{hello}.
10152 @acronym{POSIX} does not require support for any options, and says
10153 that the behavior of @command{echo} is implementation-defined if any
10154 @var{string} contains a backslash or if the first argument is
10155 @option{-n}. Portable programs can use the @command{printf} command
10156 if they need to omit trailing newlines or output control characters or
10157 backslashes. @xref{printf invocation}.
10162 @node printf invocation
10163 @section @command{printf}: Format and print data
10166 @command{printf} does formatted printing of text. Synopsis:
10169 printf @var{format} [@var{argument}]@dots{}
10172 @command{printf} prints the @var{format} string, interpreting @samp{%}
10173 directives and @samp{\} escapes to format numeric and string arguments
10174 in a way that is mostly similar to the C @samp{printf} function. The
10175 differences are as follows:
10180 The @var{format} argument is reused as necessary to convert all the
10181 given @var{argument}s. For example, the command @samp{printf %s a b}
10185 Missing @var{argument}s are treated as null strings or as zeros,
10186 depending on whether the context expects a string or a number. For
10187 example, the command @samp{printf %sx%d} prints @samp{x0}.
10191 An additional escape, @samp{\c}, causes @command{printf} to produce no
10192 further output. For example, the command @samp{printf 'A%sC\cD%sF' B
10193 E} prints @samp{ABC}.
10196 The hexadecimal escape sequence @samp{\x@var{hh}} has at most two
10197 digits, as opposed to C where it can have an unlimited number of
10198 digits. For example, the command @samp{printf '\x07e'} prints two
10199 bytes, whereas the C statement @samp{printf ("\x07e")} prints just
10204 @command{printf} has an additional directive, @samp{%b}, which prints its
10205 argument string with @samp{\} escapes interpreted in the same way as in
10206 the @var{format} string, except that octal escapes are of the form
10207 @samp{\0@var{ooo}} where @var{ooo} is 0 to 3 octal digits.
10208 If a precision is also given, it limits the number of bytes printed
10209 from the converted string.
10212 Numeric arguments must be single C constants, possibly with leading
10213 @samp{+} or @samp{-}. For example, @samp{printf %.4d -3} outputs
10217 @vindex POSIXLY_CORRECT
10218 If the leading character of a numeric argument is @samp{"} or @samp{'}
10219 then its value is the numeric value of the immediately following
10220 character. Any remaining characters are silently ignored if the
10221 @env{POSIXLY_CORRECT} environment variable is set; otherwise, a
10222 warning is printed. For example, @samp{printf "%d" "'a"} outputs
10223 @samp{97} on hosts that use the @acronym{ASCII} character set, since
10224 @samp{a} has the numeric value 97 in @acronym{ASCII}.
10229 A floating-point argument must use a period before any fractional
10230 digits, but is printed according to the @env{LC_NUMERIC} category of the
10231 current locale. For example, in a locale whose radix character is a
10232 comma, the command @samp{printf %g 3.14} outputs @samp{3,14} whereas
10233 the command @samp{printf %g 3,14} is an error.
10237 @command{printf} interprets @samp{\@var{ooo}} in @var{format} as an octal number
10238 (if @var{ooo} is 1 to 3 octal digits) specifying a character to print,
10239 and @samp{\x@var{hh}} as a hexadecimal number (if @var{hh} is 1 to 2 hex
10240 digits) specifying a character to print.
10245 @cindex ISO/IEC 10646
10247 @command{printf} interprets two character syntaxes introduced in
10248 @acronym{ISO} C 99:
10249 @samp{\u} for 16-bit Unicode (@acronym{ISO}/@acronym{IEC} 10646)
10250 characters, specified as
10251 four hexadecimal digits @var{hhhh}, and @samp{\U} for 32-bit Unicode
10252 characters, specified as eight hexadecimal digits @var{hhhhhhhh}.
10253 @command{printf} outputs the Unicode characters
10254 according to the @env{LC_CTYPE} locale.
10256 The processing of @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} requires a full-featured
10257 @code{iconv} facility. It is activated on systems with glibc 2.2 (or newer),
10258 or when @code{libiconv} is installed prior to this package. Otherwise
10259 @samp{\u} and @samp{\U} will print as-is.
10261 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
10262 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
10263 Options must precede operands.
10265 The Unicode character syntaxes are useful for writing strings in a locale
10266 independent way. For example, a string containing the Euro currency symbol
10269 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u20AC 14.95'
10273 will be output correctly in all locales supporting the Euro symbol
10274 (@acronym{ISO}-8859-15, UTF-8, and others). Similarly, a Chinese string
10277 $ /usr/local/bin/printf '\u4e2d\u6587'
10281 will be output correctly in all Chinese locales (GB2312, BIG5, UTF-8, etc).
10283 Note that in these examples, the full name of @command{printf} has been
10284 given, to distinguish it from the GNU @code{bash} built-in function
10287 For larger strings, you don't need to look up the hexadecimal code
10288 values of each character one by one. @acronym{ASCII} characters mixed with \u
10289 escape sequences is also known as the JAVA source file encoding. You can
10290 use GNU recode 3.5c (or newer) to convert strings to this encoding. Here
10291 is how to convert a piece of text into a shell script which will output
10292 this text in a locale-independent way:
10295 $ LC_CTYPE=zh_CN.big5 /usr/local/bin/printf \
10296 '\u4e2d\u6587\n' > sample.txt
10297 $ recode BIG5..JAVA < sample.txt \
10298 | sed -e "s|^|/usr/local/bin/printf '|" -e "s|$|\\\\n'|" \
10305 @node yes invocation
10306 @section @command{yes}: Print a string until interrupted
10309 @cindex repeated output of a string
10311 @command{yes} prints the command line arguments, separated by spaces and
10312 followed by a newline, forever until it is killed. If no arguments are
10313 given, it prints @samp{y} followed by a newline forever until killed.
10315 Upon a write error, @command{yes} exits with status @samp{1}.
10317 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10318 To output an argument that begins with
10319 @samp{-}, precede it with @option{--}, e.g., @samp{yes -- --help}.
10320 @xref{Common options}.
10324 @chapter Conditions
10327 @cindex commands for exit status
10328 @cindex exit status commands
10330 This section describes commands that are primarily useful for their exit
10331 status, rather than their output. Thus, they are often used as the
10332 condition of shell @code{if} statements, or as the last command in a
10336 * false invocation:: Do nothing, unsuccessfully.
10337 * true invocation:: Do nothing, successfully.
10338 * test invocation:: Check file types and compare values.
10339 * expr invocation:: Evaluate expressions.
10343 @node false invocation
10344 @section @command{false}: Do nothing, unsuccessfully
10347 @cindex do nothing, unsuccessfully
10348 @cindex failure exit status
10349 @cindex exit status of @command{false}
10351 @command{false} does nothing except return an exit status of 1, meaning
10352 @dfn{failure}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10353 where an unsuccessful command is needed.
10354 In most modern shells, @command{false} is a built-in command, so when
10355 you use @samp{false} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10356 command, not the one documented here.
10358 @command{false} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10360 This version of @command{false} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10361 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10362 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10364 Note that @command{false} (unlike all other programs documented herein)
10365 exits unsuccessfully, even when invoked with
10366 @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
10368 Portable programs should not assume that the exit status of
10369 @command{false} is 1, as it is greater than 1 on some
10370 non-@acronym{GNU} hosts.
10373 @node true invocation
10374 @section @command{true}: Do nothing, successfully
10377 @cindex do nothing, successfully
10379 @cindex successful exit
10380 @cindex exit status of @command{true}
10382 @command{true} does nothing except return an exit status of 0, meaning
10383 @dfn{success}. It can be used as a place holder in shell scripts
10384 where a successful command is needed, although the shell built-in
10385 command @code{:} (colon) may do the same thing faster.
10386 In most modern shells, @command{true} is a built-in command, so when
10387 you use @samp{true} in a script, you're probably using the built-in
10388 command, not the one documented here.
10390 @command{true} honors the @option{--help} and @option{--version} options.
10392 Note, however, that it is possible to cause @command{true}
10393 to exit with nonzero status: with the @option{--help} or @option{--version}
10394 option, and with standard
10395 output already closed or redirected to a file that evokes an I/O error.
10396 For example, using a Bourne-compatible shell:
10399 $ ./true --version >&-
10400 ./true: write error: Bad file number
10401 $ ./true --version > /dev/full
10402 ./true: write error: No space left on device
10405 This version of @command{true} is implemented as a C program, and is thus
10406 more secure and faster than a shell script implementation, and may safely
10407 be used as a dummy shell for the purpose of disabling accounts.
10409 @node test invocation
10410 @section @command{test}: Check file types and compare values
10413 @cindex check file types
10414 @cindex compare values
10415 @cindex expression evaluation
10417 @command{test} returns a status of 0 (true) or 1 (false) depending on the
10418 evaluation of the conditional expression @var{expr}. Each part of the
10419 expression must be a separate argument.
10421 @command{test} has file status checks, string operators, and numeric
10422 comparison operators.
10424 @command{test} has an alternate form that uses opening and closing
10425 square brackets instead a leading @samp{test}. For example, instead
10426 of @samp{test -d /}, you can write @samp{[ -d / ]}. The square
10427 brackets must be separate arguments; for example, @samp{[-d /]} does
10428 not have the desired effect. Since @samp{test @var{expr}} and @samp{[
10429 @var{expr} ]} have the same meaning, only the former form is discussed
10435 test @var{expression}
10437 [ @var{expression} ]
10442 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
10443 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
10444 Because most shells have a built-in @command{test} command, using an
10445 unadorned @command{test} in a script or interactively may get you
10446 different functionality than that described here.
10448 If @var{expression} is omitted, @command{test} returns false.
10449 If @var{expression} is a single argument,
10450 @command{test} returns false if the argument is null and true otherwise. The argument
10451 can be any string, including strings like @samp{-d}, @samp{-1},
10452 @samp{--}, @samp{--help}, and @samp{--version} that most other
10453 programs would treat as options. To get help and version information,
10454 invoke the commands @samp{[ --help} and @samp{[ --version}, without
10455 the usual closing brackets. @xref{Common options}.
10457 @cindex exit status of @command{test}
10461 0 if the expression is true,
10462 1 if the expression is false,
10463 2 if an error occurred.
10467 * File type tests:: -[bcdfhLpSt]
10468 * Access permission tests:: -[gkruwxOG]
10469 * File characteristic tests:: -e -s -nt -ot -ef
10470 * String tests:: -z -n = !=
10471 * Numeric tests:: -eq -ne -lt -le -gt -ge
10472 * Connectives for test:: ! -a -o
10476 @node File type tests
10477 @subsection File type tests
10479 @cindex file type tests
10481 These options test for particular types of files. (Everything's a file,
10482 but not all files are the same!)
10486 @item -b @var{file}
10488 @cindex block special check
10489 True if @var{file} exists and is a block special device.
10491 @item -c @var{file}
10493 @cindex character special check
10494 True if @var{file} exists and is a character special device.
10496 @item -d @var{file}
10498 @cindex directory check
10499 True if @var{file} exists and is a directory.
10501 @item -f @var{file}
10503 @cindex regular file check
10504 True if @var{file} exists and is a regular file.
10506 @item -h @var{file}
10507 @itemx -L @var{file}
10510 @cindex symbolic link check
10511 True if @var{file} exists and is a symbolic link.
10512 Unlike all other file-related tests, this test does not dereference
10513 @var{file} if it is a symbolic link.
10515 @item -p @var{file}
10517 @cindex named pipe check
10518 True if @var{file} exists and is a named pipe.
10520 @item -S @var{file}
10522 @cindex socket check
10523 True if @var{file} exists and is a socket.
10527 @cindex terminal check
10528 True if @var{fd} is a file descriptor that is associated with a
10534 @node Access permission tests
10535 @subsection Access permission tests
10537 @cindex access permission tests
10538 @cindex permission tests
10540 These options test for particular access permissions.
10544 @item -g @var{file}
10546 @cindex set-group-ID check
10547 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-group-ID bit set.
10549 @item -k @var{file}
10551 @cindex sticky bit check
10552 True if @var{file} exists and has its @dfn{sticky} bit set.
10554 @item -r @var{file}
10556 @cindex readable file check
10557 True if @var{file} exists and read permission is granted.
10559 @item -u @var{file}
10561 @cindex set-user-ID check
10562 True if @var{file} exists and has its set-user-ID bit set.
10564 @item -w @var{file}
10566 @cindex writable file check
10567 True if @var{file} exists and write permission is granted.
10569 @item -x @var{file}
10571 @cindex executable file check
10572 True if @var{file} exists and execute permission is granted
10573 (or search permission, if it is a directory).
10575 @item -O @var{file}
10577 @cindex owned by effective user ID check
10578 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective user ID.
10580 @item -G @var{file}
10582 @cindex owned by effective group ID check
10583 True if @var{file} exists and is owned by the current effective group ID.
10587 @node File characteristic tests
10588 @subsection File characteristic tests
10590 @cindex file characteristic tests
10592 These options test other file characteristics.
10596 @item -e @var{file}
10598 @cindex existence-of-file check
10599 True if @var{file} exists.
10601 @item -s @var{file}
10603 @cindex nonempty file check
10604 True if @var{file} exists and has a size greater than zero.
10606 @item @var{file1} -nt @var{file2}
10608 @cindex newer-than file check
10609 True if @var{file1} is newer (according to modification date) than
10610 @var{file2}, or if @var{file1} exists and @var{file2} does not.
10612 @item @var{file1} -ot @var{file2}
10614 @cindex older-than file check
10615 True if @var{file1} is older (according to modification date) than
10616 @var{file2}, or if @var{file2} exists and @var{file1} does not.
10618 @item @var{file1} -ef @var{file2}
10620 @cindex same file check
10621 @cindex hard link check
10622 True if @var{file1} and @var{file2} have the same device and inode
10623 numbers, i.e., if they are hard links to each other.
10629 @subsection String tests
10631 @cindex string tests
10633 These options test string characteristics. You may need to quote
10634 @var{string} arguments for the shell. For example:
10640 The quotes here prevent the wrong arguments from being passed to
10641 @command{test} if @samp{$V} is empty or contains special characters.
10645 @item -z @var{string}
10647 @cindex zero-length string check
10648 True if the length of @var{string} is zero.
10650 @item -n @var{string}
10651 @itemx @var{string}
10653 @cindex nonzero-length string check
10654 True if the length of @var{string} is nonzero.
10656 @item @var{string1} = @var{string2}
10658 @cindex equal string check
10659 True if the strings are equal.
10661 @item @var{string1} != @var{string2}
10663 @cindex not-equal string check
10664 True if the strings are not equal.
10669 @node Numeric tests
10670 @subsection Numeric tests
10672 @cindex numeric tests
10673 @cindex arithmetic tests
10675 Numeric relationals. The arguments must be entirely numeric (possibly
10676 negative), or the special expression @w{@code{-l @var{string}}}, which
10677 evaluates to the length of @var{string}.
10681 @item @var{arg1} -eq @var{arg2}
10682 @itemx @var{arg1} -ne @var{arg2}
10683 @itemx @var{arg1} -lt @var{arg2}
10684 @itemx @var{arg1} -le @var{arg2}
10685 @itemx @var{arg1} -gt @var{arg2}
10686 @itemx @var{arg1} -ge @var{arg2}
10693 These arithmetic binary operators return true if @var{arg1} is equal,
10694 not-equal, less-than, less-than-or-equal, greater-than, or
10695 greater-than-or-equal than @var{arg2}, respectively.
10702 test -1 -gt -2 && echo yes
10704 test -l abc -gt 1 && echo yes
10707 @error{} test: integer expression expected before -eq
10711 @node Connectives for test
10712 @subsection Connectives for @command{test}
10714 @cindex logical connectives
10715 @cindex connectives, logical
10717 The usual logical connectives.
10723 True if @var{expr} is false.
10725 @item @var{expr1} -a @var{expr2}
10727 @cindex logical and operator
10728 @cindex and operator
10729 True if both @var{expr1} and @var{expr2} are true.
10731 @item @var{expr1} -o @var{expr2}
10733 @cindex logical or operator
10734 @cindex or operator
10735 True if either @var{expr1} or @var{expr2} is true.
10740 @node expr invocation
10741 @section @command{expr}: Evaluate expressions
10744 @cindex expression evaluation
10745 @cindex evaluation of expressions
10747 @command{expr} evaluates an expression and writes the result on standard
10748 output. Each token of the expression must be a separate argument.
10750 Operands are either integers or strings. Integers consist of one or
10751 more decimal digits, with an optional leading @samp{-}.
10752 @command{expr} converts
10753 anything appearing in an operand position to an integer or a string
10754 depending on the operation being applied to it.
10756 Strings are not quoted for @command{expr} itself, though you may need to
10757 quote them to protect characters with special meaning to the shell,
10758 e.g., spaces. However, regardless of whether it is quoted, a string
10759 operand should not be a parenthesis or any of @command{expr}'s
10760 operators like @code{+}, so you cannot safely pass an arbitrary string
10761 @code{$str} to expr merely by quoting it to the shell. One way to
10762 work around this is to use the @sc{gnu} extension @code{+},
10763 (e.g., @code{+ "$str" = foo}); a more portable way is to use
10764 @code{@w{" $str"}} and to adjust the rest of the expression to take
10765 the leading space into account (e.g., @code{@w{" $str" = " foo"}}).
10767 You should not pass a negative integer or a string with leading
10768 @samp{-} as @command{expr}'s first argument, as it might be
10769 misinterpreted as an option; this can be avoided by parenthesization.
10770 Also, portable scripts should not use a string operand that happens to
10771 take the form of an integer; this can be worked around by inserting
10772 leading spaces as mentioned above.
10774 @cindex parentheses for grouping
10775 Operators may be given as infix symbols or prefix keywords. Parentheses
10776 may be used for grouping in the usual manner. You must quote
10777 parentheses and many operators to avoid the shell evaluating them,
10780 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
10781 options}. Options must precede operands.
10783 @cindex exit status of @command{expr}
10787 0 if the expression is neither null nor 0,
10788 1 if the expression is null or 0,
10789 2 if the expression is invalid,
10790 3 if an internal error occurred (e.g., arithmetic overflow).
10794 * String expressions:: + : match substr index length
10795 * Numeric expressions:: + - * / %
10796 * Relations for expr:: | & < <= = == != >= >
10797 * Examples of expr:: Examples.
10801 @node String expressions
10802 @subsection String expressions
10804 @cindex string expressions
10805 @cindex expressions, string
10807 @command{expr} supports pattern matching and other string operators. These
10808 have lower precedence than both the numeric and relational operators (in
10809 the next sections).
10813 @item @var{string} : @var{regex}
10814 @cindex pattern matching
10815 @cindex regular expression matching
10816 @cindex matching patterns
10817 Perform pattern matching. The arguments are converted to strings and the
10818 second is considered to be a (basic, a la GNU @code{grep}) regular
10819 expression, with a @code{^} implicitly prepended. The first argument is
10820 then matched against this regular expression.
10822 If the match succeeds and @var{regex} uses @samp{\(} and @samp{\)}, the
10823 @code{:} expression returns the part of @var{string} that matched the
10824 subexpression; otherwise, it returns the number of characters matched.
10826 If the match fails, the @code{:} operator returns the null string if
10827 @samp{\(} and @samp{\)} are used in @var{regex}, otherwise 0.
10829 @kindex \( @r{regexp operator}
10830 Only the first @samp{\( @dots{} \)} pair is relevant to the return
10831 value; additional pairs are meaningful only for grouping the regular
10832 expression operators.
10834 @kindex \+ @r{regexp operator}
10835 @kindex \? @r{regexp operator}
10836 @kindex \| @r{regexp operator}
10837 In the regular expression, @code{\+}, @code{\?}, and @code{\|} are
10838 operators which respectively match one or more, zero or one, or separate
10839 alternatives. SunOS and other @command{expr}'s treat these as regular
10840 characters. (@acronym{POSIX} allows either behavior.)
10841 @xref{Top, , Regular Expression Library, regex, Regex}, for details of
10842 regular expression syntax. Some examples are in @ref{Examples of expr}.
10844 @item match @var{string} @var{regex}
10846 An alternative way to do pattern matching. This is the same as
10847 @w{@samp{@var{string} : @var{regex}}}.
10849 @item substr @var{string} @var{position} @var{length}
10851 Returns the substring of @var{string} beginning at @var{position}
10852 with length at most @var{length}. If either @var{position} or
10853 @var{length} is negative, zero, or non-numeric, returns the null string.
10855 @item index @var{string} @var{charset}
10857 Returns the first position in @var{string} where the first character in
10858 @var{charset} was found. If no character in @var{charset} is found in
10859 @var{string}, return 0.
10861 @item length @var{string}
10863 Returns the length of @var{string}.
10865 @item + @var{token}
10867 Interpret @var{token} as a string, even if it is a keyword like @var{match}
10868 or an operator like @code{/}.
10869 This makes it possible to test @code{expr length + "$x"} or
10870 @code{expr + "$x" : '.*/\(.\)'} and have it do the right thing even if
10871 the value of @var{$x} happens to be (for example) @code{/} or @code{index}.
10872 This operator is a @acronym{GNU} extension. Portable shell scripts should use
10873 @code{@w{" $token"} : @w{' \(.*\)'}} instead of @code{+ "$token"}.
10877 To make @command{expr} interpret keywords as strings, you must use the
10878 @code{quote} operator.
10881 @node Numeric expressions
10882 @subsection Numeric expressions
10884 @cindex numeric expressions
10885 @cindex expressions, numeric
10887 @command{expr} supports the usual numeric operators, in order of increasing
10888 precedence. The string operators (previous section) have lower precedence,
10889 the connectives (next section) have higher.
10897 @cindex subtraction
10898 Addition and subtraction. Both arguments are converted to integers;
10899 an error occurs if this cannot be done.
10905 @cindex multiplication
10908 Multiplication, division, remainder. Both arguments are converted to
10909 integers; an error occurs if this cannot be done.
10914 @node Relations for expr
10915 @subsection Relations for @command{expr}
10917 @cindex connectives, logical
10918 @cindex logical connectives
10919 @cindex relations, numeric or string
10921 @command{expr} supports the usual logical connectives and relations. These
10922 are higher precedence than either the string or numeric operators
10923 (previous sections). Here is the list, lowest-precedence operator first.
10929 @cindex logical or operator
10930 @cindex or operator
10931 Returns its first argument if that is neither null nor zero, otherwise
10932 its second argument if it is neither null nor zero, otherwise 0. It
10933 does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is neither
10938 @cindex logical and operator
10939 @cindex and operator
10940 Return its first argument if neither argument is null or zero, otherwise
10941 0. It does not evaluate its second argument if its first argument is
10944 @item < <= = == != >= >
10951 @cindex comparison operators
10953 Compare the arguments and return 1 if the relation is true, 0 otherwise.
10954 @code{==} is a synonym for @code{=}. @command{expr} first tries to convert
10955 both arguments to integers and do a numeric comparison; if either
10956 conversion fails, it does a lexicographic comparison using the character
10957 collating sequence specified by the @env{LC_COLLATE} locale.
10962 @node Examples of expr
10963 @subsection Examples of using @command{expr}
10965 @cindex examples of @command{expr}
10966 Here are a few examples, including quoting for shell metacharacters.
10968 To add 1 to the shell variable @code{foo}, in Bourne-compatible shells:
10971 foo=`expr $foo + 1`
10974 To print the non-directory part of the file name stored in
10975 @code{$fname}, which need not contain a @code{/}:
10978 expr $fname : '.*/\(.*\)' '|' $fname
10981 An example showing that @code{\+} is an operator:
10989 expr abc : 'a\(.\)c'
10991 expr index abcdef cz
10994 @error{} expr: syntax error
10995 expr index quote index a
11001 @chapter Redirection
11003 @cindex redirection
11004 @cindex commands for redirection
11006 Unix shells commonly provide several forms of @dfn{redirection}---ways
11007 to change the input source or output destination of a command. But one
11008 useful redirection is performed by a separate command, not by the shell;
11009 it's described here.
11012 * tee invocation:: Redirect output to multiple files.
11016 @node tee invocation
11017 @section @command{tee}: Redirect output to multiple files
11020 @cindex pipe fitting
11021 @cindex destinations, multiple output
11022 @cindex read from stdin and write to stdout and files
11024 The @command{tee} command copies standard input to standard output and also
11025 to any files given as arguments. This is useful when you want not only
11026 to send some data down a pipe, but also to save a copy. Synopsis:
11029 tee [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{file}]@dots{}
11032 If a file being written to does not already exist, it is created. If a
11033 file being written to already exists, the data it previously contained
11034 is overwritten unless the @option{-a} option is used.
11036 A @var{file} of @samp{-} causes @command{tee} to send another copy of
11037 input to standard output, but this is typically not that useful as the
11038 copies are interleaved.
11040 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11047 Append standard input to the given files rather than overwriting
11051 @itemx --ignore-interrupts
11053 @opindex --ignore-interrupts
11054 Ignore interrupt signals.
11061 @node File name manipulation
11062 @chapter File name manipulation
11064 @cindex file name manipulation
11065 @cindex manipulation of file names
11066 @cindex commands for file name manipulation
11068 This section describes commands that manipulate file names.
11071 * basename invocation:: Strip directory and suffix from a file name.
11072 * dirname invocation:: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name.
11073 * pathchk invocation:: Check file name portability.
11077 @node basename invocation
11078 @section @command{basename}: Strip directory and suffix from a file name
11081 @cindex strip directory and suffix from file names
11082 @cindex directory, stripping from file names
11083 @cindex suffix, stripping from file names
11084 @cindex file names, stripping directory and suffix
11085 @cindex leading directory components, stripping
11087 @command{basename} removes any leading directory components from
11088 @var{name}. Synopsis:
11091 basename @var{name} [@var{suffix}]
11094 If @var{suffix} is specified and is identical to the end of @var{name},
11095 it is removed from @var{name} as well. Note that since trailing slashes
11096 are removed prior to suffix matching, @var{suffix} will do nothing if it
11097 contains slashes. @command{basename} prints the result on standard
11100 @c This test is used both here and in the section on dirname.
11101 @macro basenameAndDirname
11102 Together, @command{basename} and @command{dirname} are designed such
11103 that if @samp{ls "$name"} succeeds, then the command sequence @samp{cd
11104 "$(dirname "$name")"; ls "$(basename "$name")"} will, too. This works
11105 for everything except file names containing a trailing newline.
11107 @basenameAndDirname
11109 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11110 @var{name} is empty or @samp{//}. In the former case, @acronym{GNU}
11111 @command{basename} returns the empty string. In the latter case, the
11112 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11113 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11115 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11116 options}. Options must precede operands.
11124 basename /usr/bin/sort
11127 basename include/stdio.h .h
11131 @node dirname invocation
11132 @section @command{dirname}: Strip non-directory suffix from a file name
11135 @cindex directory components, printing
11136 @cindex stripping non-directory suffix
11137 @cindex non-directory suffix, stripping
11139 @command{dirname} prints all but the final slash-delimited component of
11140 a string (presumably a file name). Synopsis:
11146 If @var{name} is a single component, @command{dirname} prints @samp{.}
11147 (meaning the current directory).
11149 @basenameAndDirname
11151 @acronym{POSIX} allows the implementation to define the results if
11152 @var{name} is @samp{//}. With @acronym{GNU} @command{dirname}, the
11153 result is @samp{//} on platforms where @var{//} is distinct from
11154 @var{/}, and @samp{/} on platforms where there is no difference.
11156 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
11164 # Output "/usr/bin".
11165 dirname /usr/bin/sort
11172 @node pathchk invocation
11173 @section @command{pathchk}: Check file name portability
11176 @cindex file names, checking validity and portability
11177 @cindex valid file names, checking for
11178 @cindex portable file names, checking for
11180 @command{pathchk} checks portability of file names. Synopsis:
11183 pathchk [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{name}@dots{}
11186 For each @var{name}, @command{pathchk} prints a message if any of
11187 these conditions is true:
11191 One of the existing directories in @var{name} does not have search
11192 (execute) permission,
11194 The length of @var{name} is larger than the maximum supported by the
11197 The length of one component of @var{name} is longer than
11198 its file system's maximum.
11201 A nonexistent @var{name} is not an error, so long a file with that
11202 name could be created under the above conditions.
11204 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11205 Options must precede operands.
11211 Instead of performing checks based on the underlying file system,
11212 print a message if any of these conditions is true:
11216 A file name is empty.
11219 The length of a file name or one of its components exceeds the
11220 @acronym{POSIX} minimum limits for portability.
11223 A file name contains a character outside the portable file name
11224 character set, namely, the ASCII letters and digits, @samp{-},
11225 @samp{.}, @samp{/}, and @samp{_}.
11230 Print a message if a file name is empty, or if it contains a component
11231 that begins with @samp{-}.
11233 @item --portability
11234 @opindex --portability
11235 Print a message if a file name is not portable to all @acronym{POSIX}
11236 hosts. This option is equivalent to @samp{-p -P}.
11240 @cindex exit status of @command{pathchk}
11244 0 if all specified file names passed all checks,
11249 @node Working context
11250 @chapter Working context
11252 @cindex working context
11253 @cindex commands for printing the working context
11255 This section describes commands that display or alter the context in
11256 which you are working: the current directory, the terminal settings, and
11257 so forth. See also the user-related commands in the next section.
11260 * pwd invocation:: Print working directory.
11261 * stty invocation:: Print or change terminal characteristics.
11262 * printenv invocation:: Print environment variables.
11263 * tty invocation:: Print file name of terminal on standard input.
11267 @node pwd invocation
11268 @section @command{pwd}: Print working directory
11271 @cindex print name of current directory
11272 @cindex current working directory, printing
11273 @cindex working directory, printing
11275 @cindex symbolic links and @command{pwd}
11276 @command{pwd} prints the fully resolved name of the current directory.
11277 That is, all components of the printed name will be actual directory
11278 names---none will be symbolic links.
11280 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
11281 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
11282 Because most shells have a built-in @command{pwd} command, using an
11283 unadorned @command{pwd} in a script or interactively may get you
11284 different functionality than that described here.
11286 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or
11287 @option{--version}. @xref{Common options}.
11292 @node stty invocation
11293 @section @command{stty}: Print or change terminal characteristics
11296 @cindex change or print terminal settings
11297 @cindex terminal settings
11298 @cindex line settings of terminal
11300 @command{stty} prints or changes terminal characteristics, such as baud rate.
11304 stty [@var{option}] [@var{setting}]@dots{}
11305 stty [@var{option}]
11308 If given no line settings, @command{stty} prints the baud rate, line
11309 discipline number (on systems that support it), and line settings
11310 that have been changed from the values set by @samp{stty sane}.
11311 By default, mode reading and setting are performed on the tty line
11312 connected to standard input, although this can be modified by the
11313 @option{--file} option.
11315 @command{stty} accepts many non-option arguments that change aspects of
11316 the terminal line operation, as described below.
11318 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
11325 Print all current settings in human-readable form. This option may not
11326 be used in combination with any line settings.
11328 @item -F @var{device}
11329 @itemx --file=@var{device}
11332 Set the line opened by the file name specified in @var{device} instead of
11333 the tty line connected to standard input. This option is necessary
11334 because opening a @acronym{POSIX} tty requires use of the @code{O_NONDELAY} flag to
11335 prevent a @acronym{POSIX} tty from blocking until the carrier detect line is high if
11336 the @code{clocal} flag is not set. Hence, it is not always possible
11337 to allow the shell to open the device in the traditional manner.
11343 @cindex machine-readable @command{stty} output
11344 Print all current settings in a form that can be used as an argument to
11345 another @command{stty} command to restore the current settings. This option
11346 may not be used in combination with any line settings.
11350 Many settings can be turned off by preceding them with a @samp{-}.
11351 Such arguments are marked below with ``May be negated'' in their
11352 description. The descriptions themselves refer to the positive
11353 case, that is, when @emph{not} negated (unless stated otherwise,
11356 Some settings are not available on all @acronym{POSIX} systems, since they use
11357 extensions. Such arguments are marked below with ``Non-@acronym{POSIX}'' in their
11358 description. On non-@acronym{POSIX} systems, those or other settings also may not
11359 be available, but it's not feasible to document all the variations: just
11365 * Control:: Control settings
11366 * Input:: Input settings
11367 * Output:: Output settings
11368 * Local:: Local settings
11369 * Combination:: Combination settings
11370 * Characters:: Special characters
11371 * Special:: Special settings
11376 @subsection Control settings
11378 @cindex control settings
11384 @cindex two-way parity
11385 Generate parity bit in output and expect parity bit in input.
11391 @cindex even parity
11392 Set odd parity (even if negated). May be negated.
11399 @cindex character size
11400 @cindex eight-bit characters
11401 Set character size to 5, 6, 7, or 8 bits.
11406 Send a hangup signal when the last process closes the tty. May be
11412 Use two stop bits per character (one if negated). May be negated.
11416 Allow input to be received. May be negated.
11420 @cindex modem control
11421 Disable modem control signals. May be negated.
11425 @cindex hardware flow control
11426 @cindex flow control, hardware
11427 @cindex RTS/CTS flow control
11428 Enable RTS/CTS flow control. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11433 @subsection Input settings
11435 @cindex input settings
11440 @cindex breaks, ignoring
11441 Ignore break characters. May be negated.
11445 @cindex breaks, cause interrupts
11446 Make breaks cause an interrupt signal. May be negated.
11450 @cindex parity, ignoring
11451 Ignore characters with parity errors. May be negated.
11455 @cindex parity errors, marking
11456 Mark parity errors (with a 255-0-character sequence). May be negated.
11460 Enable input parity checking. May be negated.
11464 @cindex eight-bit input
11465 Clear high (8th) bit of input characters. May be negated.
11469 @cindex newline, translating to return
11470 Translate newline to carriage return. May be negated.
11474 @cindex return, ignoring
11475 Ignore carriage return. May be negated.
11479 @cindex return, translating to newline
11480 Translate carriage return to newline. May be negated.
11484 @cindex input encoding, UTF-8
11485 Assume input characters are UTF-8 encoded. May be negated.
11489 @kindex C-s/C-q flow control
11490 @cindex XON/XOFF flow control
11491 Enable XON/XOFF flow control (that is, @kbd{CTRL-S}/@kbd{CTRL-Q}). May
11498 @cindex software flow control
11499 @cindex flow control, software
11500 Enable sending of @code{stop} character when the system input buffer
11501 is almost full, and @code{start} character when it becomes almost
11502 empty again. May be negated.
11506 @cindex uppercase, translating to lowercase
11507 Translate uppercase characters to lowercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11512 Allow any character to restart output (only the start character
11513 if negated). Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11517 @cindex beeping at input buffer full
11518 Enable beeping and not flushing input buffer if a character arrives
11519 when the input buffer is full. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11524 @subsection Output settings
11526 @cindex output settings
11527 These arguments specify output-related operations.
11532 Postprocess output. May be negated.
11536 @cindex lowercase, translating to output
11537 Translate lowercase characters to uppercase. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11542 @cindex return, translating to newline
11543 Translate carriage return to newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11547 @cindex newline, translating to crlf
11548 Translate newline to carriage return-newline. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be
11553 Do not print carriage returns in the first column. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11558 Newline performs a carriage return. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11562 @cindex pad instead of timing for delaying
11563 Use fill (padding) characters instead of timing for delays. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11568 @cindex pad character
11569 Use delete characters for fill instead of null characters. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11575 Newline delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11582 Carriage return delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11588 @opindex tab@var{n}
11589 Horizontal tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11594 Backspace delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11599 Vertical tab delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11604 Form feed delay style. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11609 @subsection Local settings
11611 @cindex local settings
11616 Enable @code{interrupt}, @code{quit}, and @code{suspend} special
11617 characters. May be negated.
11621 Enable @code{erase}, @code{kill}, @code{werase}, and @code{rprnt}
11622 special characters. May be negated.
11626 Enable non-@acronym{POSIX} special characters. May be negated.
11630 Echo input characters. May be negated.
11636 Echo @code{erase} characters as backspace-space-backspace. May be
11641 @cindex newline echoing after @code{kill}
11642 Echo a newline after a @code{kill} character. May be negated.
11646 @cindex newline, echoing
11647 Echo newline even if not echoing other characters. May be negated.
11651 @cindex flushing, disabling
11652 Disable flushing after @code{interrupt} and @code{quit} special
11653 characters. May be negated.
11657 @cindex case translation
11658 Enable input and output of uppercase characters by preceding their
11659 lowercase equivalents with @samp{\}, when @code{icanon} is set.
11660 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11664 @cindex background jobs, stopping at terminal write
11665 Stop background jobs that try to write to the terminal. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11672 Echo erased characters backward, between @samp{\} and @samp{/}.
11673 Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11679 @cindex control characters, using @samp{^@var{c}}
11680 @cindex hat notation for control characters
11681 Echo control characters in hat notation (@samp{^@var{c}}) instead
11682 of literally. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11688 Echo the @code{kill} special character by erasing each character on
11689 the line as indicated by the @code{echoprt} and @code{echoe} settings,
11690 instead of by the @code{echoctl} and @code{echok} settings. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11696 @subsection Combination settings
11698 @cindex combination settings
11699 Combination settings:
11706 Same as @code{parenb -parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
11707 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
11711 Same as @code{parenb parodd cs7}. May be negated. If negated, same
11712 as @code{-parenb cs8}.
11716 Same as @code{-icrnl -onlcr}. May be negated. If negated, same as
11717 @code{icrnl -inlcr -igncr onlcr -ocrnl -onlret}.
11721 Reset the @code{erase} and @code{kill} special characters to their default
11728 @c This is too long to write inline.
11730 cread -ignbrk brkint -inlcr -igncr icrnl -ixoff
11731 -iuclc -ixany imaxbel opost -olcuc -ocrnl onlcr
11732 -onocr -onlret -ofill -ofdel nl0 cr0 tab0 bs0 vt0
11733 ff0 isig icanon iexten echo echoe echok -echonl
11734 -noflsh -xcase -tostop -echoprt echoctl echoke
11738 and also sets all special characters to their default values.
11742 Same as @code{brkint ignpar istrip icrnl ixon opost isig icanon}, plus
11743 sets the @code{eof} and @code{eol} characters to their default values
11744 if they are the same as the @code{min} and @code{time} characters.
11745 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{raw}.
11752 -ignbrk -brkint -ignpar -parmrk -inpck -istrip
11753 -inlcr -igncr -icrnl -ixon -ixoff -iuclc -ixany
11754 -imaxbel -opost -isig -icanon -xcase min 1 time 0
11758 May be negated. If negated, same as @code{cooked}.
11762 Same as @option{-icanon}. May be negated. If negated, same as
11767 @cindex eight-bit characters
11768 Same as @code{-parenb -istrip cs8}. May be negated. If negated,
11769 same as @code{parenb istrip cs7}.
11773 Same as @option{-parenb -istrip -opost cs8}. May be negated.
11774 If negated, same as @code{parenb istrip opost cs7}.
11778 Same as @option{-ixany}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11782 Same as @code{tab0}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated. If negated, same
11789 Same as @code{xcase iuclc olcuc}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}. May be negated.
11793 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke}.
11797 Same as @code{echoe echoctl echoke -ixany intr ^C erase ^? kill C-u}.
11802 @subsection Special characters
11804 @cindex special characters
11805 @cindex characters, special
11807 The special characters' default values vary from system to system.
11808 They are set with the syntax @samp{name value}, where the names are
11809 listed below and the value can be given either literally, in hat
11810 notation (@samp{^@var{c}}), or as an integer which may start with
11811 @samp{0x} to indicate hexadecimal, @samp{0} to indicate octal, or
11812 any other digit to indicate decimal.
11814 @cindex disabling special characters
11815 @kindex u@r{, and disabling special characters}
11816 For GNU stty, giving a value of @code{^-} or @code{undef} disables that
11817 special character. (This is incompatible with Ultrix @command{stty},
11818 which uses a value of @samp{u} to disable a special character. GNU
11819 @command{stty} treats a value @samp{u} like any other, namely to set that
11820 special character to @key{U}.)
11826 Send an interrupt signal.
11830 Send a quit signal.
11834 Erase the last character typed.
11838 Erase the current line.
11842 Send an end of file (terminate the input).
11850 Alternate character to end the line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11854 Switch to a different shell layer. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11858 Restart the output after stopping it.
11866 Send a terminal stop signal.
11870 Send a terminal stop signal after flushing the input. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11874 Redraw the current line. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11878 Erase the last word typed. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11882 Enter the next character typed literally, even if it is a special
11883 character. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11888 @subsection Special settings
11890 @cindex special settings
11895 Set the minimum number of characters that will satisfy a read until
11896 the time value has expired, when @option{-icanon} is set.
11900 Set the number of tenths of a second before reads time out if the minimum
11901 number of characters have not been read, when @option{-icanon} is set.
11903 @item ispeed @var{n}
11905 Set the input speed to @var{n}.
11907 @item ospeed @var{n}
11909 Set the output speed to @var{n}.
11913 Tell the tty kernel driver that the terminal has @var{n} rows. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11916 @itemx columns @var{n}
11919 Tell the kernel that the terminal has @var{n} columns. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11925 Print the number of rows and columns that the kernel thinks the
11926 terminal has. (Systems that don't support rows and columns in the kernel
11927 typically use the environment variables @env{LINES} and @env{COLUMNS}
11928 instead; however, GNU @command{stty} does not know anything about them.)
11929 Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11933 Use line discipline @var{n}. Non-@acronym{POSIX}.
11937 Print the terminal speed.
11940 @cindex baud rate, setting
11941 @c FIXME: Is this still true that the baud rate can't be set
11942 @c higher than 38400?
11943 Set the input and output speeds to @var{n}. @var{n} can be one
11944 of: 0 50 75 110 134 134.5 150 200 300 600 1200 1800 2400 4800 9600
11945 19200 38400 @code{exta} @code{extb}. @code{exta} is the same as
11946 19200; @code{extb} is the same as 38400. 0 hangs up the line if
11947 @option{-clocal} is set.
11951 @node printenv invocation
11952 @section @command{printenv}: Print all or some environment variables
11955 @cindex printing all or some environment variables
11956 @cindex environment variables, printing
11958 @command{printenv} prints environment variable values. Synopsis:
11961 printenv [@var{option}] [@var{variable}]@dots{}
11964 If no @var{variable}s are specified, @command{printenv} prints the value of
11965 every environment variable. Otherwise, it prints the value of each
11966 @var{variable} that is set, and nothing for those that are not set.
11968 The only options are a lone @option{--help} or @option{--version}.
11969 @xref{Common options}.
11971 @cindex exit status of @command{printenv}
11975 0 if all variables specified were found
11976 1 if at least one specified variable was not found
11977 2 if a write error occurred
11981 @node tty invocation
11982 @section @command{tty}: Print file name of terminal on standard input
11985 @cindex print terminal file name
11986 @cindex terminal file name, printing
11988 @command{tty} prints the file name of the terminal connected to its standard
11989 input. It prints @samp{not a tty} if standard input is not a terminal.
11993 tty [@var{option}]@dots{}
11996 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12006 Print nothing; only return an exit status.
12010 @cindex exit status of @command{tty}
12014 0 if standard input is a terminal
12015 1 if standard input is not a terminal
12016 2 if given incorrect arguments
12017 3 if a write error occurs
12021 @node User information
12022 @chapter User information
12024 @cindex user information, commands for
12025 @cindex commands for printing user information
12027 This section describes commands that print user-related information:
12028 logins, groups, and so forth.
12031 * id invocation:: Print user identity.
12032 * logname invocation:: Print current login name.
12033 * whoami invocation:: Print effective user ID.
12034 * groups invocation:: Print group names a user is in.
12035 * users invocation:: Print login names of users currently logged in.
12036 * who invocation:: Print who is currently logged in.
12040 @node id invocation
12041 @section @command{id}: Print user identity
12044 @cindex real user and group IDs, printing
12045 @cindex effective user and group IDs, printing
12046 @cindex printing real and effective user and group IDs
12048 @command{id} prints information about the given user, or the process
12049 running it if no user is specified. Synopsis:
12052 id [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{username}]
12055 By default, it prints the real user ID, real group ID, effective user ID
12056 if different from the real user ID, effective group ID if different from
12057 the real group ID, and supplemental group IDs.
12059 Each of these numeric values is preceded by an identifying string and
12060 followed by the corresponding user or group name in parentheses.
12062 The options cause @command{id} to print only part of the above information.
12063 Also see @ref{Common options}.
12070 Print only the group ID.
12076 Print only the group ID and the supplementary groups.
12082 Print the user or group name instead of the ID number. Requires
12083 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12089 Print the real, instead of effective, user or group ID. Requires
12090 @option{-u}, @option{-g}, or @option{-G}.
12096 Print only the user ID.
12103 @node logname invocation
12104 @section @command{logname}: Print current login name
12107 @cindex printing user's login name
12108 @cindex login name, printing
12109 @cindex user name, printing
12112 @command{logname} prints the calling user's name, as found in a
12113 system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12114 @file{/etc/utmp}), and exits with a status of 0. If there is no entry
12115 for the calling process, @command{logname} prints
12116 an error message and exits with a status of 1.
12118 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12124 @node whoami invocation
12125 @section @command{whoami}: Print effective user ID
12128 @cindex effective user ID, printing
12129 @cindex printing the effective user ID
12131 @command{whoami} prints the user name associated with the current
12132 effective user ID. It is equivalent to the command @samp{id -un}.
12134 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12140 @node groups invocation
12141 @section @command{groups}: Print group names a user is in
12144 @cindex printing groups a user is in
12145 @cindex supplementary groups, printing
12147 @command{groups} prints the names of the primary and any supplementary
12148 groups for each given @var{username}, or the current process if no names
12149 are given. If more than one name is given, the name of each user is
12151 the list of that user's groups. Synopsis:
12154 groups [@var{username}]@dots{}
12157 The group lists are equivalent to the output of the command @samp{id -Gn}.
12159 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12165 @node users invocation
12166 @section @command{users}: Print login names of users currently logged in
12169 @cindex printing current usernames
12170 @cindex usernames, printing current
12172 @cindex login sessions, printing users with
12173 @command{users} prints on a single line a blank-separated list of user
12174 names of users currently logged in to the current host. Each user name
12175 corresponds to a login session, so if a user has more than one login
12176 session, that user's name will appear the same number of times in the
12185 With no @var{file} argument, @command{users} extracts its information from
12186 a system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12187 @file{/etc/utmp}). If a file argument is given, @command{users} uses
12188 that file instead. A common choice is @file{/var/log/wtmp}.
12190 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
12196 @node who invocation
12197 @section @command{who}: Print who is currently logged in
12200 @cindex printing current user information
12201 @cindex information, about current users
12203 @command{who} prints information about users who are currently logged on.
12207 @command{who} [@var{option}] [@var{file}] [am i]
12210 @cindex terminal lines, currently used
12212 @cindex remote hostname
12213 If given no non-option arguments, @command{who} prints the following
12214 information for each user currently logged on: login name, terminal
12215 line, login time, and remote hostname or X display.
12219 If given one non-option argument, @command{who} uses that instead of
12220 a default system-maintained file (often @file{/var/run/utmp} or
12221 @file{/etc/utmp}) as the name of the file containing the record of
12222 users logged on. @file{/var/log/wtmp} is commonly given as an argument
12223 to @command{who} to look at who has previously logged on.
12227 If given two non-option arguments, @command{who} prints only the entry
12228 for the user running it (determined from its standard input), preceded
12229 by the hostname. Traditionally, the two arguments given are @samp{am
12230 i}, as in @samp{who am i}.
12233 Time stamps are listed according to the time zone rules specified by
12234 the @env{TZ} environment variable, or by the system default rules if
12235 @env{TZ} is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone
12236 with @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
12238 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12246 Same as @samp{-b -d --login -p -r -t -T -u}.
12252 Print the date and time of last system boot.
12258 Print information corresponding to dead processes.
12264 Print column headings.
12268 Same as @samp{who am i}.
12274 Print only the login names and the number of users logged on.
12275 Overrides all other options.
12279 Ignored; for compatibility with other versions of @command{who}.
12284 After the login time, print the number of hours and minutes that the
12285 user has been idle. @samp{.} means the user was active in the last minute.
12286 @samp{old} means the user has been idle for more than 24 hours.
12292 List only the entries that correspond to processes via which the
12293 system is waiting for a user to login. The user name is always @samp{LOGIN}.
12297 Attempt to canonicalize hostnames found in utmp through a DNS lookup. This
12298 is not the default because it can cause significant delays on systems with
12299 automatic dial-up internet access.
12305 Print a line of column headings.
12316 @opindex --writable
12317 @cindex message status
12318 @pindex write@r{, allowed}
12319 After each login name print a character indicating the user's message status:
12322 @samp{+} allowing @code{write} messages
12323 @samp{-} disallowing @code{write} messages
12324 @samp{?} cannot find terminal device
12332 @node System context
12333 @chapter System context
12335 @cindex system context
12336 @cindex context, system
12337 @cindex commands for system context
12339 This section describes commands that print or change system-wide
12343 * date invocation:: Print or set system date and time.
12344 * uname invocation:: Print system information.
12345 * hostname invocation:: Print or set system name.
12346 * hostid invocation:: Print numeric host identifier.
12350 @node date invocation
12351 @section @command{date}: Print or set system date and time
12354 @cindex time, printing or setting
12355 @cindex printing the current time
12360 date [@var{option}]@dots{} [+@var{format}]
12361 date [-u|--utc|--universal] @c this avoids a newline in the output
12362 [ MMDDhhmm[[CC]YY][.ss] ]
12366 Invoking @command{date} with no @var{format} argument is equivalent to invoking
12367 it with a default format that depends on the @env{LC_TIME} locale category.
12368 In the default C locale, this format is @samp{'+%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y'},
12369 so the output looks like @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 13:47:51 PST 2005}.
12372 Normally, @command{date} uses the time zone rules indicated by the
12373 @env{TZ} environment variable, or the system default rules if @env{TZ}
12374 is not set. @xref{TZ Variable,, Specifying the Time Zone with
12375 @env{TZ}, libc, The GNU C Library}.
12377 @findex strftime @r{and @command{date}}
12378 @cindex time formats
12379 @cindex formatting times
12380 If given an argument that starts with a @samp{+}, @command{date} prints the
12381 current date and time (or the date and time specified by the
12382 @option{--date} option, see below) in the format defined by that argument,
12383 which is similar to that of the @code{strftime} function. Except for
12384 conversion specifiers, which start with @samp{%}, characters in the
12385 format string are printed unchanged. The conversion specifiers are
12391 * Time conversion specifiers:: %[HIklMNpPrRsSTXzZ]
12392 * Date conversion specifiers:: %[aAbBcCdDeFgGhjmuUVwWxyY]
12393 * Literal conversion specifiers:: %[%nt]
12394 * Padding and other flags:: Pad with zeros, spaces, etc.
12395 * Setting the time:: Changing the system clock.
12396 * Options for date:: Instead of the current time.
12397 * Examples of date:: Examples.
12400 @node Time conversion specifiers
12401 @subsection Time conversion specifiers
12403 @cindex time conversion specifiers
12404 @cindex conversion specifiers, time
12406 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to times.
12410 hour (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{23})
12412 hour (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12414 hour (@samp{ 0}@dots{}@samp{23}).
12415 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12417 hour (@samp{ 1}@dots{}@samp{12}).
12418 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12420 minute (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{59})
12422 nanoseconds (@samp{000000000}@dots{}@samp{999999999}).
12423 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12425 locale's equivalent of either @samp{AM} or @samp{PM};
12426 blank in many locales.
12427 Noon is treated as @samp{PM} and midnight as @samp{AM}.
12429 like @samp{%p}, except lower case.
12430 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12432 locale's 12-hour clock time (e.g., @samp{11:11:04 PM})
12434 24-hour hour and minute. Same as @samp{%H:%M}.
12435 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12437 @cindex epoch, seconds since
12438 @cindex seconds since the epoch
12439 @cindex beginning of time
12440 seconds since the epoch, i.e., since 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC.
12441 Leap seconds are not counted unless leap second support is available.
12442 @xref{%s-examples}, for examples.
12443 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12445 second (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{60}).
12446 This may be @samp{60} if leap seconds are supported.
12448 24-hour hour, minute, and second. Same as @samp{%H:%M:%S}.
12450 locale's time representation (e.g., @samp{23:13:48})
12452 @w{@acronym{RFC} 2822/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone
12453 (e.g., @samp{-0600} or @samp{+0530}), or nothing if no
12454 time zone is determinable. This value reflects the numeric time zone
12455 appropriate for the current time, using the time zone rules specified
12456 by the @env{TZ} environment variable.
12457 The time (and optionally, the time zone rules) can be overridden
12458 by the @option{--date} option.
12459 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12461 @w{@acronym{RFC} 3339/@acronym{ISO} 8601} style numeric time zone with
12462 @samp{:} (e.g., @samp{-06:00} or @samp{+05:30}), or nothing if no time
12463 zone is determinable.
12464 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12466 Numeric time zone to the nearest second with @samp{:} (e.g.,
12467 @samp{-06:00:00} or @samp{+05:30:00}), or nothing if no time zone is
12469 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12471 Numeric time zone with @samp{:} using the minimum necessary precision
12472 (e.g., @samp{-06}, @samp{+05:30}, or @samp{-04:56:02}), or nothing if
12473 no time zone is determinable.
12474 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12476 alphabetic time zone abbreviation (e.g., @samp{EDT}), or nothing if no
12477 time zone is determinable. See @samp{%z} for how it is determined.
12481 @node Date conversion specifiers
12482 @subsection Date conversion specifiers
12484 @cindex date conversion specifiers
12485 @cindex conversion specifiers, date
12487 @command{date} conversion specifiers related to dates.
12491 locale's abbreviated weekday name (e.g., @samp{Sun})
12493 locale's full weekday name, variable length (e.g., @samp{Sunday})
12495 locale's abbreviated month name (e.g., @samp{Jan})
12497 locale's full month name, variable length (e.g., @samp{January})
12499 locale's date and time (e.g., @samp{Thu Mar @ 3 23:05:25 2005})
12501 century. This is like @samp{%Y}, except the last two digits are omitted.
12502 For example, it is @samp{20} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{2000},
12503 and is @samp{-0} if @samp{%Y} is @samp{-001}.
12504 It is normally at least two characters, but it may be more.
12506 day of month (e.g., @samp{01})
12508 date; same as @samp{%m/%d/%y}
12510 day of month, space padded; same as @samp{%_d}
12512 full date in @acronym{ISO} 8601 format; same as @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
12513 This is a good choice for a date format, as it is standard and
12514 is easy to sort in the usual case where years are in the range
12516 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12518 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number, but without the century
12519 (range @samp{00} through @samp{99}). This has the same format and value
12520 as @samp{%y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO} week number (see
12522 to the previous or next year, that year is used instead.
12523 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12525 year corresponding to the @acronym{ISO} week number. This has the
12526 same format and value as @samp{%Y}, except that if the @acronym{ISO}
12528 @samp{%V}) belongs to the previous or next year, that year is used
12530 It is normally useful only if @samp{%V} is also used;
12531 for example, the format @samp{%G-%m-%d} is probably a mistake,
12532 since it combines the ISO week number year with the conventional month and day.
12533 This is a @acronym{GNU} extension.
12537 day of year (@samp{001}@dots{}@samp{366})
12539 month (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{12})
12541 day of week (@samp{1}@dots{}@samp{7}) with @samp{1} corresponding to Monday
12543 week number of year, with Sunday as the first day of the week
12544 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12545 Days in a new year preceding the first Sunday are in week zero.
12547 @acronym{ISO} week number, that is, the
12548 week number of year, with Monday as the first day of the week
12549 (@samp{01}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12550 If the week containing January 1 has four or more days in
12551 the new year, then it is considered week 1; otherwise, it is week 53 of
12552 the previous year, and the next week is week 1. (See the @acronym{ISO} 8601
12555 day of week (@samp{0}@dots{}@samp{6}) with 0 corresponding to Sunday
12557 week number of year, with Monday as first day of week
12558 (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{53}).
12559 Days in a new year preceding the first Monday are in week zero.
12561 locale's date representation (e.g., @samp{12/31/99})
12563 last two digits of year (@samp{00}@dots{}@samp{99})
12565 year. This is normally at least four characters, but it may be more.
12566 Year @samp{0000} precedes year @samp{0001}, and year @samp{-001}
12567 precedes year @samp{0000}.
12571 @node Literal conversion specifiers
12572 @subsection Literal conversion specifiers
12574 @cindex literal conversion specifiers
12575 @cindex conversion specifiers, literal
12577 @command{date} conversion specifiers that produce literal strings.
12589 @node Padding and other flags
12590 @subsection Padding and other flags
12592 @cindex numeric field padding
12593 @cindex padding of numeric fields
12594 @cindex fields, padding numeric
12596 Unless otherwise specified, @command{date} normally pads numeric fields
12597 with zeros, so that, for
12598 example, numeric months are always output as two digits.
12599 Seconds since the epoch are not padded, though,
12600 since there is no natural width for them.
12602 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, @command{date} recognizes any of the
12603 following optional flags after the @samp{%}:
12607 (hyphen) Do not pad the field; useful if the output is intended for
12610 (underscore) Pad with spaces; useful if you need a fixed
12611 number of characters in the output, but zeros are too distracting.
12613 (zero) Pad with zeros even if the conversion specifier
12614 would normally pad with spaces.
12616 Use upper case characters if possible.
12618 Use opposite case characters if possible.
12619 A field that is normally upper case becomes lower case, and vice versa.
12623 Here are some examples of padding:
12626 date +%d/%m -d "Feb 1"
12628 date +%-d/%-m -d "Feb 1"
12630 date +%_d/%_m -d "Feb 1"
12634 As a @acronym{GNU} extension, you can specify the field width
12635 (after any flag, if present) as a decimal number. If the natural size of the
12636 output is of the field has less than the specified number of characters,
12637 the result is written right adjusted and padded to the given
12638 size. For example, @samp{%9B} prints the right adjusted month name in
12639 a field of width 9.
12641 An optional modifier can follow the optional flag and width
12642 specification. The modifiers are:
12646 Use the locale's alternate representation for date and time. This
12647 modifier applies to the @samp{%c}, @samp{%C}, @samp{%x}, @samp{%X},
12648 @samp{%y} and @samp{%Y} conversion specifiers. In a Japanese locale, for
12649 example, @samp{%Ex} might yield a date format based on the Japanese
12653 Use the locale's alternate numeric symbols for numbers. This modifier
12654 applies only to numeric conversion specifiers.
12657 If the format supports the modifier but no alternate representation
12658 is available, it is ignored.
12661 @node Setting the time
12662 @subsection Setting the time
12664 @cindex setting the time
12665 @cindex time setting
12666 @cindex appropriate privileges
12668 If given an argument that does not start with @samp{+}, @command{date} sets
12669 the system clock to the date and time specified by that argument (as
12670 described below). You must have appropriate privileges to set the
12671 system clock. The @option{--date} and @option{--set} options may not be
12672 used with such an argument. The @option{--universal} option may be used
12673 with such an argument to indicate that the specified date and time are
12674 relative to Coordinated Universal Time rather than to the local time
12677 The argument must consist entirely of digits, which have the following
12690 first two digits of year (optional)
12692 last two digits of year (optional)
12697 The @option{--set} option also sets the system clock; see the next section.
12700 @node Options for date
12701 @subsection Options for @command{date}
12703 @cindex @command{date} options
12704 @cindex options for @command{date}
12706 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
12710 @item -d @var{datestr}
12711 @itemx --date=@var{datestr}
12714 @cindex parsing date strings
12715 @cindex date strings, parsing
12716 @cindex arbitrary date strings, parsing
12719 @opindex next @var{day}
12720 @opindex last @var{day}
12721 Display the date and time specified in @var{datestr} instead of the
12722 current date and time. @var{datestr} can be in almost any common
12723 format. It can contain month names, time zones, @samp{am} and @samp{pm},
12724 @samp{yesterday}, etc. For example, @option{--date="2004-02-27
12725 14:19:13.489392193 +0530"} specifies the instant of time that is
12726 489,392,193 nanoseconds after February 27, 2004 at 2:19:13 PM in a
12727 time zone that is 5 hours and 30 minutes east of @acronym{UTC}.
12728 @xref{Date input formats}.
12730 @item -f @var{datefile}
12731 @itemx --file=@var{datefile}
12734 Parse each line in @var{datefile} as with @option{-d} and display the
12735 resulting date and time. If @var{datefile} is @samp{-}, use standard
12736 input. This is useful when you have many dates to process, because the
12737 system overhead of starting up the @command{date} executable many times can
12740 @item -r @var{file}
12741 @itemx --reference=@var{file}
12743 @opindex --reference
12744 Display the date and time of the last modification of @var{file},
12745 instead of the current date and time.
12752 @opindex --rfc-2822
12753 Display the date and time using the format @samp{%a, %d %b %Y %H:%M:%S
12754 %z}, evaluated in the C locale so abbreviations are always in English.
12758 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
12761 This format conforms to
12762 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc2822.txt, Internet
12763 @acronym{RFCs} 2822} and
12764 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc822.txt, 822}, the
12765 current and previous standards for Internet email.
12767 @item --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
12768 @opindex --rfc-3339=@var{timespec}
12769 Display the date using a format specified by
12770 @uref{ftp://ftp.rfc-editor.org/in-notes/rfc3339.txt, Internet
12771 @acronym{RFC} 3339}. This is a subset of the @acronym{ISO} 8601
12772 format, except that it also permits applications to use a space rather
12773 than a @samp{T} to separate dates from times. Unlike the other
12774 standard formats, @acronym{RFC} 3339 format is always suitable as
12775 input for the @option{--date} (@option{-d}) and @option{--file}
12776 (@option{-f}) options, regardless of the current locale.
12778 The argument @var{timespec} specifies how much of the time to include.
12779 It can be one of the following:
12783 Print just the full-date, e.g., @samp{2005-09-14}.
12784 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d}.
12787 Print the full-date and full-time separated by a space, e.g.,
12788 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06+05:30}. The output ends with a numeric
12789 time-offset; here the @samp{+05:30} means that local time is five
12790 hours and thirty minutes east of @acronym{UTC}. This is equivalent to
12791 the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S%:z}.
12794 Like @samp{seconds}, but also print nanoseconds, e.g.,
12795 @samp{2005-09-14 00:56:06.998458565+05:30}.
12796 This is equivalent to the format @samp{%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S.%N%:z}.
12800 @item -s @var{datestr}
12801 @itemx --set=@var{datestr}
12804 Set the date and time to @var{datestr}. See @option{-d} above.
12811 @opindex --universal
12812 @cindex Coordinated Universal Time
12814 @cindex Greenwich Mean Time
12817 Use Coordinated Universal Time (@acronym{UTC}) by operating as if the
12818 @env{TZ} environment variable were set to the string @samp{UTC0}.
12820 Universal Time is often called ``Greenwich Mean Time'' (@sc{gmt}) for
12821 historical reasons.
12825 @node Examples of date
12826 @subsection Examples of @command{date}
12828 @cindex examples of @command{date}
12830 Here are a few examples. Also see the documentation for the @option{-d}
12831 option in the previous section.
12836 To print the date of the day before yesterday:
12839 date --date='2 days ago'
12843 To print the date of the day three months and one day hence:
12846 date --date='3 months 1 day'
12850 To print the day of year of Christmas in the current year:
12853 date --date='25 Dec' +%j
12857 To print the current full month name and the day of the month:
12863 But this may not be what you want because for the first nine days of
12864 the month, the @samp{%d} expands to a zero-padded two-digit field,
12865 for example @samp{date -d 1may '+%B %d'} will print @samp{May 01}.
12868 To print a date without the leading zero for one-digit days
12869 of the month, you can use the (@acronym{GNU} extension)
12870 @samp{-} flag to suppress
12871 the padding altogether:
12874 date -d 1may '+%B %-d
12878 To print the current date and time in the format required by many
12879 non-@acronym{GNU} versions of @command{date} when setting the system clock:
12882 date +%m%d%H%M%Y.%S
12886 To set the system clock forward by two minutes:
12889 date --set='+2 minutes'
12893 To print the date in @acronym{RFC} 2822 format,
12894 use @samp{date --rfc-2822}. Here is some example output:
12897 Fri, 09 Sep 2005 13:51:39 -0700
12900 @anchor{%s-examples}
12902 To convert a date string to the number of seconds since the epoch
12903 (which is 1970-01-01 00:00:00 UTC), use the @option{--date} option with
12904 the @samp{%s} format. That can be useful in sorting and/or graphing
12905 and/or comparing data by date. The following command outputs the
12906 number of the seconds since the epoch for the time two minutes after the
12910 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00 +0000' +%s
12914 If you do not specify time zone information in the date string,
12915 @command{date} uses your computer's idea of the time zone when
12916 interpreting the string. For example, if your computer's time zone is
12917 that of Cambridge, Massachusetts, which was then 5 hours (i.e., 18,000
12918 seconds) behind UTC:
12921 # local time zone used
12922 date --date='1970-01-01 00:02:00' +%s
12927 If you're sorting or graphing dated data, your raw date values may be
12928 represented as seconds since the epoch. But few people can look at
12929 the date @samp{946684800} and casually note ``Oh, that's the first second
12930 of the year 2000 in Greenwich, England.''
12933 date --date='2000-01-01 UTC' +%s
12937 An alternative is to use the @option{--utc} (@option{-u}) option.
12938 Then you may omit @samp{UTC} from the date string. Although this
12939 produces the same result for @samp{%s} and many other format sequences,
12940 with a time zone offset different from zero, it would give a different
12941 result for zone-dependent formats like @samp{%z}.
12944 date -u --date=2000-01-01 +%s
12948 To convert such an unwieldy number of seconds back to
12949 a more readable form, use a command like this:
12952 # local time zone used
12953 date -d '1970-01-01 UTC 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
12954 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
12957 Or if you do not mind depending on the @samp{@@} feature present since
12958 coreutils 5.3.0, you could shorten this to:
12961 date -d @@946684800 +"%F %T %z"
12962 1999-12-31 19:00:00 -0500
12965 Often it is better to output UTC-relative date and time:
12968 date -u -d '1970-01-01 946684800 seconds' +"%Y-%m-%d %T %z"
12969 2000-01-01 00:00:00 +0000
12975 @node uname invocation
12976 @section @command{uname}: Print system information
12979 @cindex print system information
12980 @cindex system information, printing
12982 @command{uname} prints information about the machine and operating system
12983 it is run on. If no options are given, @command{uname} acts as if the
12984 @option{-s} option were given. Synopsis:
12987 uname [@var{option}]@dots{}
12990 If multiple options or @option{-a} are given, the selected information is
12991 printed in this order:
12994 @var{kernel-name} @var{nodename} @var{kernel-release} @var{kernel-version}
12995 @var{machine} @var{processor} @var{hardware-platform} @var{operating-system}
12998 The information may contain internal spaces, so such output cannot be
12999 parsed reliably. In the following example, @var{release} is
13000 @samp{2.2.18ss.e820-bda652a #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001}:
13004 @result{} Linux dum 2.2.18 #4 SMP Tue Jun 5 11:24:08 PDT 2001 i686 unknown unknown GNU/Linux
13008 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13016 Print all of the below information, except omit the processor type
13017 and the hardware platform name if they are unknown.
13020 @itemx --hardware-platform
13022 @opindex --hardware-platform
13023 @cindex implementation, hardware
13024 @cindex hardware platform
13025 @cindex platform, hardware
13026 Print the hardware platform name
13027 (sometimes called the hardware implementation).
13028 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13029 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13035 @cindex machine type
13036 @cindex hardware class
13037 @cindex hardware type
13038 Print the machine hardware name (sometimes called the hardware class
13044 @opindex --nodename
13047 @cindex network node name
13048 Print the network node hostname.
13053 @opindex --processor
13054 @cindex host processor type
13055 Print the processor type (sometimes called the instruction set
13056 architecture or ISA).
13057 Print @samp{unknown} if the kernel does not make this information
13058 easily available, as is the case with Linux kernels.
13061 @itemx --operating-system
13063 @opindex --operating-system
13064 @cindex operating system name
13065 Print the name of the operating system.
13068 @itemx --kernel-release
13070 @opindex --kernel-release
13071 @cindex kernel release
13072 @cindex release of kernel
13073 Print the kernel release.
13076 @itemx --kernel-name
13078 @opindex --kernel-name
13079 @cindex kernel name
13080 @cindex name of kernel
13081 Print the kernel name.
13082 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 (@pxref{Standards conformance}) calls this
13083 ``the implementation of the operating system'', because the
13084 @acronym{POSIX} specification itself has no notion of ``kernel''.
13085 The kernel name might be the same as the operating system name printed
13086 by the @option{-o} or @option{--operating-system} option, but it might
13087 differ. Some operating systems (e.g., FreeBSD, HP-UX) have the same
13088 name as their underlying kernels; others (e.g., GNU/Linux, Solaris)
13092 @itemx --kernel-version
13094 @opindex --kernel-version
13095 @cindex kernel version
13096 @cindex version of kernel
13097 Print the kernel version.
13104 @node hostname invocation
13105 @section @command{hostname}: Print or set system name
13108 @cindex setting the hostname
13109 @cindex printing the hostname
13110 @cindex system name, printing
13111 @cindex appropriate privileges
13113 With no arguments, @command{hostname} prints the name of the current host
13114 system. With one argument, it sets the current host name to the
13115 specified string. You must have appropriate privileges to set the host
13119 hostname [@var{name}]
13122 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13128 @node hostid invocation
13129 @section @command{hostid}: Print numeric host identifier.
13132 @cindex printing the host identifier
13134 @command{hostid} prints the numeric identifier of the current host
13135 in hexadecimal. This command accepts no arguments.
13136 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}.
13137 @xref{Common options}.
13139 For example, here's what it prints on one system I use:
13146 On that system, the 32-bit quantity happens to be closely
13147 related to the system's Internet address, but that isn't always
13153 @node Modified command invocation
13154 @chapter Modified command invocation
13156 @cindex modified command invocation
13157 @cindex invocation of commands, modified
13158 @cindex commands for invoking other commands
13160 This section describes commands that run other commands in some context
13161 different than the current one: a modified environment, as a different
13165 * chroot invocation:: Modify the root directory.
13166 * env invocation:: Modify environment variables.
13167 * nice invocation:: Modify niceness.
13168 * nohup invocation:: Immunize to hangups.
13169 * su invocation:: Modify user and group ID.
13173 @node chroot invocation
13174 @section @command{chroot}: Run a command with a different root directory
13177 @cindex running a program in a specified root directory
13178 @cindex root directory, running a program in a specified
13180 @command{chroot} runs a command with a specified root directory.
13181 On many systems, only the super-user can do this.
13185 chroot @var{newroot} [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13186 chroot @var{option}
13189 Ordinarily, file names are looked up starting at the root of the
13190 directory structure, i.e., @file{/}. @command{chroot} changes the root to
13191 the directory @var{newroot} (which must exist) and then runs
13192 @var{command} with optional @var{args}. If @var{command} is not
13193 specified, the default is the value of the @env{SHELL} environment
13194 variable or @command{/bin/sh} if not set, invoked with the @option{-i} option.
13195 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility
13196 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13198 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13199 options}. Options must precede operands.
13201 Here are a few tips to help avoid common problems in using chroot.
13202 To start with a simple example, make @var{command} refer to a statically
13203 linked binary. If you were to use a dynamically linked executable, then
13204 you'd have to arrange to have the shared libraries in the right place under
13205 your new root directory.
13207 For example, if you create a statically linked @command{ls} executable,
13208 and put it in @file{/tmp/empty}, you can run this command as root:
13211 $ chroot /tmp/empty /ls -Rl /
13214 Then you'll see output like this:
13219 -rwxr-xr-x 1 0 0 1041745 Aug 16 11:17 ls
13222 If you want to use a dynamically linked executable, say @command{bash},
13223 then first run @samp{ldd bash} to see what shared objects it needs.
13224 Then, in addition to copying the actual binary, also copy the listed
13225 files to the required positions under your intended new root directory.
13226 Finally, if the executable requires any other files (e.g., data, state,
13227 device files), copy them into place, too.
13229 @cindex exit status of @command{chroot}
13233 1 if @command{chroot} itself fails
13234 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13235 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13236 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13240 @node env invocation
13241 @section @command{env}: Run a command in a modified environment
13244 @cindex environment, running a program in a modified
13245 @cindex modified environment, running a program in a
13246 @cindex running a program in a modified environment
13248 @command{env} runs a command with a modified environment. Synopses:
13251 env [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{name}=@var{value}]@dots{} @c
13252 [@var{command} [@var{args}]@dots{}]
13256 Operands of the form @samp{@var{variable}=@var{value}} set
13257 the environment variable @var{variable} to value @var{value}.
13258 @var{value} may be empty (@samp{@var{variable}=}). Setting a variable
13259 to an empty value is different from unsetting it.
13260 These operands are evaluated left-to-right, so if two operands
13261 mention the same variable the earlier is ignored.
13263 Environment variable names can be empty, and can contain any
13264 characters other than @samp{=} and the null character (@acronym{ASCII}
13265 @sc{nul}). However, it is wise to limit yourself to names that
13266 consist solely of underscores, digits, and @acronym{ASCII} letters,
13267 and that begin with a non-digit, as applications like the shell do not
13268 work well with other names.
13271 The first operand that does not contain the character @samp{=}
13272 specifies the program to invoke; it is
13273 searched for according to the @env{PATH} environment variable. Any
13274 remaining arguments are passed as arguments to that program.
13275 The program should not be a special built-in utility
13276 (@pxref{Special built-in utilities}).
13278 @cindex environment, printing
13280 If no command name is specified following the environment
13281 specifications, the resulting environment is printed. This is like
13282 specifying the @command{printenv} program.
13284 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13285 Options must precede operands.
13289 @item -u @var{name}
13290 @itemx --unset=@var{name}
13293 Remove variable @var{name} from the environment, if it was in the
13298 @itemx --ignore-environment
13301 @opindex --ignore-environment
13302 Start with an empty environment, ignoring the inherited environment.
13306 @cindex exit status of @command{env}
13310 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the environment is output
13311 1 if @command{env} itself fails
13312 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13313 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13314 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13318 @node nice invocation
13319 @section @command{nice}: Run a command with modified niceness
13323 @cindex scheduling, affecting
13324 @cindex appropriate privileges
13326 @command{nice} prints or modifies a process's @dfn{niceness},
13327 a parameter that affects whether the process is scheduled favorably.
13331 nice [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13334 If no arguments are given, @command{nice} prints the current niceness.
13335 Otherwise, @command{nice} runs the given @var{command} with its
13336 niceness adjusted. By default, its niceness is incremented by 10.
13338 Nicenesses range at least from @minus{}20 (resulting in the most
13339 favorable scheduling) through 19 (the least favorable). Some systems
13340 may have a wider range of nicenesses; conversely, other systems may
13341 enforce more restrictive limits. An attempt to set the niceness
13342 outside the supported range is treated as an attempt to use the
13343 minimum or maximum supported value.
13345 A niceness should not be confused with a scheduling priority, which
13346 lets applications determine the order in which threads are scheduled
13347 to run. Unlike a priority, a niceness is merely advice to the
13348 scheduler, which the scheduler is free to ignore. Also, as a point of
13349 terminology, @acronym{POSIX} defines the behavior of @command{nice} in
13350 terms of a @dfn{nice value}, which is the nonnegative difference
13351 between a niceness and the minimum niceness. Though @command{nice}
13352 conforms to @acronym{POSIX}, its documentation and diagnostics use the
13353 term ``niceness'' for compatibility with historical practice.
13355 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13356 built-in utilities}).
13358 @cindex conflicts with shell built-ins
13359 @cindex built-in shell commands, conflicts with
13360 Because many shells have a built-in @command{nice} command, using an
13361 unadorned @command{nice} in a script or interactively may get you
13362 different functionality than that described here.
13364 The program accepts the following option. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13365 Options must precede operands.
13368 @item -n @var{adjustment}
13369 @itemx --adjustment=@var{adjustment}
13371 @opindex --adjustment
13372 Add @var{adjustment} instead of 10 to the command's niceness. If
13373 @var{adjustment} is negative and you lack appropriate privileges,
13374 @command{nice} issues a warning but otherwise acts as if you specified
13377 For compatibility @command{nice} also supports an obsolete
13378 option syntax @option{-@var{adjustment}}. New scripts should use
13379 @option{-n @var{adjustment}} instead.
13383 @cindex exit status of @command{nice}
13387 0 if no @var{command} is specified and the niceness is output
13388 1 if @command{nice} itself fails
13389 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13390 127 if @var{command} cannot be found
13391 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13394 It is sometimes useful to run a non-interactive program with reduced niceness.
13397 $ nice factor 4611686018427387903
13400 Since @command{nice} prints the current niceness,
13401 you can invoke it through itself to demonstrate how it works.
13403 The default behavior is to increase the niceness by @samp{10}:
13414 The @var{adjustment} is relative to the current niceness. In the
13415 next example, the first @command{nice} invocation runs the second one
13416 with niceness 10, and it in turn runs the final one with a niceness
13420 $ nice nice -n 3 nice
13424 Specifying a niceness larger than the supported range
13425 is the same as specifying the maximum supported value:
13428 $ nice -n 10000000000 nice
13432 Only a privileged user may run a process with lower niceness:
13436 nice: cannot set niceness: Permission denied
13438 $ sudo nice -n -1 nice
13443 @node nohup invocation
13444 @section @command{nohup}: Run a command immune to hangups
13447 @cindex hangups, immunity to
13448 @cindex immunity to hangups
13449 @cindex logging out and continuing to run
13452 @command{nohup} runs the given @var{command} with hangup signals ignored,
13453 so that the command can continue running in the background after you log
13457 nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{}
13460 If standard input is a terminal, it is redirected from
13461 @file{/dev/null} so that terminal sessions do not mistakenly consider
13462 the terminal to be used by the command. This is a @acronym{GNU}
13463 extension; programs intended to be portable to non-@acronym{GNU} hosts
13464 should use @samp{nohup @var{command} [@var{arg}]@dots{} </dev/null}
13468 If standard output is a terminal, the command's standard output is appended
13469 to the file @file{nohup.out}; if that cannot be written to, it is appended
13470 to the file @file{$HOME/nohup.out}; and if that cannot be written to, the
13471 command is not run.
13472 Any @file{nohup.out} or @file{$HOME/nohup.out} file created by
13473 @command{nohup} is made readable and writable only to the user,
13474 regardless of the current umask settings.
13476 If standard error is a terminal, it is normally redirected to the same file
13477 descriptor as the (possibly-redirected) standard output.
13478 However, if standard output is closed, standard error terminal output
13479 is instead appended to the file @file{nohup.out} or
13480 @file{$HOME/nohup.out} as above.
13482 To capture the command's output to a file other than @file{nohup.out}
13483 you can redirect it. For example, to capture the output of
13487 nohup make > make.log
13490 @command{nohup} does not automatically put the command it runs in the
13491 background; you must do that explicitly, by ending the command line
13492 with an @samp{&}. Also, @command{nohup} does not alter the
13493 niceness of @var{command}; use @command{nice} for that,
13494 e.g., @samp{nohup nice @var{command}}.
13496 @var{command} must not be a special built-in utility (@pxref{Special
13497 built-in utilities}).
13499 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13500 options}. Options must precede operands.
13502 @cindex exit status of @command{nohup}
13506 126 if @var{command} is found but cannot be invoked
13507 127 if @command{nohup} itself fails or if @var{command} cannot be found
13508 the exit status of @var{command} otherwise
13512 @node su invocation
13513 @section @command{su}: Run a command with substitute user and group ID
13516 @cindex substitute user and group IDs
13517 @cindex user ID, switching
13518 @cindex super-user, becoming
13519 @cindex root, becoming
13521 @command{su} allows one user to temporarily become another user. It runs a
13522 command (often an interactive shell) with the real and effective user
13523 ID, group ID, and supplemental groups of a given @var{user}. Synopsis:
13526 su [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{user} [@var{arg}]@dots{}]
13529 @cindex passwd entry, and @command{su} shell
13531 @flindex /etc/passwd
13532 If no @var{user} is given, the default is @code{root}, the super-user.
13533 The shell to use is taken from @var{user}'s @code{passwd} entry, or
13534 @file{/bin/sh} if none is specified there. If @var{user} has a
13535 password, @command{su} prompts for the password unless run by a user with
13536 effective user ID of zero (the super-user).
13542 @cindex login shell
13543 By default, @command{su} does not change the current directory.
13544 It sets the environment variables @env{HOME} and @env{SHELL}
13545 from the password entry for @var{user}, and if @var{user} is not
13546 the super-user, sets @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME} to @var{user}.
13547 By default, the shell is not a login shell.
13549 Any additional @var{arg}s are passed as additional arguments to the
13552 @cindex @option{-su}
13553 GNU @command{su} does not treat @file{/bin/sh} or any other shells specially
13554 (e.g., by setting @code{argv[0]} to @option{-su}, passing @option{-c} only
13555 to certain shells, etc.).
13558 @command{su} can optionally be compiled to use @code{syslog} to report
13559 failed, and optionally successful, @command{su} attempts. (If the system
13560 supports @code{syslog}.) However, GNU @command{su} does not check if the
13561 user is a member of the @code{wheel} group; see below.
13563 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13566 @item -c @var{command}
13567 @itemx --command=@var{command}
13570 Pass @var{command}, a single command line to run, to the shell with
13571 a @option{-c} option instead of starting an interactive shell.
13578 @cindex file name pattern expansion, disabled
13579 @cindex globbing, disabled
13580 Pass the @option{-f} option to the shell. This probably only makes sense
13581 if the shell run is @command{csh} or @command{tcsh}, for which the @option{-f}
13582 option prevents reading the startup file (@file{.cshrc}). With
13583 Bourne-like shells, the @option{-f} option disables file name pattern
13584 expansion (globbing), which is not likely to be useful.
13592 @c other variables already indexed above
13595 @cindex login shell, creating
13596 Make the shell a login shell. This means the following. Unset all
13597 environment variables except @env{TERM}, @env{HOME}, and @env{SHELL}
13598 (which are set as described above), and @env{USER} and @env{LOGNAME}
13599 (which are set, even for the super-user, as described above), and set
13600 @env{PATH} to a compiled-in default value. Change to @var{user}'s home
13601 directory. Prepend @samp{-} to the shell's name, intended to make it
13602 read its login startup file(s).
13606 @itemx --preserve-environment
13609 @opindex --preserve-environment
13610 @cindex environment, preserving
13611 @flindex /etc/shells
13612 @cindex restricted shell
13613 Do not change the environment variables @env{HOME}, @env{USER},
13614 @env{LOGNAME}, or @env{SHELL}. Run the shell given in the environment
13615 variable @env{SHELL} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd
13616 entry, unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and
13617 @var{user}'s shell is restricted. A @dfn{restricted shell} is one that
13618 is not listed in the file @file{/etc/shells}, or in a compiled-in list
13619 if that file does not exist. Parts of what this option does can be
13620 overridden by @option{--login} and @option{--shell}.
13622 @item -s @var{shell}
13623 @itemx --shell=@var{shell}
13626 Run @var{shell} instead of the shell from @var{user}'s passwd entry,
13627 unless the user running @command{su} is not the super-user and @var{user}'s
13628 shell is restricted (see @option{-m} just above).
13632 @cindex exit status of @command{su}
13636 1 if @command{su} itself fails
13637 126 if subshell is found but cannot be invoked
13638 127 if subshell cannot be found
13639 the exit status of the subshell otherwise
13642 @cindex wheel group, not supported
13643 @cindex group wheel, not supported
13645 @subsection Why GNU @command{su} does not support the @samp{wheel} group
13647 (This section is by Richard Stallman.)
13651 Sometimes a few of the users try to hold total power over all the
13652 rest. For example, in 1984, a few users at the MIT AI lab decided to
13653 seize power by changing the operator password on the Twenex system and
13654 keeping it secret from everyone else. (I was able to thwart this coup
13655 and give power back to the users by patching the kernel, but I
13656 wouldn't know how to do that in Unix.)
13658 However, occasionally the rulers do tell someone. Under the usual
13659 @command{su} mechanism, once someone learns the root password who
13660 sympathizes with the ordinary users, he or she can tell the rest. The
13661 ``wheel group'' feature would make this impossible, and thus cement the
13662 power of the rulers.
13664 I'm on the side of the masses, not that of the rulers. If you are
13665 used to supporting the bosses and sysadmins in whatever they do, you
13666 might find this idea strange at first.
13669 @node Process control
13670 @chapter Process control
13672 @cindex processes, commands for controlling
13673 @cindex commands for controlling processes
13676 * kill invocation:: Sending a signal to processes.
13680 @node kill invocation
13681 @section @command{kill}: Send a signal to processes
13684 @cindex send a signal to processes
13686 The @command{kill} command sends a signal to processes, causing them
13687 to terminate or otherwise act upon receiving the signal in some way.
13688 Alternatively, it lists information about signals. Synopses:
13691 kill [-s @var{signal} | --signal @var{signal} | -@var{signal}] @var{pid}@dots{}
13692 kill [-l | --list | -t | --table] [@var{signal}]@dots{}
13695 The first form of the @command{kill} command sends a signal to all
13696 @var{pid} arguments. The default signal to send if none is specified
13697 is @samp{TERM}. The special signal number @samp{0} does not denote a
13698 valid signal, but can be used to test whether the @var{pid} arguments
13699 specify processes to which a signal could be sent.
13701 If @var{pid} is positive, the signal is sent to the process with the
13702 process ID @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, the signal is sent to all
13703 processes in the process group of the current process. If @var{pid}
13704 is @minus{}1, the signal is sent to all processes for which the user has
13705 permission to send a signal. If @var{pid} is less than @minus{}1, the signal
13706 is sent to all processes in the process group that equals the absolute
13707 value of @var{pid}.
13709 If @var{pid} is not positive, a system-dependent set of system
13710 processes is excluded from the list of processes to which the signal
13713 If a negative @var{PID} argument is desired as the first one, it
13714 should be preceded by @option{--}. However, as a common extension to
13715 @acronym{POSIX}, @option{--} is not required with @samp{kill
13716 -@var{signal} -@var{pid}}. The following commands are equivalent:
13725 The first form of the @command{kill} command succeeds if every @var{pid}
13726 argument specifies at least one process that the signal was sent to.
13728 The second form of the @command{kill} command lists signal information.
13729 Either the @option{-l} or @option{--list} option, or the @option{-t}
13730 or @option{--table} option must be specified. Without any
13731 @var{signal} argument, all supported signals are listed. The output
13732 of @option{-l} or @option{--list} is a list of the signal names, one
13733 per line; if @var{signal} is already a name, the signal number is
13734 printed instead. The output of @option{-t} or @option{--table} is a
13735 table of signal numbers, names, and descriptions. This form of the
13736 @command{kill} command succeeds if all @var{signal} arguments are valid
13737 and if there is no output error.
13739 The @command{kill} command also supports the @option{--help} and
13740 @option{--version} options. @xref{Common options}.
13742 A @var{signal} may be a signal name like @samp{HUP}, or a signal
13743 number like @samp{1}, or an exit status of a process terminated by the
13744 signal. A signal name can be given in canonical form or prefixed by
13745 @samp{SIG}. The case of the letters is ignored, except for the
13746 @option{-@var{signal}} option which must use upper case to avoid
13747 ambiguity with lower case option letters. The following signal names
13748 and numbers are supported on all @acronym{POSIX} compliant systems:
13754 2. Terminal interrupt.
13760 9. Kill (cannot be caught or ignored).
13768 Other supported signal names have system-dependent corresponding
13769 numbers. All systems conforming to @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 also
13770 support the following signals:
13774 Access to an undefined portion of a memory object.
13776 Child process terminated, stopped, or continued.
13778 Continue executing, if stopped.
13780 Erroneous arithmetic operation.
13782 Illegal Instruction.
13784 Write on a pipe with no one to read it.
13786 Invalid memory reference.
13788 Stop executing (cannot be caught or ignored).
13792 Background process attempting read.
13794 Background process attempting write.
13796 High bandwidth data is available at a socket.
13798 User-defined signal 1.
13800 User-defined signal 2.
13804 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XSI} extension
13805 also support the following signals:
13811 Profiling timer expired.
13815 Trace/breakpoint trap.
13817 Virtual timer expired.
13819 CPU time limit exceeded.
13821 File size limit exceeded.
13825 @acronym{POSIX} 1003.1-2001 systems that support the @acronym{XRT} extension
13826 also support at least eight real-time signals called @samp{RTMIN},
13827 @samp{RTMIN+1}, @dots{}, @samp{RTMAX-1}, @samp{RTMAX}.
13833 @cindex delaying commands
13834 @cindex commands for delaying
13836 @c Perhaps @command{wait} or other commands should be described here also?
13839 * sleep invocation:: Delay for a specified time.
13843 @node sleep invocation
13844 @section @command{sleep}: Delay for a specified time
13847 @cindex delay for a specified time
13849 @command{sleep} pauses for an amount of time specified by the sum of
13850 the values of the command line arguments.
13854 sleep @var{number}[smhd]@dots{}
13858 Each argument is a number followed by an optional unit; the default
13859 is seconds. The units are:
13872 Historical implementations of @command{sleep} have required that
13873 @var{number} be an integer, and only accepted a single argument
13874 without a suffix. However, GNU @command{sleep} accepts
13875 arbitrary floating point numbers (using a period before any fractional
13878 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13884 @node Numeric operations
13885 @chapter Numeric operations
13887 @cindex numeric operations
13888 These programs do numerically-related operations.
13891 * factor invocation:: Show factors of numbers.
13892 * seq invocation:: Print sequences of numbers.
13896 @node factor invocation
13897 @section @command{factor}: Print prime factors
13900 @cindex prime factors
13902 @command{factor} prints prime factors. Synopses:
13905 factor [@var{number}]@dots{}
13906 factor @var{option}
13909 If no @var{number} is specified on the command line, @command{factor} reads
13910 numbers from standard input, delimited by newlines, tabs, or spaces.
13912 The only options are @option{--help} and @option{--version}. @xref{Common
13915 The algorithm it uses is not very sophisticated, so for some inputs
13916 @command{factor} runs for a long time. The hardest numbers to factor are
13917 the products of large primes. Factoring the product of the two largest 32-bit
13918 prime numbers takes about 80 seconds of CPU time on a 1.6 GHz Athlon.
13921 $ p=`echo '4294967279 * 4294967291'|bc`
13923 18446743979220271189: 4294967279 4294967291
13926 Similarly, it takes about 80 seconds for GNU factor (from coreutils-5.1.2)
13927 to ``factor'' the largest 64-bit prime:
13930 $ factor 18446744073709551557
13931 18446744073709551557: 18446744073709551557
13934 In contrast, @command{factor} factors the largest 64-bit number in just
13935 over a tenth of a second:
13938 $ factor `echo '2^64-1'|bc`
13939 18446744073709551615: 3 5 17 257 641 65537 6700417
13945 @node seq invocation
13946 @section @command{seq}: Print numeric sequences
13949 @cindex numeric sequences
13950 @cindex sequence of numbers
13952 @command{seq} prints a sequence of numbers to standard output. Synopses:
13955 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{last}
13956 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{last}
13957 seq [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{first} @var{increment} @var{last}
13960 @command{seq} prints the numbers from @var{first} to @var{last} by
13961 @var{increment}. By default, each number is printed on a separate line.
13962 When @var{increment} is not specified, it defaults to @samp{1},
13963 even when @var{first} is larger than @var{last}.
13964 @var{first} also defaults to @samp{1}. So @code{seq 1} prints
13965 @samp{1}, but @code{seq 0} and @code{seq 10 5} produce no output.
13966 Floating-point numbers
13967 may be specified (using a period before any fractional digits).
13969 The program accepts the following options. Also see @ref{Common options}.
13970 Options must precede operands.
13973 @item -f @var{format}
13974 @itemx --format=@var{format}
13975 @opindex -f @var{format}
13976 @opindex --format=@var{format}
13977 @cindex formatting of numbers in @command{seq}
13978 Print all numbers using @var{format}.
13979 @var{format} must contain exactly one of the @samp{printf}-style
13980 floating point conversion specifications @samp{%a}, @samp{%e},
13981 @samp{%f}, @samp{%g}, @samp{%A}, @samp{%E}, @samp{%F}, @samp{%G}.
13982 The @samp{%} may be followed by zero or more flags taken from the set
13983 @samp{-+#0 '}, then an optional width containing one or more digits,
13984 then an optional precision consisting of a @samp{.} followed by zero
13985 or more digits. @var{format} may also contain any number of @samp{%%}
13986 conversion specifications. All conversion specifications have the
13987 same meaning as with @samp{printf}.
13989 The default format is derived from @var{first}, @var{step}, and
13990 @var{last}. If these all use a fixed point decimal representation,
13991 the default format is @samp{%.@var{p}f}, where @var{p} is the minimum
13992 precision that can represent the output numbers exactly. Otherwise,
13993 the default format is @samp{%g}.
13995 @item -s @var{string}
13996 @itemx --separator=@var{string}
13997 @cindex separator for numbers in @command{seq}
13998 Separate numbers with @var{string}; default is a newline.
13999 The output always terminates with a newline.
14002 @itemx --equal-width
14003 Print all numbers with the same width, by padding with leading zeros.
14004 @var{first}, @var{step}, and @var{last} should all use a fixed point
14005 decimal representation.
14006 (To have other kinds of padding, use @option{--format}).
14010 You can get finer-grained control over output with @option{-f}:
14013 $ seq -f '(%9.2E)' -9e5 1.1e6 1.3e6
14019 If you want hexadecimal integer output, you can use @command{printf}
14020 to perform the conversion:
14023 $ printf '%x\n' `seq 1048575 1024 1050623`
14029 For very long lists of numbers, use xargs to avoid
14030 system limitations on the length of an argument list:
14033 $ seq 1000000 | xargs printf '%x\n' | tail -n 3
14039 To generate octal output, use the printf @code{%o} format instead
14042 On most systems, seq can produce whole-number output for values up to
14043 at least @code{2^53}. Larger integers are approximated. The details
14044 differ depending on your floating-point implementation, but a common
14045 case is that @command{seq} works with integers through @code{2^64},
14046 and larger integers may not be numerically correct:
14049 $ seq 18446744073709551616 1 18446744073709551618
14050 18446744073709551616
14051 18446744073709551616
14052 18446744073709551618
14055 Be careful when using @command{seq} with outlandish values: otherwise
14056 you may see surprising results, as @command{seq} uses floating point
14057 internally. For example, on the x86 platform, where the internal
14058 representation uses a 64-bit fraction, the command:
14061 seq 1 0.0000000000000000001 1.0000000000000000009
14064 outputs 1.0000000000000000007 twice and skips 1.0000000000000000008.
14069 @node File permissions
14070 @chapter File permissions
14073 @include getdate.texi
14077 @node Opening the software toolbox
14078 @chapter Opening the Software Toolbox
14080 An earlier version of this chapter appeared in
14081 @uref{http://www.linuxjournal.com/article.php?sid=2762, the
14082 @cite{What's GNU?} column of @cite{Linux Journal}, 2 (June, 1994)}.
14083 It was written by Arnold Robbins.
14086 * Toolbox introduction:: Toolbox introduction
14087 * I/O redirection:: I/O redirection
14088 * The who command:: The @command{who} command
14089 * The cut command:: The @command{cut} command
14090 * The sort command:: The @command{sort} command
14091 * The uniq command:: The @command{uniq} command
14092 * Putting the tools together:: Putting the tools together
14096 @node Toolbox introduction
14097 @unnumberedsec Toolbox Introduction
14099 This month's column is only peripherally related to the GNU Project, in
14100 that it describes a number of the GNU tools on your GNU/Linux system and how they
14101 might be used. What it's really about is the ``Software Tools'' philosophy
14102 of program development and usage.
14104 The software tools philosophy was an important and integral concept
14105 in the initial design and development of Unix (of which Linux and GNU are
14106 essentially clones). Unfortunately, in the modern day press of
14107 Internetworking and flashy GUIs, it seems to have fallen by the
14108 wayside. This is a shame, since it provides a powerful mental model
14109 for solving many kinds of problems.
14111 Many people carry a Swiss Army knife around in their pants pockets (or
14112 purse). A Swiss Army knife is a handy tool to have: it has several knife
14113 blades, a screwdriver, tweezers, toothpick, nail file, corkscrew, and perhaps
14114 a number of other things on it. For the everyday, small miscellaneous jobs
14115 where you need a simple, general purpose tool, it's just the thing.
14117 On the other hand, an experienced carpenter doesn't build a house using
14118 a Swiss Army knife. Instead, he has a toolbox chock full of specialized
14119 tools---a saw, a hammer, a screwdriver, a plane, and so on. And he knows
14120 exactly when and where to use each tool; you won't catch him hammering nails
14121 with the handle of his screwdriver.
14123 The Unix developers at Bell Labs were all professional programmers and trained
14124 computer scientists. They had found that while a one-size-fits-all program
14125 might appeal to a user because there's only one program to use, in practice
14130 difficult to write,
14133 difficult to maintain and
14137 difficult to extend to meet new situations.
14140 Instead, they felt that programs should be specialized tools. In short, each
14141 program ``should do one thing well.'' No more and no less. Such programs are
14142 simpler to design, write, and get right---they only do one thing.
14144 Furthermore, they found that with the right machinery for hooking programs
14145 together, that the whole was greater than the sum of the parts. By combining
14146 several special purpose programs, you could accomplish a specific task
14147 that none of the programs was designed for, and accomplish it much more
14148 quickly and easily than if you had to write a special purpose program.
14149 We will see some (classic) examples of this further on in the column.
14150 (An important additional point was that, if necessary, take a detour
14151 and build any software tools you may need first, if you don't already
14152 have something appropriate in the toolbox.)
14154 @node I/O redirection
14155 @unnumberedsec I/O Redirection
14157 Hopefully, you are familiar with the basics of I/O redirection in the
14158 shell, in particular the concepts of ``standard input,'' ``standard output,''
14159 and ``standard error''. Briefly, ``standard input'' is a data source, where
14160 data comes from. A program should not need to either know or care if the
14161 data source is a disk file, a keyboard, a magnetic tape, or even a punched
14162 card reader. Similarly, ``standard output'' is a data sink, where data goes
14163 to. The program should neither know nor care where this might be.
14164 Programs that only read their standard input, do something to the data,
14165 and then send it on, are called @dfn{filters}, by analogy to filters in a
14168 With the Unix shell, it's very easy to set up data pipelines:
14171 program_to_create_data | filter1 | ... | filterN > final.pretty.data
14174 We start out by creating the raw data; each filter applies some successive
14175 transformation to the data, until by the time it comes out of the pipeline,
14176 it is in the desired form.
14178 This is fine and good for standard input and standard output. Where does the
14179 standard error come in to play? Well, think about @command{filter1} in
14180 the pipeline above. What happens if it encounters an error in the data it
14181 sees? If it writes an error message to standard output, it will just
14182 disappear down the pipeline into @command{filter2}'s input, and the
14183 user will probably never see it. So programs need a place where they can send
14184 error messages so that the user will notice them. This is standard error,
14185 and it is usually connected to your console or window, even if you have
14186 redirected standard output of your program away from your screen.
14188 For filter programs to work together, the format of the data has to be
14189 agreed upon. The most straightforward and easiest format to use is simply
14190 lines of text. Unix data files are generally just streams of bytes, with
14191 lines delimited by the @acronym{ASCII} @sc{lf} (Line Feed) character,
14192 conventionally called a ``newline'' in the Unix literature. (This is
14193 @code{'\n'} if you're a C programmer.) This is the format used by all
14194 the traditional filtering programs. (Many earlier operating systems
14195 had elaborate facilities and special purpose programs for managing
14196 binary data. Unix has always shied away from such things, under the
14197 philosophy that it's easiest to simply be able to view and edit your
14198 data with a text editor.)
14200 OK, enough introduction. Let's take a look at some of the tools, and then
14201 we'll see how to hook them together in interesting ways. In the following
14202 discussion, we will only present those command line options that interest
14203 us. As you should always do, double check your system documentation
14204 for the full story.
14206 @node The who command
14207 @unnumberedsec The @command{who} Command
14209 The first program is the @command{who} command. By itself, it generates a
14210 list of the users who are currently logged in. Although I'm writing
14211 this on a single-user system, we'll pretend that several people are
14216 @print{} arnold console Jan 22 19:57
14217 @print{} miriam ttyp0 Jan 23 14:19(:0.0)
14218 @print{} bill ttyp1 Jan 21 09:32(:0.0)
14219 @print{} arnold ttyp2 Jan 23 20:48(:0.0)
14222 Here, the @samp{$} is the usual shell prompt, at which I typed @samp{who}.
14223 There are three people logged in, and I am logged in twice. On traditional
14224 Unix systems, user names are never more than eight characters long. This
14225 little bit of trivia will be useful later. The output of @command{who} is nice,
14226 but the data is not all that exciting.
14228 @node The cut command
14229 @unnumberedsec The @command{cut} Command
14231 The next program we'll look at is the @command{cut} command. This program
14232 cuts out columns or fields of input data. For example, we can tell it
14233 to print just the login name and full name from the @file{/etc/passwd}
14234 file. The @file{/etc/passwd} file has seven fields, separated by
14238 arnold:xyzzy:2076:10:Arnold D. Robbins:/home/arnold:/bin/bash
14241 To get the first and fifth fields, we would use @command{cut} like this:
14244 $ cut -d: -f1,5 /etc/passwd
14245 @print{} root:Operator
14247 @print{} arnold:Arnold D. Robbins
14248 @print{} miriam:Miriam A. Robbins
14252 With the @option{-c} option, @command{cut} will cut out specific characters
14253 (i.e., columns) in the input lines. This is useful for input data
14254 that has fixed width fields, and does not have a field separator. For
14255 example, list the Monday dates for the current month:
14257 @c Is using cal ok? Looked at gcal, but I don't like it.
14268 @node The sort command
14269 @unnumberedsec The @command{sort} Command
14271 Next we'll look at the @command{sort} command. This is one of the most
14272 powerful commands on a Unix-style system; one that you will often find
14273 yourself using when setting up fancy data plumbing.
14276 command reads and sorts each file named on the command line. It then
14277 merges the sorted data and writes it to standard output. It will read
14278 standard input if no files are given on the command line (thus
14279 making it into a filter). The sort is based on the character collating
14280 sequence or based on user-supplied ordering criteria.
14283 @node The uniq command
14284 @unnumberedsec The @command{uniq} Command
14286 Finally (at least for now), we'll look at the @command{uniq} program. When
14287 sorting data, you will often end up with duplicate lines, lines that
14288 are identical. Usually, all you need is one instance of each line.
14289 This is where @command{uniq} comes in. The @command{uniq} program reads its
14290 standard input. It prints only one
14291 copy of each repeated line. It does have several options. Later on,
14292 we'll use the @option{-c} option, which prints each unique line, preceded
14293 by a count of the number of times that line occurred in the input.
14296 @node Putting the tools together
14297 @unnumberedsec Putting the Tools Together
14299 Now, let's suppose this is a large ISP server system with dozens of users
14300 logged in. The management wants the system administrator to write a program that will
14301 generate a sorted list of logged in users. Furthermore, even if a user
14302 is logged in multiple times, his or her name should only show up in the
14305 The administrator could sit down with the system documentation and write a C
14306 program that did this. It would take perhaps a couple of hundred lines
14307 of code and about two hours to write it, test it, and debug it.
14308 However, knowing the software toolbox, the administrator can instead start out
14309 by generating just a list of logged on users:
14319 Next, sort the list:
14322 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort
14329 Finally, run the sorted list through @command{uniq}, to weed out duplicates:
14332 $ who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14338 The @command{sort} command actually has a @option{-u} option that does what
14339 @command{uniq} does. However, @command{uniq} has other uses for which one
14340 cannot substitute @samp{sort -u}.
14342 The administrator puts this pipeline into a shell script, and makes it available for
14343 all the users on the system (@samp{#} is the system administrator,
14344 or @code{root}, prompt):
14347 # cat > /usr/local/bin/listusers
14348 who | cut -c1-8 | sort | uniq
14350 # chmod +x /usr/local/bin/listusers
14353 There are four major points to note here. First, with just four
14354 programs, on one command line, the administrator was able to save about two
14355 hours worth of work. Furthermore, the shell pipeline is just about as
14356 efficient as the C program would be, and it is much more efficient in
14357 terms of programmer time. People time is much more expensive than
14358 computer time, and in our modern ``there's never enough time to do
14359 everything'' society, saving two hours of programmer time is no mean
14362 Second, it is also important to emphasize that with the
14363 @emph{combination} of the tools, it is possible to do a special
14364 purpose job never imagined by the authors of the individual programs.
14366 Third, it is also valuable to build up your pipeline in stages, as we did here.
14367 This allows you to view the data at each stage in the pipeline, which helps
14368 you acquire the confidence that you are indeed using these tools correctly.
14370 Finally, by bundling the pipeline in a shell script, other users can use
14371 your command, without having to remember the fancy plumbing you set up for
14372 them. In terms of how you run them, shell scripts and compiled programs are
14375 After the previous warm-up exercise, we'll look at two additional, more
14376 complicated pipelines. For them, we need to introduce two more tools.
14378 The first is the @command{tr} command, which stands for ``transliterate.''
14379 The @command{tr} command works on a character-by-character basis, changing
14380 characters. Normally it is used for things like mapping upper case to
14384 $ echo ThIs ExAmPlE HaS MIXED case! | tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]'
14385 @print{} this example has mixed case!
14388 There are several options of interest:
14392 work on the complement of the listed characters, i.e.,
14393 operations apply to characters not in the given set
14396 delete characters in the first set from the output
14399 squeeze repeated characters in the output into just one character.
14402 We will be using all three options in a moment.
14404 The other command we'll look at is @command{comm}. The @command{comm}
14405 command takes two sorted input files as input data, and prints out the
14406 files' lines in three columns. The output columns are the data lines
14407 unique to the first file, the data lines unique to the second file, and
14408 the data lines that are common to both. The @option{-1}, @option{-2}, and
14409 @option{-3} command line options @emph{omit} the respective columns. (This is
14410 non-intuitive and takes a little getting used to.) For example:
14432 The file name @file{-} tells @command{comm} to read standard input
14433 instead of a regular file.
14435 Now we're ready to build a fancy pipeline. The first application is a word
14436 frequency counter. This helps an author determine if he or she is over-using
14439 The first step is to change the case of all the letters in our input file
14440 to one case. ``The'' and ``the'' are the same word when doing counting.
14443 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | ...
14446 The next step is to get rid of punctuation. Quoted words and unquoted words
14447 should be treated identically; it's easiest to just get the punctuation out of
14451 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' | ...
14454 The second @command{tr} command operates on the complement of the listed
14455 characters, which are all the letters, the digits, the underscore, and
14456 the blank. The @samp{\n} represents the newline character; it has to
14457 be left alone. (The @acronym{ASCII} tab character should also be included for
14458 good measure in a production script.)
14460 At this point, we have data consisting of words separated by blank space.
14461 The words only contain alphanumeric characters (and the underscore). The
14462 next step is break the data apart so that we have one word per line. This
14463 makes the counting operation much easier, as we will see shortly.
14466 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14467 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | ...
14470 This command turns blanks into newlines. The @option{-s} option squeezes
14471 multiple newline characters in the output into just one. This helps us
14472 avoid blank lines. (The @samp{>} is the shell's ``secondary prompt.''
14473 This is what the shell prints when it notices you haven't finished
14474 typing in all of a command.)
14476 We now have data consisting of one word per line, no punctuation, all one
14477 case. We're ready to count each word:
14480 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14481 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | ...
14484 At this point, the data might look something like this:
14497 The output is sorted by word, not by count! What we want is the most
14498 frequently used words first. Fortunately, this is easy to accomplish,
14499 with the help of two more @command{sort} options:
14503 do a numeric sort, not a textual one
14506 reverse the order of the sort
14509 The final pipeline looks like this:
14512 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14513 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort | uniq -c | sort -n -r
14522 Whew! That's a lot to digest. Yet, the same principles apply. With six
14523 commands, on two lines (really one long one split for convenience), we've
14524 created a program that does something interesting and useful, in much
14525 less time than we could have written a C program to do the same thing.
14527 A minor modification to the above pipeline can give us a simple spelling
14528 checker! To determine if you've spelled a word correctly, all you have to
14529 do is look it up in a dictionary. If it is not there, then chances are
14530 that your spelling is incorrect. So, we need a dictionary.
14531 The conventional location for a dictionary is @file{/usr/dict/words}.
14532 On my GNU/Linux system,@footnote{Redhat Linux 6.1, for the November 2000
14533 revision of this article.}
14534 this is a is a sorted, 45,402 word dictionary.
14536 Now, how to compare our file with the dictionary? As before, we generate
14537 a sorted list of words, one per line:
14540 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14541 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u | ...
14544 Now, all we need is a list of words that are @emph{not} in the
14545 dictionary. Here is where the @command{comm} command comes in.
14548 $ tr '[:upper:]' '[:lower:]' < whats.gnu | tr -cd '[:alnum:]_ \n' |
14549 > tr -s ' ' '\n' | sort -u |
14550 > comm -23 - /usr/dict/words
14553 The @option{-2} and @option{-3} options eliminate lines that are only in the
14554 dictionary (the second file), and lines that are in both files. Lines
14555 only in the first file (standard input, our stream of words), are
14556 words that are not in the dictionary. These are likely candidates for
14557 spelling errors. This pipeline was the first cut at a production
14558 spelling checker on Unix.
14560 There are some other tools that deserve brief mention.
14564 search files for text that matches a regular expression
14567 count lines, words, characters
14570 a T-fitting for data pipes, copies data to files and to standard output
14573 the stream editor, an advanced tool
14576 a data manipulation language, another advanced tool
14579 The software tools philosophy also espoused the following bit of
14580 advice: ``Let someone else do the hard part.'' This means, take
14581 something that gives you most of what you need, and then massage it the
14582 rest of the way until it's in the form that you want.
14588 Each program should do one thing well. No more, no less.
14591 Combining programs with appropriate plumbing leads to results where
14592 the whole is greater than the sum of the parts. It also leads to novel
14593 uses of programs that the authors might never have imagined.
14596 Programs should never print extraneous header or trailer data, since these
14597 could get sent on down a pipeline. (A point we didn't mention earlier.)
14600 Let someone else do the hard part.
14603 Know your toolbox! Use each program appropriately. If you don't have an
14604 appropriate tool, build one.
14607 As of this writing, all the programs we've discussed are available via
14608 anonymous @command{ftp} from: @*
14609 @uref{ftp://gnudist.gnu.org/textutils/textutils-1.22.tar.gz}. (There may
14610 be more recent versions available now.)
14612 None of what I have presented in this column is new. The Software Tools
14613 philosophy was first introduced in the book @cite{Software Tools}, by
14614 Brian Kernighan and P.J. Plauger (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-03669-X).
14615 This book showed how to write and use software tools. It was written in
14616 1976, using a preprocessor for FORTRAN named @command{ratfor} (RATional
14617 FORtran). At the time, C was not as ubiquitous as it is now; FORTRAN
14618 was. The last chapter presented a @command{ratfor} to FORTRAN
14619 processor, written in @command{ratfor}. @command{ratfor} looks an awful
14620 lot like C; if you know C, you won't have any problem following the
14623 In 1981, the book was updated and made available as @cite{Software Tools
14624 in Pascal} (Addison-Wesley, ISBN 0-201-10342-7). Both books are
14625 still in print and are well worth
14626 reading if you're a programmer. They certainly made a major change in
14627 how I view programming.
14629 The programs in both books are available from
14630 @uref{http://cm.bell-labs.com/who/bwk, Brian Kernighan's home page}.
14631 For a number of years, there was an active
14632 Software Tools Users Group, whose members had ported the original
14633 @command{ratfor} programs to essentially every computer system with a
14634 FORTRAN compiler. The popularity of the group waned in the middle 1980s
14635 as Unix began to spread beyond universities.
14637 With the current proliferation of GNU code and other clones of Unix programs,
14638 these programs now receive little attention; modern C versions are
14639 much more efficient and do more than these programs do. Nevertheless, as
14640 exposition of good programming style, and evangelism for a still-valuable
14641 philosophy, these books are unparalleled, and I recommend them highly.
14643 Acknowledgment: I would like to express my gratitude to Brian Kernighan
14644 of Bell Labs, the original Software Toolsmith, for reviewing this column.
14646 @node Copying This Manual
14647 @appendix Copying This Manual
14650 * GNU Free Documentation License:: License for copying this manual.
14664 @c Local variables:
14665 @c texinfo-column-for-description: 32